Home
        Lexmark X654de MFP User Guide Manual
         Contents
1.                                                                                                               125 235                      By default  Collate is set to On  If you do not want to collate your copies  then change the setting to Off   To turn collation off   1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch Copy     4 Use the keypad to enter the number of copies     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 99    5 Touch Off if you do not want your copies collated     6 Touch Copy It     Placing separator sheets between copies  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy     Touch Options     u A U N    Touch Separator Sheets     Note  Collate must be On for the separator sheets to be placed between copies  If Collate is Off  the separator  sheets are added to the end of the pr
2.                                               M   291   elio CaMadaiNOviCeS EHE                    294  Power CONSUIM PU ON et 301    INdeX      esseeseesssessosssesssessoesscssocssscesccsscssocesssssccsscesscsssoessesssesssesseesssessessssss DOS    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Safety information 12    Safety information    Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily accessible   Do not place or use this product near water or wet locations     CAUTION   POTENTIAL INJURY  This product uses a laser  Use of controls or adjustments or performance of  procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure     This product uses a printing process that heats the print media  and the heat may cause the media to release emissions   You must understand the section in your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for selecting print media  to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions     Use care when you replace a lithium battery     CAUTION   POTENTIAL INJURY  There is a danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced   Replace it only with the same or an equivalent type of lithium battery  Do not recharge  disassemble  or  incinerate a lithium battery  Discard used batteries according to the manufacturer s instructions and local  regulations     CAUTION   HOT SURFACE  The inside of the printer might be hot  To reduce the risk of injury from a hot 
3.                Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices    296       r                                           M    Magyar Alul  rott  Lexmark International  Inc  nyilatkozom  hogy a term  k megfelel a vonatkoz   alapvet    k  vetelm  nyeknek   s az 1999 5 EC ir  nyelv egy  b el    r  sainak      slenska   H  r me   l  sir Lexmark International  Inc  yfir   v   a     essi vara er    samr  mi vi   grunnkr  fur og a  rar  kr  fur  sem ger  ar eru    tilskipun 1999 5 EC    Italiano Con la presente Lexmark International  Inc  dichiara che questo questo prodotto    conforme ai requisiti  essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999 5 CE    Latviski Ar   o Lexmark International  Inc  deklar    ka Sis izstr  d  jums atbilst Direkt  vas 1999 5 EK b  tiskaj  m  prasibam un citiem ar to saistitajiem noteikumiem    Lietuvi       iuo Lexmark International  Inc  deklaruoja  kad   is produktas atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas  1999 5 EB direktyvos nuostatas    Malti Bil pre  enti  Lexmark International  Inc   jiddikjara li dan il prodott huwa konformi mal   ti  ijiet  essenzjali u ma dispo  izzjonijiet o  rajn relevanti li jinsabu fid Direttiva 1999 5 KE    Nederlands   Hierbij verklaart Lexmark International  Inc  dat het toestel dit product in overeenstemming is met de essenti  le  eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999 5 EG    Norsk Lexmark International  Inc  erkl  rer herved at dette produktet er i samsvar
4.                c Remove the printer hard disk by pulling it upward to unseat the standoffs        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 34    d Remove the thumbscrews that attach the printer hard disk mounting bracket to the printer hard disk  and then  remove the bracket  Set the printer hard disk aside           4 Remove the metal cover from the ISP opening     EET    I  e                      Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup    35    5 Align the posts of the plastic tee to the holes in the system board  and then press downward until the tee snaps  into place  Be sure each post of the tee has latched completely  and that the tee is seated firmly onto the system    board                                       p  SSS  Tee     Jn  p  a           es  SSS                            E                           6 Install the ISP onto the plastic tee  Angle the ISP over the plastic tee  and then approach the plastic tee so that any  overhanging connectors will pass through the ISP opening in the system board cage     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          ii                   Additional printer setup 36    7 Lower the ISP toward the plastic tee until the ISP is seated between the guides of the plastic tee              8 Insert the long thumbscrew and turn it clockwise enough to hold the ISP in place  but do not tighten the thumbscrew  at this time              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com
5.         nstall additional printer memory     42 xy Cartridge region mismatch    Install a print cartridge that matches the region number of the printer  x indicates the value of the printer region  y  indicates the value of the cartridge region  x and y can have the following values                     1 US    2 Europe  the Middle East  and Africa   3 Asia   4 Latin America    9 Invalid region J             50 PPDS font error    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing       The printer cannot find a requested font  From the PPDS menu  select Best Fit  and then select On  The printer will  find a similar font and reformat the affected text       Cancel the current print job     51 Defective flash detected    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing       Cancel the current print job     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer messages 244    52 Not enough free space in flash memory for resources    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing   Downloaded fonts and macros not previously stored in flash memory are deleted     Delete fonts  macros  and other data stored in flash memory       Upgrade to a larger capacity flash memory card     53 Unformatted flash detected    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to stop the defragment operation and continue printing       Form
6.        3 Flex the sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them  and then fan them  Do not fold or crease the paper  Straighten  the edges on a level surface     4 Load the paper into the multipurpose feeder     5 Slide the paper guide toward the inside of the tray until it lightly rests against the edge of the paper                                6 Touch Continue     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 147    260 paper jam    Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam  The envelope feeder feeds envelopes from the bottom of  the stack  the bottom envelope will be the one that is jammed     1  2  3    O on O wl    10    Lift the envelope weight   Remove all envelopes     If the jammed envelope has entered the printer and cannot be pulled out  then lift the envelope feeder up and then  out of the printer  and then set it aside     Remove the envelope from the printer     Note  If you cannot remove the envelope  then the print cartridge will have to be removed  For more  information  see    200 and 201 paper jams    on page 141     Reinstall the envelope feeder  Make sure it snaps into place   Flex and stack the envelopes    Load the envelopes in the envelope feeder    Adjust the paper guide    Lower the envelope weight     Touch Continue     270 279 paper jams    To clear a jam in the high capacity output stacker or the 4 bin mailbox     1  2    a uu A U    Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam     If the paper is ex
7.        Once a limit is reached  the jobs for that user name and that PIN are deleted        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          182    Understanding printer menus      Menu item  Job Expiration  Off  1 hour  4 hours  24 hours  1 week       r    Description    Limits the amount of time a confidential job stays in the printer before it is deleted    Notes       Offis the default setting     e  f the Job Expiration setting is changed while confidential jobs reside on the  printer RAM or printer hard disk  the expiration time for those print jobs does  not change to the new default value        fthe printer is turned off  all confidential jobs held in printer RAM are  deleted           M       Disk Wiping menu  Menu item  Automatic Wiping   off   On    Description    Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  from the printer hard disk  All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved   such as downloaded fonts  macros  and held jobs     Automatic Wiping marks all disk space used by a previous job and does not permit  the file system to reuse this space until it has been sanitized     Only Automatic Wiping enables users to activate disk wiping without having to take  the printer offline for an extended amount of time     Notes       This menu item appears only if a formatted  non defective printer hard disk is  installed       Offis the default setting     Due to the large amount of resources required for Automa
8.      Custom Type  lt x gt        1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off           Note  Only installed trays  drawers  and feeders are listed in this menu    lt        Configure MP menu    Menu item Description       Configure MP Determines when the printer selects paper from the multipurpose feeder  Cassette Notes   Manual  First   Cassette is the factory default setting       The Cassette setting configures the multipurpose feeder as an automatic  paper source       When Manual is selected  the multipurpose feeder can be used only for  manual feed print jobs        f paper is loaded in the multipurpose feeder and First is selected  then  paper always feeds from the multipurpose feeder first                 Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Envelope Enhance    157    The envelope conditioner significantly reduces the wrinkling of some envelopes        Menu item    Envelope Enhance   Off   1  Least    2   3   4   5   6  Most        r    Description    Enables or disables the envelope conditioner  Notes       The factory default setting is 5        f noise reduction is more important than wrinkle reduction  then  decrease the setting           bs       Substitute Size menu    Menu item    Substitute Size  Off  Statement A5  Letter A4  All Listed       r    Description    Substitutes a specified paper size if the requested paper size is not available    Notes     All Listed is the factory default setting  All available su
9.      Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing     Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead    Use these guidelines when selecting preprinted forms and letterhead     Use grain long for 60 to 90 g m  weight paper     Use only forms and letterhead printed using an offset lithographic or engraved printing process       Avoid papers with rough or heavily textured surfaces     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper and specialty media guidelines 88    Use papers printed with heat resistant inks designed for use in xerographic copiers  The ink must be able to withstand  temperatures up to 230  C  446  F  without melting or releasing hazardous emissions  Use inks that are not affected by  the resin in toner  Inks that are oxidation set or oil based generally meet these requirements  latex inks might not   When in doubt  contact the paper supplier     Preprinted papers such as letterhead must be able to withstand temperatures up to 230  C  446  F  without melting or  releasing hazardous emissions     Using recycled paper and other office papers    As an environmentally conscious company  Lexmark supports the use of recycled office paper produced specifically for  use in laser  electrophotographic  printers  In 1998  Lexmark presented to the US government a study demonstrating  that recycled paper produced by major mills in the US fed as well as non recycled paper  However  no blanket statement  can be made that a
10.      Scan documents and send them to another printer  PDF by way of FTP      Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer 17    Understanding the ADF and scanner glass    Automatic Document Feeder  ADF  Scanner glass          Use the ADF for multiple page documents    Use the scanner glass for single pages  small items  such as postcards or  photos   transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings or lightweight carbonless forms      M A                You can use the ADF or the scanner glass to scan documents     Using the ADF    The Automatic Document Feeder  ADF  can scan multiple pages  including duplex pages  When using the ADF     Load the document into the ADF faceup  short edge first     Load up to 75 sheets of plain paper in the ADF input tray     Scan sizes from 76 2 x 139 4 mm  3 0 x 5 5 in   to 215 9 x 355 6 mm  8 5 x 14 in       Scan documents with mixed page sizes  letter and legal      Scan media weights from 52 to 120 g m   14 to 32 Ib        Donotload postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine clippings   into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     Using the scanner glass    The scanner glass can be used to scan or copy single pages or book pages  When using the scanner glass     Place a document facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner     Scan or copy documents up to 215 9 x 355 6 mm  8 5 x 14 in       Copy books up to 25 3 mm 
11.      Security Audit Log menu    Menu item    Export Log       Description    Enables an authorized user to export the security log  Notes       To export the log from the printer control panel  a flash drive must be  attached to the printer       From the Embedded Web Server  the log can be downloaded to a computer           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals             Understanding printer menus    Menu item   Delete Log  Delete now  Do not delete    184    Description    Specifies whether audit logs are deleted    Note  Delete Now is the factory default setting        Configure Log  Enable Audit  Enable Remote Syslog  Remote Syslog Facility       Severity of events to log    Specifies whether and how the audit logs are created    Note  Factory default settings enable the security audit log           Thi       Set Date Time menu    Menu item    View Date Time    Description    Lets you view the current date and time settings for the printer       Set Date Time   lt input date time gt     Note  Date Time is set in YYYY MM DD HH MM format        Time Zone   lt list of time zones gt     Note  GMT is the factory default setting        Observe DST    Note  On is the factory default setting and uses the applicable Daylight Saving Time          r    On associated with the Time Zone setting   Off  Enable NTP Enables Network Time Protocol  which synchronizes the clocks of devices on a  On network  Off Note  On is the factory default setting           M       Downloaded From
12.      The printer sends page   n   of the fax job  where   n   is the number of the page sent  Wait for the message to clear     Serial   x      The printer is using a serial cable connection  The serial port is the active communication link     Set clock    The clock is not set  This message appears if no other fax status message appears  It remains until the clock is set     SMTP server not set up  Contact system administrator     An error occurred on the SMTP server  or the SMTP server is not configured properly  Touch Continue to clear the  message  If the message appears again  contact your system support person     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 241    Some held jobs were not restored  Touch Continue to delete the specified job     Note  Some held jobs are not restored  They stay on the hard disk and are inaccessible     System busy  preparing resources for job     Not all resources needed for the job are available  Wait for the message to clear     System busy  preparing resources for job  Deleting held job s      Not all resources needed for the job are available  Some held jobs are deleted to free system memory  Wait for the  message to clear     Unsupported disk    An unsupported printer hard disk has been installed  Remove the unsupported device  and then install a supported  one     Unsupported USB device  please remove    Remove the unrecognized USB device     Unsupported USB hub  please remove    Remove the unrecog
13.     57 Configuration change  held jobs were not restored    Since the time the jobs were stored on the printer hard disk something has changed in the printer to invalidate the  held jobs  Possible changes include       The printer firmware has been updated     Paper input  output  or duplex options needed for the print job were removed     The print job was created using data from a device in the USB port and the device is no longer in the port       The printer hard disk contains jobs that were stored while installed in a different printer model     Touch Continue to clear the message     58 Too many bins attached   1 Turn the printer power off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Remove the additional bins    4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Turn the printer power back on     58 Too many disks installed   1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Remove the extra disks    4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Turn the printer back on     58 Too many flash options installed  1 Turn the printer off   2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet     3 Remove the excess flash memory     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages    4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Turn the printer back on     58 Too many trays attached   1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Remove the addition
14.     In Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier    a  b  c    From the Go menu  choose Applications   Double click Internet Connect     From the toolbar  click AirPort     7 From the Network pop up menu  select your wireless network     Configure your computer to use the printer wirelessly    52    To print to a network printer  each Macintosh user must install a custom PostScript Printer Description  PPD  file and  create a printer in the Print Center or Printer Setup Utility     1 Install a PPD file on the computer     a  b  c  d  e  f  g  h    Insert the Software and Documentation CD in the CD or DVD drive     Double click the installer package for the printer   From the Welcome screen  click Continue     Click Continue again after viewing the Readme file     Click Continue after viewing the license agreement  and then click Agree to accept the terms of the agreement     Select a Destination  and then click Continue   From the Easy Install screen  click Install     Type the user password  and then click OK   All necessary software is installed on the computer     Click Close when installation is complete     2 Add the printer     a    For IP printing     In Mac OS X version 10 5   1 From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   2 Click Print  amp  Fax    3 Click      4 Select the printer from the list    5 Click Add     In Mac OS X version 10 4  1 From the Go menu  choose Applications   2 Double click Utilities     3 Locate and double click Printer Setup Utility or Print Cente
15.     Menu item    Card Stock Loading  Duplex  Off    161    Description    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Card Stock as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Recycled Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Recycled as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Labels Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Labels as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Vinyl Labels Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Vinyl Labels as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Bond Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Bond as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Letterhead Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Letterhead as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Preprinted Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Preprinted as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Colored Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Colored as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Light L
16.     Menu item Description   Double Ring Answers calls with a double ring pattern  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off   Triple Ring Answers calls with a triple ring pattern  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off          M       Fax Mode  Fax Server Setup  menu    Fax Server mode sends the fax job to a fax server for transmission           Fax Server Setup    Menu item Description  To Format Lets you enter the information using the virtual keyboard on the printer touch screen  Reply Address  Subject  Message  Primary SMTP Gateway Specifies SMTP server port information  Note  25 is the default SMTP gateway port   Secondary SMTP Gateway Specifies SMTP server port information    Note  25 is the default SMTP gateway port        Image Format  PDF   pdf   XPS   xps   TIFF   tif     Specifies the image type for scan to fax       Content  Text  Text Photo  Photograph    Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to fax    Notes       Text is used when the document is mostly text       Text Photo is the factory default setting  Text Photo is used when the  documents are mostly text or line art       Photograph is used when the document is a high quality photograph or inkjet             r    print   Fax Resolution Specifies the resolution level for scan to fax  Standard  Fine  Super Fine  Ultra Fine  Darkness Lightens or darkens the output  1 9          Note  5 factory default setting     M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understan
17.     Notes       19 mm is the factory default setting          Margin size can be increased in 1 mm increments        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 230    Menu item Description             Backgrounds Specifies whether to print backgrounds on HTML documents  Do Not Print Note  Print is the factory default setting   Print   Image menu   Menu item Description   Auto Fit Selects the optimal paper size  scaling  and orientation  On Notes   Off      On is the factory default setting       The On setting overrides scaling and orientation settings for some images        Invert Inverts bi tonal monochrome images  On Notes   Off    e Off is the factory default setting     The font size can be increased in 1 point increments       This setting does not apply to GIF or JPEG images           Scaling Scales the image to fit the selected paper size  Anchor Top Left Notes   Best Fit  Anchor Center   Best Fit is the factory default setting   Fit Height Width   When Auto Fit is set to On  Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit   Fit Height  Fit Width  Orientation Sets the image orientation  Portrait Note  Portrait is the factory default setting   Landscape    Rev Portrait  Rev Landscape                   M  d  XPS menu  Menu item Description  Print Error Pages Prints a page containing information on errors  including XML markup errors  Off Note  Off is the factory default setting   On       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Unders
18.     Push all trays in firmly after loading paper     Paper recommendations    Use only recommended paper or specialty media  For more information  see    Paper types and weights supported  by the printer    on page 90     Do not load wrinkled  creased  damp  bent  or curled paper    Flex  fan  and straighten paper before loading it    Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand    Do not mix paper sizes  weights  or types in the same stack    Make sure all sizes and types are set correctly in the printer control panel menus     Store paper per the manufacturer s recommendations     Envelope recommendations    To reduce wrinkling  use the Envelope Enhance menu in the Paper menu    Do not feed envelopes that        Have excessive curl or twist       Have windows  holes  perforations  cutouts  or embossing       Have metal clasps  string ties  or folding bars       Have an interlocking design       Have postage stamps attached       Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position      Have bent corners       Have rough  cockle  or laid finishes        Are stuck together or damaged in any way    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 141    Understanding jam numbers and locations    When a jam occurs  a message indicating the jam location appears  Open doors and covers and remove trays to access  jam locations  To resolve any paper jam message  you must clear all jammed paper from the paper path     The following table
19.    5 Load the stack of envelopes flap side down     Warning   Potential Damage  Never use envelopes with stamps  clasps  snaps  windows  coated linings  or  self stick adhesives  These envelopes may severely damage the printer     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 83       Note  Do not exceed the maximum stack height by forcing paper under the stack height limiter   6 Adjust the width guide to lightly touch the edge of the paper stack   7 Lower the envelope weight to touch the paper stack     8 From the printer control panel  set the Paper Size and Paper Type   Linking and unlinking trays    Linking trays    Tray linking is useful for large print jobs or multiple copies  When one linked tray is empty  paper feeds from the next  linked tray  When the Paper Size and Paper Type settings are the same for any trays  the trays are automatically linked     The printer automatically senses the Paper Size setting according to the position of the paper guides in each tray except  the multipurpose feeder  The printer can sense A4  A5  JIS B5  Letter  Legal  Executive  and Universal paper sizes  The  multipurpose feeder and trays using other paper sizes can be linked manually using the Paper Size menu available from    the Paper Size Type menu     Note  To link the multipurpose feeder  Configure MP must be set to Cassette in the Paper menu in order for MP  Feeder Size to appear as a menu item     The Paper Type setting must be set for all 
20.    Delete the print job  and then print it again       For PDF documents  recreate the PDF and then print it again     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 266    IVIAKE SURE THE PRINTER HAS SUFFICIENT MEMORY    Free up additional printer memory by scrolling through the list of held jobs and deleting some of them     Job takes longer than expected to print    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     REDUCE THE COMPLEXITY OF THE PRINT JOB    Eliminate the number and size of fonts  the number and complexity of images  and the number of pages in the job     CHANGE THE PAGE PROTECT SETTING TO OFF     uy    Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears    On the home screen  touch         Touch Settings    Touch General Settings    Touch the down arrow until Print Recovery appears    Touch Print Recovery    Touch the right arrow next to Page Protect until Off appears     Touch Submit     O on OO Ui A W N       Touch A     Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper    CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     Incorrect characters print  MAKE SURE THE PRINTER IS NOT IN HEX TRACE 
21.    When  Original Size  is set to Auto Size Sense  the scanner automatically determines the size of the original  document     Sides  Duplex     This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex  printed on one side  or duplex  printed on both  sides   This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the document     Orientation    This option tells the printer whether the original document is in portrait or landscape orientation and then changes the  Sides and Binding settings to match the original document orientation     Binding    Tells the printer whether the original document is bound on the long edge or short edge side     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to an FTP address 125    Resolution    This option adjusts the output quality of your file  Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the time  needed to scan your original document  Image resolution can be decreased to reduce the file size     Send As    This option sets the output  PDF  TIFF  JPEG or XPS  for the scanned image     PDF   Creates a single file with multiple pages  viewable with Adobe Reader  Adobe Reader is provided free by  Adobe at www adobe com     Secure PDF   Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access    TIFF   Creates multiple files or a single file  If Multi page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  Web Server  then TIFF saves one page in each file  Th
22.    ae S   wale ERI SU  were ep anri wur venf  w vd Safer wed eg few arte wire  fares frere ar fad  wies SEIS UIT GET d Gea p deu    ve fare A Nerf 4 fafratar fere ei Bl       viT de                                                       ab c                                                    Noise emission levels    The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO 9296     Note  Some modes may not apply to your product     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 297                Printing 56 dBA   Scanning 52 dBA   Copying 56 dBA    Ready 30 dBA J             Values are subject to change  See www lexmark com for current values     Temperature information         Ambient temperature 15 6C       32 2C               Shipping and storage temperature  40 0C     60 0C          Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment  WEEE  directive    The WEEE logo signifies specific recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the European  Union  We encourage the recycling of our products  If you have further questions about recycling options  visit the  Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com for your local sales office phone number     Product disposal    Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste  Consult your local authorities  for disposal and recycling options     Federal Communications Commission  FCC  compliance information statement    This eq
23.   Canada  1 800 539 6275 Note  For additional information about    contacting Lexmark  see the printed   Dem  8 00 AM 11 00 PM warranty that came with your printer    ET   Saturday  Noon   6 00 PM ET    Mexico  001 888 377 0063   Monday Friday  8 00 AM    8 00 PM ET     Note  Telephone numbers and support  times may change without notice  For the  most recent telephone numbers available   see the printed warranty statement that  came with your printer                    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer 15    Description Where to find  North America  Where to find  rest of world        E mail support For e mail support  visit our Web site  E mail support varies by country or region   www lexmark com  and may not be available in some instances   1 Click SUPPORT  Visit our Web site at www lexmark com     Select a country or region  and then select    Click Technical Support   the Customer Support link     Select your printer type   Note  For additional information about  contacting Lexmark  see the printed    From the Support Tools section  click   warranty that came with your printer   e Mail Support     2  3  4 Select your printer model   5    6 Complete the form  and then click  Submit Request                    Printer configurations    Note  Printer configuration may vary depending on your printer model     Basic models          Automatic Document Feeder  ADF        Printer control panel       Standard exit bin       Multipurpose f
24.   Default  SOUrCe merui aa e a eee ni M ER Ni M RI ES E EREE RRE ERE 153  Paper Size  Type neni eea EENE A ege REV obs aice ne ene 153    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 8    Configure MP mefill   desinere retrieve e Hoe REC aeaiee aa R aeiae o Yep e d Eu Eo PEDE TERR HAY Ee IUE dee Td Ya 156  Envelope Enlidh6e   ete er dere E E decane bonitas ias reset E upe vds UR poke aoe eee 157  Substit  te Size MENU   sies cete e btedut ite rro s ere a E abide Ei be aired fede iut eui reds cita eerta 157  Paper Textures sinl e                                157  Paper Weight MOMU ETE D TU ELE 159  Paper Eodading miento ui on e relate i aedes d eoe Gebote ages bud inde Ga sce dul ta Gola sa Peli    epos dr ese Evo e YET 161  CUSTOM TYPES MEMU ysis aseaine aadar nna a o     162  Custorm Names menu    eap e ete ainia dots pert Ee EEEE EREE EA NAE EEEE ER EERE 162  Custom Scan SIZES  MENU 5 25 22  aroi neea niaaa iana TR RYE aa aa FERE REX REA Ro A NaRa aaar ATEENA iai 163  Custom Bin Names MENU      sssssssssssssssressresrssssssssssssssresterettresssstsetttetttesstesssssessssessssttesttteeeteeesssseoseteeesesesssesesene 163  Universal Setup  men  eina ct aed capat EE ia eH ERR E RR Eo ER PREISE RR e REA CAR ed 163  Bin  Setup DATUR RT                   164  RE POPES men  k iyccis ssc EP 165  Network Ports M nu     ccccccccccccssssssccecccceccsessesceecccsecssaussseecececeesecsssuseseceucecssaueseuseceecessssessesuusansasaseeeese 167  Active NIC moenia cce se crear
25.   Image menu 230  Insert staple cartridge 234  Insert Tray   x   235  Install bin   xx   235  Install envelope feeder 235  Install tray   xx   235  installation  wireless network 49  50  installing  options in driver 47  printer software 46  installing printer software  adding options 47  Internal Solutions Port  installing 32  troubleshooting 278    310    Internal Solutions Port  network  changing port settings 56   Invalid PIN 235   IPv6 menu 172    J  jams  avoiding 140  locating doors and trays 141  locations 141  numbers 141  jams  clearing  200 141  201 141  202 143  230   239 144  240   249 145  250 146  260 147  270 279 147  280   289 paper jams 147  283 staple jams 148  290   294 150  stapler 148  job interrupt 101  Job stored for delayed  transmission 236    L    labels  tips on using 133  letterhead  copying to 95  loading  2000 sheet tray 75  loading  multipurpose feeder 79  loading  trays 72  tips on using 131  LexLink menu 174  light  indicator 18  Line busy 236  linking trays 83  Load   src   with   x   236  Load manual feeder with   x   236  Load staples 236  loading  2000 sheet tray 75  250 sheet tray  standard or  optional  72  550 sheet tray  standard or  optional  72  card stock 79    Index    envelopes 79  81   letterhead in 2000 sheet tray 75   letterhead in multipurpose  feeder 79   letterhead in trays 72   multipurpose feeder 79   transparencies 79    M    Macintosh  wireless network installation 50  maintenance kit  ordering 256  memory card  install
26.   On is the factory default setting  The background of the  image will be removed        Allow Custom Job Scans  On  Off    Lets you scan multiple jobs to one file    Note  On is the factory default setting  If On is selected  the Allow  Custom Job Scans setting can be enabled for specific jobs        Scanner Jam Recovery  Job level  Page level    Specifies how a scanned job should be reloaded if a paper jam  occurs in the ADF    Notes      f Job level is selected  the entire job must be rescanned if  any pages jam        f Page level is selected  rescan from the jammed page  forward        Web Page Refresh Rate  30 300    Specifies the number of seconds between Embedded Web Server  refreshes    Note  120 seconds is the factory default setting           Contact Name       Specifies a contact name for the printer    Note  The contact name will be stored on the Embedded Web  Server           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       190       Menu item Description  Location Specifies the location of the printer   Note  The location will be stored on the Embedded Web Server   Alarms Sets an alarm to sound when the printer requires operator    Alarm Control    intervention             Cartridge Alarm Available selections for each alarm type are   Staple Alarm Off  Single  Continuous  Notes     Single is the factory default setting for Alarm Control  Single  sounds three quick beeps     Off is the factory default setting for Toner Alarm and
27.   and then enter the recipient s telephone number or shortcut number  or  search the address book     Note  To place a dial pause within a fax number  press      The dial pause appears as a comma in the    Fax to   box  Use this feature if you need to dial an outside line first     5 Touch Fax It     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 114    Sending a fax using the computer    Faxing from a computer lets you send electronic documents without leaving your desk  This gives you the flexibility of  faxing documents directly from software programs     Note  In order to perform this function from your computer  you must use the PostScript printer driver for your  printer     1 From your software program  click File  gt  Print    2 From the Print window  select your printer  and then click Properties   3 Choose the Other Options tab  and then click Fax    4 Click OK  and then click OK again    5 On the Fax screen  type the name and number of the fax recipient     6 Click Send     Creating shortcuts    Creating a fax destination shortcut using the Embedded Web Server    Instead of entering the entire phone number of a fax recipient on the printer control panel each time you want to send  a fax  you can create a permanent fax destination and assign a shortcut number  A shortcut can be created to a single  fax number or a group of fax numbers     1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of 
28.   dealers in your area  In other countries or regions  visit the Lexmark Web Site at www lexmark com or contact the place  where you purchased the printer     Note  All life estimates for printer supplies assume printing on letter  or A4 size plain paper     Ordering print cartridges  When 88 Cartridge low appears or when the print becomes faded   1 Remove the print cartridge     2 Firmly shake the cartridge side to side and front to back several times to redistribute toner     Zs       3 Reinsert the cartridge and continue printing     Note  Repeat this procedure multiple times until the print remains faded  and then replace the cartridge     Lexmark Return Program Regular cartridge  Cartridge    Recommended print cartridges and part numbers       For the US and Canada                   Print cartridge X651A11A X651A21A  High Yield Print Cartridge X651H11A X651H21A  Extra High Yield Print Cartridge X654X11A X654X21A  High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X651H04A Not applicable  Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications   X654X04A Not applicable       For Europe  the Middle East  and Africa                   Print cartridge X651A21E X651A11E  High Yield Print Cartridge X651H21E X651H11E  Extra High Yield Print Cartridge X654X21E X654X11E  High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X651H04E Not applicable  Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications   X654X04E Not applicab
29.   itis the preferred option when there is a great deal of distance between the printer and computer or when an interface  with a better transfer rate is not available     After installing the serial port  you will need to configure the printer and the computer so they can communicate  Make  sure you have connected the serial cable to the serial port on your printer     1 Set the parameters in the printer   a From the printer control panel  navigate to the menu with port settings   b Locate the submenu with serial port settings   c Make any necessary changes to the serial settings   d Save the new settings   e    Print a menu settings page     2 Install the printer driver     a Insert the Software and Documentation CD  It launches automatically   If the CD does not launch automatically  do one of the following     In Windows Vista    1 Click e    2 Inthe Start Search box  type D   setup exe  where Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive     In Windows XP and earlier  1 Click Start   2 Click Run   3 Type D   setup  exe  where Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive   Click Install Printer and Software   Click Agree to accept the Printer Software License Agreement   Click Custom   Make sure Select Components is selected  and then click Next   Make sure Local is selected  and then click Next     Select the manufacturer of the printer from the menu     zz a   0 aana c    Select the printer model from the menu  and then click Add Printer   i Click the   beside the printer model under
30.   type D   setup  exe  where Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 54    In Windows XP and earlier   a Click Start    b Click Run    c Type D  setup  exe  where D is the letter of your CD or DVD drive     2 Click Install Printer and Software   3 Click Agree to agree to the License Agreement   4 Select Suggested  and then click Next     Note  To configure the printer using a static IP address  using IPv6  or to configure printers using scripts  select  Custom and follow the on screen instructions     Select Wired Network Attach  and then click Next   Select the printer manufacturer from the list     Select the printer model from the list  and then click Next     on oO Uu    Select the printer from the list of printers discovered on the network  and then click Finish     Note  If your configured printer does not appear in the list of discovered printers  click Add Port and follow the  on screen instructions     9 Follow the on screen instructions to complete the installation     For Macintosh users  1 Allow the network DHCP server to assign an IP address to the printer     2 Print the network setup page from the printer  For information on printing a network setup page  see  Printing a  network setup page  on page 46     3 Locate the printer IP address in the TCP IP section of the network setup page  You will need the IP address if you  are configuring access for computers on a different subnet than 
31.  1 in   thick     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer 18    Understanding the printer control panel    1       CC C      e    4                               LILA   V       5  ang  8 7    Item Description  1 Display View scanning  copying  faxing  and printing options as well as status and error messages   2 Keypad Enter numbers or symbols on the display        3   Dial Pause   Press       to cause a two  or three second dial pause in a fax number  In the Fax To field  a  Dial Pause is represented by a comma           jJ   From the home screen  press       to redial a fax number       The button functions only within the Fax menu or with fax functions  When outside of the  Fax menu  fax function  or home screen  pressing       causes an error beep        4 Back In the Copy menu  press to delete the right most digit of the value in the Copy Count  The  default value of 1 appears if the entire number is deleted by pressing numerous times     1    In the Fax Destination List  press to delete the right most digit of a number entered  manually  You can also press to delete an entire shortcut entry  Once an entire line is  deleted  another press of causes the cursor to move up one line     In the E mail Destination List  press to delete the character to the left of the cursor  If the  character is in a shortcut  then the shortcut is deleted        5   Home Press to return to the home screen                         Downloaded From ManualsPrint
32.  10 4 and earlier    1     o o dou BW N    B  eo    Note  If the printer doesn t show up in the list  you may need to add it using the IP address  Contact your    From the Go menu  choose Applications   Double click Utilities    Double click Print Center or Printer Setup Utility   From the Printer List  click Add    Choose the Default Browser tab    Click More Printers    From the first pop up menu  choose AppleTalk     From the second pop up menu  select Local AppleTalk zone     Select the printer from the list   Click Add     system support person for assistance     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       55    Additional printer setup 56    Changing port settings after installing a new network Internal  Solutions Port    When a new network Lexmark Internal Solutions Port  ISP  is installed in the printer  the printer configurations on  computers that access the printer must be updated because the printer will be assigned a new IP address  All computers  that access the printer must be updated with this new IP address in order to print to it over the network     Notes        fthe printer has a static IP address that will stay the same  then you do not need to make any changes to the  computer configurations        fthe computers are configured to print to the printer by a network name that will stay the same  instead of by  IP address  then you do not need to make any changes to the computer configurations        f you are adding a wireless ISP to a printer previou
33.  2 Click Links  amp  Index   3 Click Set Date and Time   4 Click inside the Manually Set Date  amp  Time box  and then enter the current date and time     5 Click Submit     Turning Daylight Saving Time on  The printer can be set to automatically adjust for Daylight Saving Time  DST    1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Links  amp  Index    3 Click Set Date and Time    4 Select Automatically Observe DST   5 Click Submit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 71    Loading paper and specialty media    This section explains how to load the 250   500   and 2000 sheet trays  and the multipurpose feeder  It also includes  information about paper orientation  setting the Paper Size and Paper Type  and linking and unlinking trays     Setting the Paper Size and Paper Type    The Paper Size setting is determined by the position of the paper guides in the tray for all trays except the multipurpose  feeder  The Paper Size setting for the multipurpose feeder must be set manually  The factory default Paper Type setting  is Plain Paper  The Paper Type setting must be set manually for all trays that do not contain plain paper     1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears    2 On the home screen  touch         3 Touch Paper Menu    4 Touch Paper Size 
34.  56  PostScript menu 226  Power Saver  adjusting 262  print job  canceling from Macintosh 138  canceling from Windows 138  print quality  cleaning the scanner glass 251  print quality test pages   printing 137  print quality troubleshooting  blank pages 280  characters have jagged edges 280  clipped images 281  ghost images 281  gray background 282  poor transparency quality 290  print irregularities 283  print is too dark 286  print is too light 285  print quality test pages 279  repeating defects 284  skewed print 284  solid black streaks 285  solid color pages 287  solid white streaks 285  streaked vertical lines 288  toner fog or background  shading 288  toner rubs off 289  toner specks 289  print troubleshooting  error reading USB drive 264    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       held jobs do not print 265  incorrect characters print 266  incorrect margins 282  jammed page does not  reprint 279  job prints from wrong tray 266  job prints on wrong paper 266  job takes longer than  expected 266  jobs do not print 265  Large jobs do not collate 267  multiple language PDFs do not  print 264  paper curl 283  paper frequently jams 278  tray linking does not work 267  unexpected page breaks  occur 267  printer  configurations 15  minimum clearances 16  259  models 15  moving 258  259  selecting a location 16  setting up in new location 259  shipping 259  printer control panel 18  factory defaults  restoring 262  printer hard disk  installing 38  printer messages  15
35.  Card  Custom Scan Size  lt x gt   A4   AS   Oficio  Mexico    A6   JIS B5   Book Original   Auto Size Sense  Mixed Letter Legal    Menu item Description   Color Specifies whether a job prints in grayscale or color  Gray Note  Gray is the factory default setting    Color   Resolution Specifies how many dots per inch are scanned  75 Note  150 dpi is the factory default setting    150  200  300  400  600   Darkness Lightens or darkens the output  1 9 Note  5 is the factory default setting    Orientation Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  Portrait Note  Portrait is the factory default setting   Landscape   Original Size Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  Letter Note  Letter is the US factory default setting  A4 is the international factory default  Legal setting    Executive  Folio  Statement  Universal  4x 6in   3x5 in        Sides  Duplex   Off  Long edge  Short edge       Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  Notes       Off is the factory default setting       Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page  left edge for  portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation        Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page  top edge for          portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation         Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item    JPEG Quality  Best for content  5 90       209    Description    Sets th
36.  Click Fax Holding Schedule     b From the Action menu  select Hold faxes     c From the Time menu  select the time you want the held faxes released     d From the Day s  menu  select the day you want the held faxes released     9 Click Add     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 121    Forwarding a fax  This option lets you print and forward received faxes to a fax number  e mail address  FTP site  or LDSS   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     Click Settings   Click Fax Settings     Click Analog Fax Setup     uU A U   N    From the Fax Forwarding menu  select one of the following     Print    Print and Forward    Forward   6 From the  Forward to  menu  select one of the following      Fax     E mail   e FTP     LDSS     eSF    7 Click inside the Forward to Shortcut box  and then enter the shortcut number where you want the fax forwarded     Note  The shortcut number must be a valid shortcut number for the setting that was selected in the  Forward  to  menu     8 Click Submit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to an FTP address 122    Scanning to an FTP address    ADF Scanner glass             Use the ADF for multiple page documents    Use the scanner glass for single pages  small items  such as postcards or  photos   transparencies  photo paper  or t
37.  Guide 260  emission  notices 293  294  295  296  enlarging a copy 97  Envelope Enhance 157  envelopes  loading 79 81  tips on using 132    309    Ethernet networking  Macintosh 53  Windows 53  Ethernet port 44  exterior of the printer  cleaning 251  e mail  canceling 110  notice of low supply level 260  notice of paper jam 260  notice of paper needed 260  notice that different paper is  needed 260  e mail function  setting up 106  e mail screen  advanced options 111  options 110  111  E mail Settings menu 206  e mailing  adding message line 109  adding subject line 109  changing output file type 109  configuring the e mail  settings 107  creating shortcuts using the  Embedded Web Server 107  creating shortcuts using the touch  screen 107  setting up e mail function 106  using shortcut numbers 108  using the address book 108  using the touch screen 108    F    factory defaults  restoring   printer control panel menus 262  fax card   installing 42  Fax failed 233  Fax memory full 234  Fax Mode  Analog Fax Setup   menu 197  Fax Mode  Fax Server Setup   menu 205  Fax partition inoperative  Contact  system administrator  234  fax quality  improving 120  fax screen   advanced options 119   options 118  119    Index    Fax server  To Format  not set up   Contact system administrator  234  Fax Station Name not set up 234  Fax Station Number not set up 234  fax troubleshooting  blocking junk faxes 117  caller ID is not shown 272  can receive but not send  faxes 274  can send but not 
38.  Have postage stamps attached        Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 133        Have bent corners      Have rough  cockle  or laid finishes    Adjust the width guide to fit the width of the envelopes     Note  A combination of high humidity  over 6096  and the high printing temperature may wrinkle or seal envelopes     Tips on using labels    Print samples on the labels being considered for use before buying large quantities     Notes       Paper  dual web paper  polyester  and vinyl labels are supported      When using the duplex unit  specially designed  integrated  and dual web paper labels are supported      Printing labels requires a special label fuser cleaner which is included with the special cartridge required for  label applications  For more information  see  Ordering supplies  on page 255     For detailed information on label printing  characteristics  and design  see the Card Stock  amp  Label Guide available on  the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com publications   When printing on labels      Feed labels from a 250 sheet tray  a 550 sheet tray  or the multipurpose feeder      Use labels designed specifically for laser printers  Check with the manufacturer or vendor to verify that         The labels can withstand temperatures up to 230  C  446  F  without sealing  excessive curling  wrinkling  or  releasing hazardous emissions         Label adhesives  face s
39.  Manuals       Additional printer setup 37    9 Attach the two provided screws to secure the ISP mounting bracket to the system board cage             LEE  Q                      10 Tighten the long thumbscrew   Note  Do not overtighten the thumbscrew   11 Insert the plug of the ISP interface cable into the receptacle of the system board     Note  The plugs and receptacles are color coded              12 Ifa printer hard disk was previously installed  then attach the printer hard disk to the ISP  For more information   see  Installing a printer hard disk  on page 38     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 38    13 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door           Installing a printer hard disk  The optional printer hard disk can be installed with or without a Lexmark Internal Solutions Port  ISP    Note  This operation requires a flathead screwdriver     A CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well     and unplug any cables going into the printer     Warning   Potential Damage  System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity  Touch  something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic co
40.  ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 185    Settings menu    General Settings menu      Menu item Description    Display Language Sets the language of the text appearing on the display  English Note  All languages may not be available for all printers   Francais  Deutsch  Italiano  Espanol  Dansk  Norsk  Nederlands  Svenska  Portuguese  Suomi  Russian  Polski  Magyar  Turkce  Cesky  Simplified Chinese  Traditional Chinese                Korean  Japanese  Eco Mode Minimizes the use of energy  paper  or specialty media  off Notes   Energy          Energy Paper   Off is the factory default setting  Off resets the printer to its  factory default settings   Paper     The Energy setting minimizes the power used by the printer   Performance may be affected but not print quality      Paper minimizes the amount of paper and specialty media  needed for a print job by duplexing each page  Performance  may be affected but not print quality      Energy Paper minimizes the use of power and of paper and  specialty media    ADF Loaded Beep Specifies whether the ADF emits a beep when paper is loaded  Enabled Note  Disabled is the factory default setting   Disabled       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer menus    a    Menu item    Quiet Mode  Off  On    186    Description    Reduces the amount of noise produced by the printer  Notes     e Off is the factory default setting       On configures the printer to produce as little nois
41.  Network headings     Print job    Copy job    Fax profile  e FTP    E mail send    Each heading has a list of jobs shown in a column under it which can show only three  jobs per screen  Each job appears as a button which you can touch to access  information about the job  If more than three jobs exist in a column  then an arrow  appears enabling you to scroll through the jobs        Continue       Touch this button when more changes need to be made for a job or after clearing  a paper jam                 Cancel   Cancels an action or a selection    Cancels out of a screen and returns to the previous screen  Select Selects a menu or menu item          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Learning about the printer    Features    a    Menu trail line     Menus  gt  Settings  gt  Copy Settings  gt   Number of Copies       Feature    24    Description    A Menu trail line is located at the top of each menu screen  This feature acts as a  trail  showing the path taken to arrive at the current menu  It gives the exact location  within the menus     Touch any of the underlined words to return to that menu or menu item   The Number of Copies is not underlined since this is the current screen  If you touch  an underlined word on the Number of Copies screen before the Number of Copies    is set and saved  then the selection is not saved  and it does not become the user  default setting        Attendance message alert          If an attendance message occurs which closes
42.  Print  amp  Fax  and then double click the printer icon    3 From the printer window  select the job to cancel    4 From the icon bar at the top of the window  click the Delete icon   In Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier    1 From the Go menu  choose Applications    2 Double click Utilities  and then double click Print Center or Printer Setup Utility     3 Double click the printer icon     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 139    4 From the printer window  select the job to cancel     5 From the icon bar at the top of the window  click the Delete icon     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 140    Clearing jams    Jam error messages appear on the control panel display and include the area of the printer where the jam occurred   When there is more than one jam  the number of jammed pages is displayed     Avoiding jams    The following hints can help you avoid jams     Paper tray recommendations    Make sure the paper lies flat in the tray   Do not remove trays while the printer is printing     Do not load trays  the multipurpose feeder  or the envelope feeder while the printer is printing  Load them prior  to printing  or wait for a prompt to load them     Do not load too much paper  Make sure the stack height does not exceed the indicated maximum height     Make sure the guides in the paper trays  multipurpose feeder  or envelope feeder are properly positioned and are  not pressing too tightly against the paper or envelopes 
43.  RR ee E o ee dede RR TREE Decal 60  CHOOSING a TAX  COMMCCEION MR E                                                M       60    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 3    Using am RJ11 adapter sn nanana a p a inari raiba eaa a seat oi iiaa ao aeaii 61  Connecting directly to a telephone wall jack in Germany            cccccssscccesssssseeecessseeseeescssseecesseseseeesesesseeeseeees 64  CONNECTING toa telephone  aret erae Eae i ide aaa eiaa ape anar reae E RE daria 65  Connecting to an answering MACHING              ccsssccesssesseeecessssnsecescessueececessessececcsseeeeseseseaseeeeceseasesuasessessnneeeeens 66  Connecting to a computer with a MOCEM            ccccesssssececcessnsceecesceesseececesessaseeecesseasasecsessueeeseeseaaaseeenseeseaeaeeens 68  Setting the outgoing fax name and NUMDEL            cccccesccccsssssnsccescsssseececessessececesesssaeecescserseseeseseseeeseeeseseaeeees 69  Setting the date  and time  cedit tr dee ihi Dag na od Pa oda De RE ea aa ai Ea Fg a RARE RAN IS PARE FARA 4 RU CA TR cd ga 70  Turning Daylight Saving Time on           ccccccesesssceecssssseceeeessessseececssuseeescseasececessessseeeesseesusesecsseseaseseeeeessseenaeeeseses 70    Loading paper and specialty media                                            eeeeeee eese 71    Setting the Paper Size and Paper Type            cccccessccceceseneceeeceeeeececeecesceeaeeeeseaaeeceeseeeaeeceeseanaeeeeesnennaeeeees 71  Configuring Universal paper SettingS               c
44.  Select Components     j Make sure the correct port is available under Select Components  This is the port where the serial cable attaches  to the computer  If the correct port is not available  select the port under the Select Port menu  and then click  Add Port     k Make any configuration changes necessary in the Add a New Port window  Click Add Port to finish adding the  port     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 59      Make sure the box next to the selected printer model is checked   m Select any other optional software you want to install  and then click Next     n Click Finish to complete the printer software installation   3 Set the COM port parameters     After the printer driver is installed  you must set the serial parameters in the communications  COM  port assigned  to the printer driver   The serial parameters in the COM port must match the serial parameters you set in the printer     a Openthe Device Manager  Do one of the following     In Windows Vista    1 Click e    2 Click Control Panel    3 Click System and Maintenance   4 Click System    5 Click Device Manager     In Windows XP   1 Click Start    2 Click Control Panel    3 Click Performance and Maintenance    4 Click System    5 From the Hardware tab  click Device Manager     In Windows 2000   1 Click Start    2 Click Settings    Control Panel    3 Click System    4 From the Hardware tab  click Device Manager     Click   to expand the list of available ports   Sele
45.  Staple  Alarm  Off means no alarm will sound     Continuous repeats three beeps every 10 seconds     Staple Alarm is available only when the finisher is installed   Timeouts Sets the amount of time the printer waits for user intervention  Job Hold Timeout before it holds jobs that require unavailable resources and  Disabled continues to print other jobs in the print queue  5 255 Notes     30 seconds is the factory default setting     This menu item appears only when a printer hard disk is  installed   Timeouts Specifies the number of minutes of inactivity before the system  Standby Mode enters a lower power state  Disabled Note  15 minutes is the factory default setting   2 240  Timeouts Specifies the number of minutes of inactivity before some systems    Power Saver Mode    begin entering a minimum power state           Disabled Notes   2 240    60 minutes is the factory default setting     Power Saver does not interact with Standby Mode   Timeouts Sets the amount of time in seconds the printer waits before    Screen Timeout  15 300       returning the printer display to a Ready state       Note  30 seconds is the factory default setting        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       191       Menu item Description  Timeouts Sets the amount of time in seconds the printer waits to receive an  Print Timeout end of job message before canceling the remainder of the print job  Disabled Notes   1 255     90 seconds is the factory default
46.  Touch the paper type arrows for the desired tray until the correct custom type appears   6 Touch the tray number or MP Feeder Type   7 Touch Submit     Changing a Custom Type   x   name    You can use the Embedded Web Server or MarkVision    to define a name other than Custom Type   x   for each of the  custom paper types that are loaded  When a Custom Type   x   name is changed  the menus display the new name  instead of Custom Type   x       To change a Custom Type   x   name from the Embedded Web Server   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings    3 Under Default Settings  click Paper Menu    4 Click Custom Names    5 Type a name for the paper type in a Custom Name   x   box     Note  This custom name will replace a custom type   x   name under the Custom Types and Paper Size Type  menus     6 Click Submit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media    7 Click Custom Types     Custom Types appears  followed by your custom name   8 Select a Paper Type setting from the list next to your custom name     9 Click Submit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       85    Paper and specialty media guidelines 86    Paper and specialty media guidelines    Paper guidelines    Selecting the correct paper or specialty media reduces printing p
47.  a function  such as copy or fax  then  a solid red dot appears over the function button on the home screen  This indicates  that an attendance message exists              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 25    Additional printer setup    Installing internal options    CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     You can customize your printer connectivity and memory capacity by adding optional cards  The instructions in this  section explain how to install the available cards  you can also use them to locate a card for removal     Available internal options    Memory cards      Printer memory      Flash memory      Fonts    Firmware cards      Bar Code and Forms       PDS and SCS TNe      PrintCryption         PRESCRIBE    Printer hard disk  e Lexmark   Internal Solutions Ports  ISP       RS 232 C Serial ISP      Parallel 1284 B ISP      MarkNet    N8150802 11 b g n Wireless ISP      MarkNet N8130 10 100 Fiber ISP      MarkNet N8120 10 100 1000 Ethernet ISP    MarkNet N8110 V 34 Fax Card    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 26    Accessing the system board to install 
48.  a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  On  Off  Background Removal Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy   4 to  4 Note  0 is the factory default setting   Auto Center Lets you automatically center the fax on the page  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Color Dropout Specifies which color to drop during faxing  and how much to increase or decrease  Color Dropout the dropout  None Notes   Red  SER   Noneis the factory default setting for Color Dropout   Blue   128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold   Default Red Threshold  0 255  Default Green Threshold  0 255  Default Blue Threshold  0 255  Contrast Specifies the contrast of the output  Best for content Note     Best for content    is the factory default setting   0 5  Mirror Image Creates a mirror image of the original document  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Negative Image Creates a negative image of the original document  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    a    Menu item    Shadow Detail  0 4    202    Description    Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a fax    Note  0 is the factory default setting        Scan edge to edge    Specifies if the original document is scanned edge to edge prior to faxing       On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off   Sharpness Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a fax  0 5    Note  3 is the 
49.  an icon of that overlay will be available     Content    This option enhances copy quality  Choose from Text  Text Photo  Photograph  or Printed Image     Text   Use this setting when copying original documents that are mostly text or line art     Text Photo   Use this setting when copying original documents that are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures     Photograph   Use this setting when copying an original document that is a high quality photograph or inkjet print       Printed Image   Usethis setting when copying halftone photographs  documents printed ona laser printer  or pages  from a magazine or newspaper     Advanced Duplex    This option controls whether the documents are one sided or two sided  what orientation your original documents  have  and how your documents are bound     Note  Some Advanced Duplex options may not be available on all printer models     Save as Shortcut    This option allows the current settings to be saved as a shortcut     Improving copy quality       Question Tip  When should I use Text   Use text mode when text preservation is the main goal of the copy  and preserving images  mode  copied from the original document is not a concern       Text mode is recommended for receipts  carbon copy forms  and documents that contain  only text or fine line art        When should I use   Use Text Photo mode when copying an original document that contains a mixture of text  Text Photo mode  and graphics       Text Photo mode is recommended for 
50.  an optional StapleSmart II Finisher With an optional StapleSmart II Finisher                                     Single sided printing  J       Single sided printing  M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media    Without an optional StapleSmart II Finisher With an optional StapleSmart II Finisher                              Duplex  two sided  printing Duplex  two sided  printing    P       Note  Notice the maximum fill line on the side of the tray which indicates the maximum height for loading  paper  Do not overload the tray              7 Insert the tray     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 79    Loading the multipurpose feeder    1 Pull down the multipurpose feeder door                                d    4 Flex the sheets of paper or specialty media back and forth to loosen them  and then fan them  Do not fold or crease  them  Straighten the edges on a level surface     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media       y  Paper       Envelopes       Transparencies                      Avoid touching the print side of transparencies  Be careful not to scratch them   X d       5 Load the paper or specialty media  Slide the stack gently into the multipurpose feeder until it comes to a stop                                            Single sided printing Single sided printing  s       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loadin
51.  and graphics       Text Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles  business graphics  and brochures        When should I use Photo   Use Photo mode when scanning photos printed on a laser printer or taken from a magazine or  mode  newspaper     X P                Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 131    Printing    This chapter covers printing  printer reports  and job cancelation  Selection and handling of paper and specialty media    can affect how reliably documents print  For more information  see    Avoiding jams    on page 140 and    Storing paper     on page 88     Printing a document    1 Load paper into a tray or feeder     2 From the printer control panel Paper menu  set the Paper Type and Paper Size to match the loaded paper     3 Do one of the following     For Windows users  a With a document open  click File  gt  Print     b Click Properties  Preferences  Options  or Setup  and then adjust the settings as needed     Note  To print on a specific size or type of paper  adjust the paper size or type settings to match the loaded  paper  or select the appropriate tray or feeder     C Click OK  and then click Print     For Macintosh users  a Customize the settings as needed in the Page Setup dialog   1 With a document open  choose File    Page Setup     2 Choose a paper size or create a custom size to match the loaded paper   3 Click OK     b Customize the settings as needed in the Print dialog   1 With a document open  choose File    Pr
52.  and printer at the same  time     Notes         Remove all printer options before moving the printer         Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it off the optional drawer     Warning   Potential Damage  Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer  warranty     Moving the printer to another location    The printer and options can be safely moved to another location by following these precautions       Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer  Any cart  used to move the options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the options       Keep the printer in an upright position       Avoid severe jarring movements     Setting the printer up in a new location    Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer                          1 Right Side   20 cm  8 in    2 LeftSide  31 cm  12 in    3 Front 51 cm  20 in    4 Rear 20 cm  8 in       5  Top 31 cm  12 in                    Shipping the printer    When shipping the printer  use the original packaging or call the place of purchase for a relocation kit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Administrative support 260    Administrative support    Finding advanced networking and administrator information    This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks  For more advanced system support tasks  see the Networking  Guide on the Software and Documentation CD 
53.  compliance statement    This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference Causing Equipment Standard  ICES 003     Avis de conformit   aux normes de l industrie du Canada    Cet appareil num  rique de classe A est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux   quipements  pouvant causer des interf  rences NMB 003     Industry Canada radio interference statement    Industry Canada  Canada     This device complies with Industry Canada specification RSS 210  Operation is subject to the following two conditions    1  this device may not cause interference  and  2  this device must accept any interference  including interference that  may cause undesired operation of the device     This device has been designed to operate only with the antenna provided  Use of any other antenna is strictly prohibited  per regulations of Industry Canada     To prevent radio interference to the licensed service  this device is intended to be operated indoors and away from  windows to provide maximum shielding  Equipment  or its transmit antenna  that is installed outdoors is subject to  licensing     The installer of this radio equipment must ensure that the antenna is located or pointed such that it does not emit RF  fields in excess of Health Canada limits for the general population  consult Safety Code 6  obtainable from Health  Canada s Web site www hc sc gc ca rpb     The term  IC   before the certification registration number only signifies that 
54.  component  allow the surface to cool before touching     A CAUTION   POTENTIAL INJURY  The printer weight is greater than 18 kg  40 Ib  and requires two or more  trained personnel to move it safely     CAUTION     POTENTIAL INJURY  Before moving the printer  follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  printer damage     Turn the printer off using the power switch  and then unplug the power cord from the wall outlet     Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it     Lift the printer off of the optional drawer and set it aside instead of trying to lift the drawer and printer at the same  time   Note  Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it off the optional drawer     Use only the power cord provided with this product or the manufacturer s authorized replacement     Use only the telecommunications  RJ 11  cord provided with this product or a 26 AWG or larger replacement when  connecting this product to the public switched telephone network     CAUTION     SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     A CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  Make sure that all external connections  such as Ethernet and telephone system 
55.  configure automatic tray linking  If the same size  and type of paper are in two trays and the Paper Size and Paper Type  settings match  then the trays are automatically linked  When one tray  is empty  the job prints using the linked tray       Automatic size sensing is not supported for Oficio  Folio  or Statement  paper sizes       The 2000 sheet tray supports A4  Letter  and Legal paper sizes        Description          1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off     Note  Only installed trays  drawers  and feeders are listed in this menu   b       S       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 154    Menu item Description    Tray  lt x gt  Type Specifies the type of paper loaded in each tray  Plain Paper Notes   Card Stock  Transparency   Plain Paper is the factory default setting for Tray 1  Custom Type   x   is  Recycled the factory default setting for all other trays   Labels    f available  a user defined name will appear instead of Custom  Vinyl Labels TPES  inyl La  Bond   Use this menu item to configure automatic tray linking  If the same size  head and type of paper are in two trays and the Paper Size and Paper Type  AE xe settings match  then the trays are automatically linked  When one tray  Preprinted is empty  the job prints using the linked tray     Colored Paper   Light Paper   Heavy Paper  Rough Cotton Paper  Custom Type   x         MP Feeder Size Specifies the paper size loaded in the multipurpose feeder  A4 N
56.  connections  are properly installed in their marked plug in ports     This product is designed  tested  and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific  manufacturer s components  The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious  The manufacturer is not  responsible for the use of other replacement parts     CAUTION   POTENTIAL INJURY  Do not twist  bind  crush  or place heavy objects on the power cord  Do not  subject the power cord to abrasion or stress  Do not pinch the power cord between objects such as furniture  and walls  If the power cord is misused  a risk of fire or electrical shock results  Inspect the power cord regularly  for signs of misuse  Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet before inspecting it     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Safety information 13    Refer service or repairs  other than those described in the user documentation  to a professional service person     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  To avoid the risk of electric shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer  unplug  the power cord from the wall outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before proceeding     A CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm  Do not set up this product or  make any electrical or cabling connections  such as the fax feature  power cord  or telephone  during a lightning  storm     CAUTION   TIPPING HAZARD  Floor mounted configurations require additional furniture
57.  default setting   Normal  Heavy   Envelope Weight Specifies the relative weight of the envelopes loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy   Rough Envelope Weight Specifies the relative weight of the rough envelopes loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy   Letterhead Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy   Preprinted Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy   Colored Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy   Light Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light   Heavy Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Heavy   Rough Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy   Custom  lt x gt  Specifies the relative weight of the custom paper type loaded in a specific tray  Light Notes   Normal  Heavy   Normal is the factory default setting      Settings appear only if the custom type is supported              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Paper Loading menu   
58.  first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 From the printer control panel  press KD     4 If you placed the document on the scanner glass  then touch Finish the Job to return to the home screen     Copying using the ADF  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 Adjust the paper guides     3 On the home screen  touch Copy  or use the keypad to enter the number of copies     The copy screen appears     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 94    4  5    Change the copy settings as needed     Touch Copy It     Copying using the scanner glass    1  2    Place an original document facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner     On the home screen  touch Copy  or use the keypad to enter the number of copies     The copy screen appears     3 Change the copy settings as needed     Touch Copy It     5  f you have more pages to scan  then place the next document on the scanner glass  and then touch Scan the Next    Page     Touch Finish the Job to return to the home screen     Copy
59.  for a solution  and then print another network setup page     Setting up the printer software    Installing printer software    A printer driver is software that lets the computer communicate with the printer  The printer software is typically  installed during the initial printer setup  If you need to install the software after setup  follow these instructions     For Windows users   1 Close all open software programs    2 Insert the Software and Documentation CD    3 From the main installation dialog  click Install     4 Follow the instructions on the screen     For Macintosh users   1 Close all open software applications    2 Insert the Software and Documentation CD    3 From the Finder desktop  double click the printer CD icon that automatically appears   4 Double click the Install icon     5 Follow the instructions on the screen     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 47    Using the World Wide Web   1 Go to the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com    2 From the Drivers  amp  Downloads menu  click Driver Finder   3 Select your printer  and then select your operating system     4 Download the driver and install the printer software     Updating available options in the printer driver    Once the printer software and any options are installed  it may be necessary to manually add the options in the printer  driver to make them available for print jobs     For Windows users  1 Doone ofthe following     In Windows Vista    Click e    Clic
60.  for stability  You must  use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using a high capacity input tray  a duplex unit and an input  option  or more than one input option  If you purchased a multifunction printer  MFP  that scans  copies  and  faxes  you may need additional furniture  For more information  see www lexmark com multifunctionprinters     SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer 14    Learning about the printer    Finding information about the printer    Where to find    Setup information         Description    The Setup information gives you instructions for setting up   You can find the Setup information on the side of the printer  the printer  Follow the set of instructions for local  network    box or on the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com     or wireless  depending on what you need           Help   Description Where to find   The Help gives you instructions for using the While in any Lexmark software program  click Help  Tips  gt  Help  or Help  gt   software  Help Topics        Customer support      Description Where to find  North America  Where to find  rest of world        Telephone numbers and support hours  vary by country or region    Visit our Web site at www lexmark com   Select a country or region  and then select  the Customer Support link     Telephone support Call us at     US  1 800 332 4120  Monday Friday  8 00 AM   11 00 PM  ET     Saturday  Noon   6 00 PM ET  di     
61.  g n    Description  Network Mode Specifies the network mode  Infrastructure Notes   Ad hoc    Infrastructure mode lets the printer access a network using an  access point     Ad hoc is the factory default setting  Ad hoc mode configures the  printer for wireless networking directly between it and a computer   Compatibility Specifies the wireless standard for the wireless network  802 11n  802 11b g       Choose Network    list of available networks      Lets you select an available network for the printer to use       View Signal Quality    Lets you view the quality of the wireless connection       View Security Mode       X    Lets you view the encryption method for the wireless connection      Disabled    indicates that the wireless network is not encrypted              AppleTalk menu    This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports  gt  Standard Network or Network  lt x gt   gt  Std Network Setup or Net  lt x gt  Setup  gt  AppleTalk    a                   Menu item Description  Activate Activates AppleTalk support  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off  View Name Shows the assigned AppleTalk name  Note  The name can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server   View Address Shows the assigned AppleTalk address  Note  The address can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server   Set Zone Provides a list of AppleTalk zones available on the network   lt list of zones available on the Note  The default setting is the default zone for the n
62.  is set to Off   PS SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  On through a parallel port requires it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes       Onisthe factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data       When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PCL emulation if PCL  SmartSwitch is set to On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals             Understanding printer menus       Menu item    NPA Mode  On  Off  Auto    177    Description    Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol    Notes       Auto is the factory default setting       Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Parallel Buffer  Disabled  Auto  3K to   max size allowed      Sets the size of the parallel input buffer    Notes       Auto is the factory default setting     The Disabled setting turns off job buffering  Any jobs already buffered on the  disk are printed before normal processing is resumed    The parallel buffer size setting can be changed in 1K increments    The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer     the size of the othe
63.  line as the printer  or subscribe to the telephone company s Distinctive Ring service  then keep  the Ring Delay setting at 4     1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings    3 Click Fax Settings    4 Click Analog Fax Setup    5 Inthe Rings to Answer box  enter the number of times you want the phone to ring before answering     6 Click Submit     THE TONER MAY BE LOW    88 Cartridge low appears when the toner is low     Can receive but not send faxes    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     THE PRINTER IS NOT IN FAX MODE    On the home screen  touch Fax to put the printer in Fax mode     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 275    THE DOCUMENT IS NOT LOADED PROPERLY    Load the original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left  corner     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     MIAKE SURE THE SHORTCUT NUMBER IS SET UP PROPERLY    Check to make sure the shortcut number has been programmed for the number that you want to dial       Asan alternative  dial the telephone number manually     Received fax has poor print quality    These are po
64.  lists the jams that can occur and the location of each jam                                                                                                                 Jam numbers Area  1 200 202 Printer  2     230 239 Duplex unit  3 240 249 Paper tray  4  250 Multipurpose feeder  5 260 Envelope feeder  6   270 279 Optional output bin  7   280 282 Finisher  8   283 Stapler  i 9 290 294 ADF cover J                200 and 201 paper jams    1 Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam     2 Lower the multipurpose feeder door     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 142    3 Push the release latch  and then open the front cover              4 Lift and pull the print cartridge out of the printer     Warning   Potential Damage  Do not touch the photoconductor drum on the underside of the cartridge  Use  the cartridge handle whenever you are holding the cartridge              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 143    5 Place the print cartridge aside   Warning   Potential Damage  Do not leave the cartridge exposed to light for extended periods     Warning   Potential Damage  The jammed paper may be covered with unfused toner which can stain garments  and skin     6 Remove the jammed paper     CAUTION   HOT SURFACE  The inside of the printer might be hot  To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  component  allow the surface to cool before touching     Note  If the paper is not easy to remove  then open the rear 
65.  low or when the paper needs to be changed   added  or unjammed     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Administrative support 261    To set up e mail alerts   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings    3 Under Other Settings  click E mail Alert Setup    4 Select the items for notification  and type in the e mail addresses   5 Click Submit     Note  See your system support person to set up the e mail server     Viewing reports    You can view some reports from the Embedded Web Server  These reports are useful for assessing the status of the  printer  the network  and supplies     To view reports from a network printer   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Reports  and then click the type of report you want to view     Adjusting the brightness of the display  If you are having trouble reading your display  the LCD brightness can be adjusted through the Settings menu   1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   On the home screen  touch        Touch Settings     2   3   4 Touch General Settings    5 Touch the down arrow until Screen Brightness appears   6    Touch the arrows to in
66.  med de grunnleggende krav og    vrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999 5 EF    Polski Niniejszym Lexmark International  Inc  o  wiadcza    e niniejszy produkt jest zgodny z zasadniczymi  wymogami oraz pozosta  ymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999 5 EC    Portugu  s   A Lexmark International Inc  declara que este este produto est   conforme com os requisitos essenciais e outras  disposi    es da Diretiva 1999 5 CE    Slovensky   Lexmark International  Inc  t  mto vyhlasuje    e tento produkt sp    a z  kladn   po  iadavky a v  etky  pr  slu  n   ustanovenia smernice 1999 5 ES    Slovensko   Lexmark International  Inc  izjavlja  da je ta izdelek v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi  relevantnimi dolo  ili direktive 1999 5 ES    Svenska H  rmed intygar Lexmark International  Inc  att denna produkt star i   verensst  mmelse med de v  sentliga  egenskapskrav och   vriga relevanta best  mmelser som framg  r av direktiv 1999 5 EG              India emissions notice    This device uses very low power low range RF communication that has been tested and found not to cause any  interference whatsoever  The manufacturer is not responsible in case of any disputes arising out of requirement of  permissions from any local authority  regulatory bodies or any organization  required by the end user to install and  operate this product at his premises     aRA Sa YT   E X3 aed et HA ald  Ha Lor RF HYG BD NUNT Geet S ferret eur fu  8  ak we wrap Up B fo ae feet A gor I aes So el Ge
67.  mismatch 243  50 PPDS font error 243  51 Defective flash detected 243  52 Not enough free space in flash  memory for resources 244  53 Unformatted flash detected 244  54 Network  lt x gt  software error 244  54 Serial option  lt x gt  error 244  54 Standard network software  error 244  55 Unsupported option in slot 245    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       550 sheet tray  standard or  optional    loading 72  56 Parallel port  lt x gt  disabled 245  56 Serial port  lt x gt  disabled 245  56 Standard parallel port  disabled 245  56 Standard USB port disabled 245  56 USB port  lt x gt  disabled 246  57 Configuration change  held jobs  were not restored 246  58 Too many bins attached 246  58 Too many disks installed 246  58 Too many flash options  installed 246  58 Too many trays attached 247  59 Incompatible envelope  feeder 247  59 Incompatible output bin   lt x gt  247  59 Incompatible tray  lt x gt  247  61 Remove defective disk 247  62 Disk full 247  63 Unformatted disk 248  80 Routine maintenance  needed 248  841 846 Scanner Service Error 249  88 Cartridge low 248  88 yy Cartridge nearly low 248  88 yy Replace cartridge 248  900   999 Service   message   249    Symbols   scan to computer  screen  options 128  129  130    A   Active NIC menu 167   address book  fax  using 115   ADF  copying using 93   ADF maintenance kit  ordering 257   ADF pick assembly  ordering 257   ADF separator roll  ordering 257    308    Answering 232  AppleTalk menu 173  attaching cab
68.  of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Rough is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Envelope Texture Specifies the relative texture of the envelopes loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Rough Envelope Texture Specifies the relative texture of the rough envelopes loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Rough is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Letterhead Texture Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Preprinted Texture Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Colored Texture Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Light Texture Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough             Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item  Heavy Texture  Smooth  Normal  Rough    Description    Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray    Note  Normal is the factory default setting     159       Rough Texture  Smooth  Normal  Rough    Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray    Note  Rough is the factory def
69.  on     3 Release the buttons when the screen with the progress bar appears     The printer performs a power on sequence  and then the Configuration menu appears   4 Touch the down arrow until Print Quality Pages appears     5 Touch Print Quality Pages   The print quality test pages print   6 Touch Back     7 Touch Exit Configuration   Canceling a print job    Canceling a print job from the printer control panel  1 Touch Cancel Jobs on the touch screen  or press eo on the keypad   2 Touch the job you want to cancel     3 Touch Delete Selected Jobs     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 138    Canceling a print job from the computer    To cancel a print job  do one of the following     For Windows users    In Windows Vista     Click e    1  2 Click Control Panel    3 Click Hardware and Sound   4 Click Printers    5 Double click the printer icon    6 Select the job to cancel    7 From the keyboard  press Delete    In Windows XP    1 Click Start    2 From Printers and Faxes  double click the printer icon    3 Select the job to cancel    4 From the keyboard  press Delete    From the Windows taskbar   When you send a job to print  a small printer icon appears in the right corner of the taskbar     1 Double click the printer icon     A list of print jobs appears in the printer window   2 Select a job to cancel     3 From the keyboard  press Delete     For Macintosh users   In Mac OS X version 10 5    1 From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences    2 Click
70.  page received  Wait for the message to  clear     Remove packaging material  check  lt x gt     Remove any remaining packaging material from the specified location     Remove paper from  lt linked bin set name gt   Remove the paper from the specified bin  The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing     If removing the paper does not clear the message  then touch Continue     Remove paper from all bins  Remove the paper from all of the bins  The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing     If removing the paper does not clear the message  then touch Continue     Remove paper from bin  lt x gt   Remove the paper from the specified bin  The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing     If removing the paper does not clear the message  then touch Continue     Remove paper from standard output bin    Remove the stack of paper from the standard exit bin     Replace  lt x gt  if restarting job     One or more messages which interrupted a scan job are now cleared  Replace the original documents in the scanner  to restart the scan job   lt x gt  is a page of the scan job   Try one or more of the following      Touch Cancel Job if a scan job is processing when the message appears  This cancels the job and clears the message       Touch Scan from Automatic Document Feeder if the page jam recovery is active  Scanning resumes from the ADF  immediately after the last successfully scanned page     Touch Scan from flatbed 
71.  paper from the standard exit bin     CHECK TO SEE IF THE PAPER TRAY IS EMPTY    Load paper in the tray     IVIAKE SURE THE CORRECT PRINTER SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED      Verify that you are using the correct printer software        fyouareusing a USB port  make sure you are running a supported operating system and using compatible printer  software     IVIAKE SURE THE INTERNAL PRINT SERVER IS INSTALLED PROPERLY AND WORKING      Make sure the internal print server is properly installed and that the printer is connected to the network       Print a network setup page and check that the status shows Connected  If the status is Not Connected  check the  network cables  and then try printing the network setup page again  Contact your system support person to make  sure the network is functioning correctly     Copies of the printer software are also available on the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com     MAKE SURE YOU ARE USING A RECOMMENDED USB  SERIAL  OR ETHERNET CABLE    For more information  visit the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com     MAKE SURE PRINTER CABLES ARE SECURELY CONNECTED  Check the cable connections to the printer and print server to make sure they are secure     For more information  see the setup documentation that came with the printer     Confidential and other held jobs do not print    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     PARTIAL JOB  NO JOB  OR BLANK PAGES PRINT    The print job may contain a formatting error or invalid data  
72.  power switch     The printer cable is securely attached to the printer and the host computer  print server  option  or other network  device       All options are properly installed       The printer driver settings are correct     Once you have checked each of these possibilities  turn the printer off  wait for about 10 seconds  and then turn the  printer back on  This often fixes the problem     Printer control panel display is blank or displays only diamonds    The printer self test failed  Turn the printer off  wait about 10 seconds  and then turn the printer on     If Ready does not appear  then turn the printer off and contact Customer Support     Solving printing problems    Multiple language PDFs do not print  The documents contain unavailable fonts   1 Open the document you want to print in Adobe Acrobat     2 Click the printer icon   The Print dialog appears     3 Select Print as image     4 Click OK     Error message about reading USB drive appears    Make sure the USB drive is supported  For information regarding tested and approved USB flash memory devices  visit  the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 265    Jobs do not print    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     IVIAKE SURE THE PRINTER IS READY TO PRINT    Make sure Ready or Power Saver appears on the display before sending a job to print     CHECK TO SEE IF THE STANDARD EXIT BIN IS FULL    Remove the stack of
73.  quality problems  such as streaks on copied or scanned images   1 Slightly dampen a soft  lint free cloth or paper towel with water     2 Open the scanner cover                       3 Wipe the scanner glass until it is clean and dry     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 252    4  5    6  7  8  9    Wipe the white underside of the scanner cover until it is clean and dry     Open the bottom ADF door        Wipe the ADF scanner glass under the ADF door   Close the bottom ADF door   Wipe the scanner glass  flatbed  and backing material by moving the cloth or paper towel from side to side     Close the scanner cover     Adjusting scanner registration    Scanner Registration is a process to align the scan area with the paper location  To manually adjust the scanner  registration     1    A U   N    on O Ui    Turn the printer off   Clean the scanner glass and backing material   Hold down and while turning the printer on     Release the buttons when the screen with the progress bar appears     The printer performs a power on sequence  and then the Configuration menu appears   Touch the down arrow until Scanner Manual Registration appears    Touch Scanner Manual Registration    Touch Print Quick Test to print a registration page     Choose the section of the scanner to align     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 253    To align the scanner glass  flatbed      a Place the Quick Test page facedown on the sc
74.  rolls 257  fuser 256  maintenance kit 256  pick rollers 257  staple cartridges 258  transfer roller 257    314    system board   accessing 26  System busy  preparing resources  for job  241  System busy  preparing resources  for job  Deleting held job s   241    I    TCP IP menu 171  telecommunication  notices 297  298  299  300  touch screen  buttons 21  transfer roller  ordering 257  transparencies  loading 79  making 94  tips on using 132  tray linking 84  tray unlinking 84  trays  linking 83  84  unlinking 83  84  troubleshooting  checking an unresponsive  printer 264  checking an unresponsive  scanner 270  contacting Customer Support 290  solving basic printer  problems 264  troubleshooting  copy  copier does not respond 268  partial document or photo  copies 270  poor copy quality 268  poor scanned image quality 271  scanner unit does not close 268  troubleshooting  display  display is blank 264  display shows only diamonds 264  troubleshooting  fax  blocking junk faxes 117  caller ID is not shown 272  can receive but not send  faxes 274  can send but not receive  faxes 274  cannot send or receive a fax 272  received fax has poor print  quality 275    Index    troubleshooting  paper feed  message remains after jam is  cleared 279  troubleshooting  print  error reading USB drive 264  held jobs do not print 265  incorrect characters print 266  incorrect margins 282  jammed page does not  reprint 279  job prints from wrong tray 266  job prints on wrong paper 266  job take
75.  select the paper source from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  select the paper source from the Print dialog and pop up menus     THE PRINT CARTRIDGE IS DEFECTIVE    Replace the print cartridge     THE PAPER PATH MAY NOT BE CLEAR  Check the paper path around the print cartridge     CAUTION    HOT SURFACE  The inside of the printer might be hot  To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  component  allow the surface to cool before touching     Clear any paper you see     THERE IS TONER IN THE PAPER PATH  Contact Customer Support   Toner fog or background shading appears on the page    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE    Replace the print cartridge     THE CHARGE ROLLS MAY BE DEFECTIVE    Replace the charge rolls     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 289    THERE IS TONER IN THE PAPER PATH    Contact Customer Support     Toner rubs off       These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     CHECK THE PAPER TEXTURE SETTING    From the printer control panel Paper menu  mak
76.  sets the width of the page to allow the printing of  eighty 10 pitch characters   PCL Emulation Settings Specifies whether the printer automatically performs a carriage return after a  Auto CR after LF line feed control command  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  PCL Emulation Settings Specifies whether the printer automatically performs a line feed after a carriage  Auto LF after CR return control command  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 228    Menu item Description    Tray Renumber Configures the printer to work with printer software or programs that use  Assign MP Feeder different source assignments for trays  drawers  and feeders  Off Notes   None  0 199  Assign Tray  lt x gt   Off  None  0 199  Assign Manual Paper  Off  None  0 199  Assign Man Env  Off  None  0 199    e Off is the factory default setting       None is not an available selection  It appears only when it is selected by  the PCL 5 interpreter       None ignores the Select Paper Feed command     0 199 allows a custom setting to be assigned        Tray Renumber Lets you view the factory default setting assigned to each tray  drawer  or feeder   View Factory Def even if it has not been installed   MPF Default   8  T1 Default   1  T2 Default   4  T3 Default   5  T4 Default   20  T5 Default   21  Env Default   6  MPaper Default   2  MEnv Default   3       Tray Renumber Returns all tray  drawer  a
77.  setting      When the timer expires  any partially printed page still in the  printer is printed  and then the printer checks to see if any  new print jobs are waiting      Print Timeout is available only when using PCL or PPDS  emulation  This setting has no effect on PostScript emulation  print jobs    Timeouts Sets the amount of time in seconds the printer waits for additional  Wait Timeout data before canceling a print job  Disabled Notes   15 65535      40 seconds is the factory default setting       Wait Timeout is available only when the printer is using  PostScript emulation  This setting has no effect on PCL or  PPDS emulation print jobs        Print Recovery  Auto Continue  Disabled  5 255    Lets the printer automatically continue printing from certain offline  situations when not resolved within the specified time period    Notes       Disabled is the factory default setting     e 5 255 is a range of time in seconds        Print Recovery  Jam Recovery  On  Off  Auto    Specifies whether the printer reprints jammed pages    Notes       Auto is the factory default setting  The printer reprints  jammed pages unless the memory required to hold the pages  is needed for other printer tasks       Onsetsthe printer to always reprint jammed pages       Off sets the printer to never reprint jammed pages        Print Recovery  Page Protect  On  Off          Lets the printer successfully print a page that may not have printed  otherwise    Notes     Off is the factory defaul
78.  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy   Touch Copy from  and then touch Auto Size Sense     Touch Copy to  and then touch Auto Size Match     a uu A WwW NM    Touch Copy It     The scanner identifies the mixed paper sizes as they scan  Copies are printed on mixed paper sizes corresponding  to the paper sizes of the original document     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 97    Example 2  Copying to a single paper size    The printer has one paper tray  loaded with letter size paper  A document that contains letter  and legal size pages  needs to be copied     1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy   Touch Copy from  and then touch Mixed Letter Legal     Touch Copy to  and then touch Letter     a uu A WwW N    Touch Copy It   The scanner identifies the mixed paper sizes as they scan and then scales the legal size pages to print on letter size  paper     Copying on both sides of the paper  duplexing   1 L
79.  that     Your wireless network is set up and working properly       The computer you are using is connected to the same wireless network where you want to set up the printer     1 Connect the power cable  and then turn the printer on              Make sure the printer and computer are fully on and ready           3 Click Install   4 Click Agree   5 Click Suggested     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       49    Additional printer setup 50    6 Click Wireless Network Attach     7 Connect the cables in the following order   a Temporarily connect a USB cable between the computer on the wireless network and the printer        Note  After the printer is configured  the software will instruct you to disconnect the temporary USB cable  so you can print wirelessly   b If your printer has faxing capabilities  then connect the telephone cable   8 Follow the on screen instructions to complete the software installation   9 To allow other computers on the wireless network to use the wireless printer  follow steps 2 through 6 and step 8    for each computer     Installing the printer on a wireless network  Macintosh     Prepare to configure the printer  1 Locate the printer MAC address on the sheet that came with the printer  Write the last six digits of the MAC address    in the space provided below   MAC address      1          2 If your printer has faxing capabilities  then connect the telephone cable     3 Connect the power cable  and then turn the power on     Downloaded F
80.  the other device is finished before sending  a fax        f you are using the On Hook Dial feature  then turn up the volume to verify a dial tone     TEMPORARILY DISCONNECT OTHER EQUIPMENT    To ensure the printer is working correctly  connect it directly to the telephone line  Disconnect any answering  machines  computers with modems  or telephone line splitters     CHECK FOR JAMS    Clear any jams  and then make sure that Ready appears     TEMPORARILY DISABLE CALL WAITING    Call Waiting can disrupt fax transmissions  Disable this feature before sending or receiving a fax  Call your telephone  company to obtain the keypad sequence for temporarily disabling Call Waiting     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 274    Voice MIAIL SERVICE MAY BE INTERFERING WITH THE FAX TRANSMISSION  Voice Mail offered through your local telephone company may disrupt fax transmissions  To enable both Voice Mail  and the printer to answer calls  you may want to consider adding a second telephone line for the printer   THE PRINTER MEMORY MAY BE FULL  1 Dial the fax number     2 Scan the original document one page at a time     Can send but not receive faxes    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK TO SEE IF THE PAPER TRAY IS EMPTY    Load paper in the tray     CHECK THE RING COUNT DELAY SETTINGS    The ring count delay sets the number of times the phone line rings before the printer answers  If you have extension  phones on the same
81.  the printer hard disk mounting bracket            SS   ee             Kr N      p       f     amp  Va   e                      p     I ba  C          A  C Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the system board     Note  The plugs and receptacles are color coded                                                                                   Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 42    Installing a fax card  Note  This task requires a flathead screwdriver     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     Warning   Potential Damage  System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity  Touch  something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors     1 Access the system board           2 Unpack the fax card     3 Remove the metal cover from the fax card opening                    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup    4 Insert the fax card and attach the two provided screws to secure the fax card mounting bracket              WIE                        Downloaded From M
82.  view the label on the  fuser     Part name Part number    Maintenance kit 40X4723  100 V T1 fuser   40X4724  110 V T1 fuser   40X4765  220 V T1 fuser   40X4766  100 V T2 fuser   40X4767  110 V T2 fuser   40X4768  220 V T2 fuser                 Ordering a fuser    To check the fuser type  T1 or T2  installed in the printer  remove the print cartridge to view the label on the fuser     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 257    Part name Part number    T1 fuser 40X1870  100 V   40X4418  110 V   40X1871  220 V        T2 fuser 40X5853  100 V   40X5854  110 V   40X5855  220 V                 Ordering an ADF maintenance kit    The ADF maintenance kit contains all the items necessary to replace the ADF pick mechanism and the ADF separator  roller     See the following table for the maintenance kit part number for your specific printer     Part number       ADF Maintenance kit 40X4769       Ordering a transfer roller    When toner smudges appear on the front or back of printed pages  order a replacement transfer roller     Part number       Transfer roll assembly 40X1886       Ordering charge rolls    When toner fog or background shading appears on printed pages  order replacement charge rolls        Part number    Charge roll assembly 40X5852       Ordering pick rollers    When the paper fails to properly feed from the tray  order new pick rollers     Part number       Pick rollers 40X4308       Ordering ADF replacement parts    Order ADF replac
83. 09  Adding e mail subject and message information                     sessi snas 109  Changing the Output file type    ec edicere tret cai c a eld rg era e Za ze ica 109   Canceling an emiail  i 2 eer reor ea rrr sar dees snvdeaviasenanctaddvanessnvaneesiun Ea OEE nde coueesesdevaede rds Evae eaa ERES EE 110   Understanding e mail options                    eese seen nennen enne seen nemen reete nenne inerenti ener nennen enne 110  Original SIZe   2  initio erede Ed eit dde aa aa aaa De Ropa Due eta a d de tape ena n Eee To Hie id Bu CE ko pn d File 110  SIRE                                                                             AE a 110  igneum                                                            HEP 110  Binding   iieste oi mae he bar ter aae du Dien aget dvi dat du sa ja ced qo fae pad de rada age Coin epe avo ee quee EE uuu  110  E mail Subject eee ortis uei i vitai ei i ente tnde aa E de UL E E EU eae Ed unt 110  sS tte               m 111  E mail MeSSage 5  eer td ee e hdi t eit die ed dete ve em Gideon ed MA eet 111  Resolution des                                                  J                             111  Send AS KE H                                                 H         111  Soi ELE 111  Advanced OPtiO NS necies RR 111    FAMINE E E E A E E E A Ic    Sendinga faX craneae E A E E E E a 113  Sending a fax using the printer control panel                    sesenta rennen nnn nnns 113  Sendirg a fax using the Computer   s  eee betae reis E ERR ero 
84. 1 This size appears in the Paper Size menu only when the paper source does not support size sensing or when size sensing  is turned off       Only the standard exit bin supports this size    This size setting formats the page for 216 x 356 mm  8 5 x 14 in   unless the size is specified by the software application       To support duplexing  the Universal width must be between 148 mm  5 8 in  and 216 mm  8 5 in   Universal length must  be between 182 mm  7 2 in  and 356 mm  14 in     lt           J       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper and specialty media guidelines 90    a    Paper size Dimensions 250  or Optional Multipurpose Duplex unit  550 sheet trays 2000 sheet tray   feeder     standard or  optional     Universal   138 x 210 mm J X J X   5 5 x 8 3 in   up to  216 x 356 mm    8 5 x 14 in            70 x 127 mm X X V X   2 8 x 5 in   up to  216 x 356 mm   8 5 x 14 in      148 x 182 mm vV X vV V     5 8 x 7 7 in   up to  216 x 356 mm   8 5 x 14 in            7 3 4 Envelope 98 x 191 mm X X   Monarch   3 9 x 7 5 in         9 Envelope 98 x 225 mm X X   3 9 x 8 9 in         10 Envelope 105 x 241 mm X X   4 1 x 9 5 in         DL Envelope 110 x 220 mm X X   4 3 x 8 7 in         Other Envelope 98 x 162 mm X X   3 9 x 6 4 in   to  176 x 250 mm   6 9 x 9 8 in         V             S  x                      1 This size appears in the Paper Size menu only when the paper source does not support size sensing or when size sensing  is turned off       Only the stan
85. 2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct size setting     For Windows users  specify the size from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the size from the Page Setup dialog     Cannot scan from a computer    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES    Clear any error messages     CHECK THE POWER    Make sure the printer is plugged in  the power is on  and Ready appears     CHECK THE CABLE CONNECTIONS    Make sure the network or USB cable is securely connected to the computer and the printer     Solving fax problems    Caller ID is not shown  Contact your telecommunications company to verify that your telephone line is subscribed to the caller ID service     If your region supports multiple caller ID patterns  you may have to change the default setting  There are two settings  available  FSK  pattern 1  and DTMF  pattern 2   The availability of these settings by way of the Fax menu depends on  whether your country or region supports multiple caller ID patterns  Contact your telecommunications company to  determine which pattern or switch setting to use     Cannot send or receive a fax    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES    Clear any error messages     CHECK THE POWER    Make sure the printer is plugged in  the power is on  and Ready appears     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 273    CH
86. 65 Emulation error  load  emulation option 250  200   282 yy paper jam 248  283 Staple jam 248  290 294 yy scanner jam 248  293 Replace all originals if  restarting job 248  293 02 Flatbed Cover Open 249  30 Invalid refill  change  cartridge 241  31 Replace defective  cartridge 241  32 Cartridge part number  unsupported by device 241  34 Short paper 242  35 Insufficient memory to support  Resource Save feature 242  37 Insufficient memory for Flash  Memory Defragment  operation 242    312    37 Insufficient memory to collate  job 242  37 Insufficient memory  some  Held Jobs were deleted 242  37 Insufficient memory  some held  jobs will not be restored 242  38 Memory full 243  39 Complex page  some data may  not have printed 243  42 xy Cartridge region  mismatch 243  50 PPDS font error 243  51 Defective flash detected 243  52 Not enough free space in flash  memory for resources 244  53 Unformatted flash  detected 244  54 Network   x   software  error 244  54 Serial option   x   error 244  54 Standard network software  error 244  55 Unsupported option in  slot 245  56 Parallel port   x   disabled 245  56 Serial port   x   disabled 245  56 Standard parallel port  disabled 245  56 Standard USB port  disabled 245  56 USB port   x   disabled 246  57 Configuration change  held jobs  were not restored 246  58 Too many bins attached 246  58 Too many disks installed 246  58 Too many flash options  installed 246  58 Too many trays attached 247  59 Incompatible envelope  feeder 247  59 In
87. 8  V A  Fax Send Settings    Menu item Description  Resolution Specifies quality in dots per inch  dpi   A higher resolution gives greater print quality   Standard but it increases the fax transmission time for outgoing faxes   Fine Note  Standard is the factory default setting   Super Fine  Ultra Fine  Original Size Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  Letter Note  Letter is the US factory default setting  A4 is the international factory default  Legal setting   Executive  Folio  Statement  Universal  4x 6in   3x 5in     Business Card  Custom Scan Size  lt x gt   A4   A5   Oficio  Mexico    A6   JIS B5   Book Original   Auto Size Sense  Mixed Letter Legal       r          La       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       200             Menu item Description  Sides  Duplex  Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  Off Notes   Long edge  Short edge   Off is the factory default setting     Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page  left edge for  portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation      Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page  top edge for  portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation    Content Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to fax  Text Notes   Text Photo  Photograph   Text is used when the document is mostly text     Text Photo is the factory default setting  Text Photo is used when the  doc
88. 9 oder 80D1877  f  r jede Leitung installiert werden    ber die in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte   bertragen werden   Die Verwendung des Lexmark Filters ist obligatorisch  da in allen analogen Telefonleitungen in der Schweiz  Zeitsteuertakte vorhanden sind     Uso del prodotto in Svizzera    Questo prodotto richiede un filtro toni Billing svizzero   codice Lexmark 14B5109 o 80D1877  da installare su tutte le  linee che ricevono impulsi remoti in Svizzera  E necessario utilizzare il filtro Lexmark poich   gli impulsi remoti sono  presenti su tutte le linee analogiche in Svizzera     ENERGY STAR       ENERGY STAR    Laser notice    The printer is certified in the U S  to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR Subchapter J for Class    1  laser  products  and elsewhere is certified as a Class   laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825 1     Class   laser products are not considered to be hazardous  The printer contains internally a Class IIIb  3b  laser that is  nominally a 5 milliwatt gallium arsenide laser operating in the wavelength of 770 795 nanometers  The laser system  and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class   level during normal  operation  user maintenance  or prescribed service condition     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 301    Laser advisory label    A laser notice label may be affixed to this printer as shown        Power consumption    Product power consumption    The 
89. B  lt x gt  241  using RJ11 adapter 61  Utilities menu 224    V    Verify print jobs 134  printing from Macintosh  computer 135  printing from Windows 135  viewing  reports 261    W    Waiting for redial 241  Windows  wireless network installation 49  wired network setup  using Windows 53  wired networking  using Macintosh 53  Wireless menu 172  wireless network  configuration information 48  installation  using Macintosh 50  installation  using Windows 49    315    X  XPS menu 230    
90. B port        Notes        f you insert the flash drive when the printer requires attention  such as when a jam has occurred  then the  printer ignores the flash drive        f you insert the flash drive while the printer is printing other jobs  then Printer Busy appears  After the  other jobs are processed  you may need to view the held jobs list to print documents from the flash drive     3 Touch the document you want to print     Note  Folders found on the flash drive appear as folders  File names are appended by the extension type  for  example   jpg      Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 137    4 Touch the arrows if you want to increase the number of printed copies   5 Touch Print     Note  Do not remove the flash drive from the USB port until the document has finished printing     If you leave the flash drive in the printer after leaving the initial USB menu screen  then you can still print  pdf files  from the flash drive as held jobs     Printing information pages    Printing a directory list  A directory list shows the resources stored in flash memory or on the printer hard disk   1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears    2 On the home screen  touch         3 Touch Reports    4 Touch the down arrow until Print Directory appears     5 Touch Print Directory     Printing the print quality test pages   Print the print quality test pages to isolate print quality problems   1 Turn the printer off    2 Hold down and while turning the printer
91. E PAPER SIZE SETTING  Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct size setting     For Windows users  specify the size from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the size from the Page Setup dialog     Solving scanner problems    Checking an unresponsive scanner    If your scanner is not responding  then make sure     The printer is turned on       The printer cable is securely attached to the printer and the host computer  print server  option  or other network  device       The power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly grounded electrical outlet     The electrical outlet is not turned off by any switch or breaker     The printer is not plugged into any surge protectors  uninterrupted power supplies  or extension cords       Other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet is working     Once you have checked each of these possibilities  turn the printer off and then back on  This often fixes the problem  with the scanner     Scan was not successful    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE CABLE CONNECTIONS    Make sure the network or USB cable is securely connected to the computer and the printer     AN ERROR MAY HAVE OCCURRED IN THE PROGRAM    Turn off and then restart the computer     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubl
92. ECK THE PRINTER CONNECTIONS    Make sure the cable connections for the following hardware are secure  if applicable     Telephone    Handset      Answering machine    CHECK THE TELEPHONE WALL JACK  1 Plug a telephone into the wall jack   2 Listen for a dial tone   3 If you do not hear a dial tone  then plug a different telephone into the wall jack   4 If you still do not hear a dial tone  then plug a telephone into a different wall jack     5  f you hear a dial tone  then connect the printer to that wall jack     REVIEW THIS DIGITAL PHONE SERVICE CHECKLIST  The fax modem is an analog device  Certain devices can be connected to the printer so that digital telephone services  can be used        f you are using an ISDN telephone service  then connect the printer to an analog telephone port  an R interface  port  on an ISDN terminal adapter  For more information and to request an R interface port  contact your ISDN  provider        f you are using DSL  then connect to a DSL filter or router that will support analog use  For more information   contact your DSL provider        f you are using a PBX telephone service  then make sure you are connecting to an analog connection on the PBX   If none exists  consider installing an analog telephone line for the fax machine     CHECK FOR A DIAL TONE    Place atest call to the telephone number to which you want to send a fax to make sure that it is working correctly        fthe telephone line is being used by another device  then wait until
93. From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 204    Menu item Description       Auto Print Logs Enables automatic printing of fax logs  On Note  Logs print after every 200 jobs   Off   Log Paper Source Selects the source of the paper used for printing logs  Tray  lt x gt     Manual Feeder       Logs Display Specifies whether printed logs display the dialed number or the station name returned  Remote Station Name  Dialed Number       Enable Job Log Enables access to the Fax Job log  On  Off       Enable Call Log Enables access to the Fax Call log  On  Off       Log Output Bin Specifies the output bin where fax logs are printed  Standard Bin  Bin  lt x gt              V       Speaker Settings               Menu item Description  Speaker Mode Notes   Always Of   Always Off turns the speaker off   On until Connected              On until Connected is the factory default setting  The speaker is on and issues a  Always On     RN  noise until the fax connection is made     Always On turns the speaker on   Speaker Volume Controls the volume setting  High Note  High is the factory default setting   Low  Ringer Volume Controls the fax speaker ringer volume  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off  XX             Distinctive Rings       Menu item Description   Single Ring Answers calls with a one ring pattern  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    a    205      
94. HAS ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY      Load paper from a fresh package       Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it     CHECK THE PAPER    Avoid textured paper with rough finishes     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE    Replace the print cartridge     Solid color pages            These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     MAKE SURE THE PRINT CARTRIDGE IS PROPERLY INSTALLED    Remove the print cartridge and shake it from side to side to redistribute the toner  and then reinstall it     THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE OR LOW ON TONER    Replace the used print cartridge with a new one  If the problem continues  the printer may need to be serviced  For  more information  contact Customer Support     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 288    Streaked vertical lines    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     THE TONER IS SMEARED    Select another tray or feeder to feed paper for the job     From the printer control panel  select the Default Source from the Paper Menu     For Windows users 
95. If your name does not appear  touch the down  arrow until your name appears  or touch Search Held Jobs if there are a large number of held jobs in the printer     Touch Confidential Jobs   Enter your PIN   Touch the job you want to print     Touch Print  or touch the arrows to increase or decrease the number of copies  and then touch Print     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 136    Printing from a flash drive  A USB port is located on the printer control panel  Insert a flash drive to print supported file types  Supported file types  include   pdf   gif  jpeg   jpg   bmp   png   tiff   tif   pcx  and  dcx     Many flash drives are tested and approved for use with the printer  For more information  visit the Lexmark Web site  at www lexmark com     Notes       Hi Speed flash drives must support the Full speed standard  Flash drives supporting only USB Low speed  capabilities are not supported       USB devices must support the FAT  File Allocation Tables  system  Devices formatted with NTFS  New  Technology File System  or any other file system are not supported        f selecting an encrypted  pdf file  then enter the file password from the printer control panel     Before printing an encrypted  pdf file  enter the file password from the printer control panel       You cannot print files for which you do not have printing permissions   To print from a flash drive   1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears     2 Insert a flash drive into the US
96. Jobs     The Cancel Jobs screen appears     2 Touch the job or jobs you want to cancel     Only three jobs appear on the screen  touch the down arrow until the job you want appears  and then touch the  job you want to cancel     3 Touch Delete Selected Jobs     The Deleting Selected Jobs screen appears  the selected jobs are deleted  and then the home screen appears     Understanding fax options    Original Size    This option opens a screen where you can choose the size of the documents you are going to fax       Touch a paper size button to select that size as the Original Size setting  The fax screen appears with your new  setting displayed       When Original Size is set to Mixed Letter Legal  you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper sizes       When  Original Size  is set to Auto Size Sense  the scanner automatically determines the size of the original  document     Content    This option tells the printer the original document type  Choose from Text  Text Photo  or Photograph  Color can be  turned on or off with any of the Content choices  Content affects the quality and size of your scan     Text   Emphasizes sharp  black  high resolution text against a clean  white background      Text Photo   Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 119      Photograph   Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures  This setting increases the time 
97. L06    Getting ready to e malil               cere diede eed ee nte Reed e net R Lene bead ee pasa auae ee Eod ed eei e dre aue ped MO sue de 106  Setting Up the e mail f  nction       ci dedic ie eoe na Mac a a a caa LL aha EUER Kd a eaa ded RR Rn Eaa 106  Configuring the e mail Settings             ccccccccccsssssssecesssssseeeceesssseecsesesssececesesseeeeeseeesseeeeeeessaseeessesesseeesssseaseeeaeaas 107    ed rele le blegros t                       107  Creating an e mail shortcut using the Embedded Web Servel             sscccsesssssecceesssesseeeecessneeseeeessssseeeeesssaaea 107  Creating an e mail shortcut using the touch screen            ceeesessecescesseeceeesesesseeeccesssaaseeesseeseeecessssueeeees neni nnns 107   E mailing a doc  mieht     eicere ente eeeet to o e Rte ede a ye Re eee dd d aaa eee ed Ra erede duod eO Ra a Redde 108  Sending an e mail using the touch screen            cccccsessssececeessnsssecescessssececesesuasecsccesueeeecesessuseeeceseasaeeesessessaaaaas 108  Sending an e mail using a shortcut number             ccccsscccccessssssecescsssseeceeessesnseececsessssesseseaseeecesecasaeeeesesessaeeness 108  Sending an e mail using the address book             cccscsccessessseeceessssasececcseueceesessaeeecescesaseeseeseeaseescessuesessesesees 108    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 5    Customizing e mail SCttiNgS             cccccceesseecsensneeceeseneecceenseeececesnseeecsaaeecesseeecesseeaeceeeesaeeseseeneanaeeeeseaees 1
98. LEXMARK    X651de  X652de  X654de  X656de   X656dte  X658d  X658de  X658dme   X658dfe  X658dte  X658dtme   X658dtfe    User s Guide    March 2012 www lexmark com    Lexmark and Lexmark with diamond design are trademarks of Lexmark International  Inc   registered in the United States and or other countries  All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners       2008 Lexmark International  Inc    All rights reserved    740 West New Circle Road   Lexington  Kentuc ky 40550    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 2    Contents    eal P                                         i L2    Learning about the DrIEer  eoo ee eois ropa bake pa EE pE E e eyE ERES Ee ERXN Eo ErRe Pes vex r resa css r opp L      Finding information about the Printer             ccccscssccccceceecessesssnsssseceseeceecescessesesesessueuseseseeeesecseseneseseeeees 14  Printer config  ratlOns       eee toroe ertet e RR ERR aene RR E E VERE ES eve VEA Ee dee ev ku Re EAE VERRE Fe ei S Ui Ee eU EE 15  Selecting a location for the  printer    cie eee a E e a ea Ue Vae adde a Ea 16  Basic functions of the scanner               sessssssssssseseseeseeeeee eene nennen nnns enn nnns in ennn nns en etienne nennt nennen nns 16  Understanding the ADF and scanner glass                    esses nennen nennen nasse en nennen nn 17  Understanding the printer control PaNel            ccs sssssccccceessessssssnaeseeceececeescessesesesnensaesaeeeeeeeeeseesseseseeeeees 18  Understanding the hom
99. LIABILITY TO YOU     IN NO EVENT WILLLEXMARK  ITS SUPPLIERS  SUBSIDIARIES  OR RESELLERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL  INCIDENTAL   INDIRECT  EXEMPLARY  PUNITIVE  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOST PROFITS  OR REVENUES  LOST SAVINGS  INTERRUPTION OF USE OR ANY LOSS OF  INACCURACY IN  OR DAMAGE TO  DATA  OR RECORDS  FOR CLAIMS OF THIRD PARTIES  OR DAMAGE TO REAL OR TANGIBLE PROPERTY  FOR LOSS OF PRIVACY  ARISING OUT OR IN ANY WAY RELATED TO THE USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THE SOFTWARE PROGRAM  OR  OTHERWISE IN CONNECTION WITH ANY PROVISION OF THIS SOFTWARE LICENCE AGREEMENT   REGARDLESS OF  THE NATURE OF THE CLAIM  INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT  TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR STRICT LIABILITY   AND EVEN IF LEXMARK  OR ITS SUPPLIERS  AFFILIATES  OR  REMARKETERS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES  OR FOR ANY CLAIM BY YOU BASED  ONATHIRD PARTY CLAIM  EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT THIS EXCLUSION OF DAMAGES IS DETERMINED LEGALLY INVALID   THE FOREGOING LIMITATIONS APPLY EVEN IF THE ABOVE STATED REMEDIES FAIL OF THEIR ESSENTIAL PURPOSE     4 U S A  STATE LAWS  This Software Limited Warranty gives you specific legal rights  You may also have other rights  that vary from state to state  Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts or the  exclusion of limitation of incidental or consequential damages  so the above limitations may not apply to you     5 LICENSE GRANT  Lexmark grants you the followi
100. MODE    If Ready Hex appears on the display  then you must exit Hex Trace mode before you can print your job  Turn the  printer off and back on to exit Hex Trace mode     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 267    Tray linking does not work    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     LOAD THE SAME SIZE AND TYPE OF PAPER      Load the same size and type of paper in each tray to be linked       Move the paper guides to the correct positions for the paper size loaded in each tray     Ust THE SAME Paper SIZE AND PAPER TYPE SETTINGS    Print a menu settings page and compare the settings for each tray        f necessary  adjust the settings from the Paper Size Type menu     Note  The multipurpose feeder does not automatically sense the paper size  You must set the size from the Paper  Size Type menu     Large jobs do not collate    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     Maxe SURE COLLATE is SET TO ON  From the Finishing menu or Print Properties  set Collate to On     Note  Setting Collate to Off in the software overrides the setting in the Finishing menu     REDUCE THE COMPLEXITY OF THE PRINT JOB  Reduce the complexity of the print job by eliminating the number and size of fonts  the number and complexity of  images  and the number of pages in the job    IMAKE SURE THE PRINTER HAS ENOUGH MEMORY    Add printer memory or an optional hard disk     Unexpected page breaks occur    INCREASE THE PRINT TIMEO
101. Network   x      Std Network Setup or Net   x   Setup    LexLink menu    Menu item Description                Activate Activates LexLink support  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  View Nickname Lets you view the assigned LexLink nickname  Note  The LexLink nickname can be changed only from the Embedded Web  Server   M           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Standard USB menu       175             Menu item Description  PCL SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  On through a USB port requires it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes     On is the factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data     When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PostScript emulation if the PS  SmartSwitch setting is On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if the PS SmartSwitch setting is Off   PS SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  On through a USB port requires it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes     Onisthe factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data     When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PCL emulation if the PCL  SmartSwitch setting is On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if the PCL SmartSwi
102. No dial tone 237   noise emission levels 296  notices 292  293  294  295  296   297  298  299  300  301  302    O   options  fax card 25  42  firmware card 29  firmware cards 25    311    flash memory card 29   internal 25   Internal Solutions Port 32   memory card 28   memory cards 25   networking 25   ports 25   printer hard disk 38  options  touch screen   copy 102  103  104   e mail 110  111   fax 118  119   FTP 124 125   scan to computer 128  129  130  ordering   ADF maintenance kit 257   ADF pick assembly 257   ADF separator roll 257   charge rolls 257   fuser 256   maintenance kit 256   pick rollers 257   staple cartridges 258   transfer roller 257  ordering supplies 255  output file type   changing 109    P    paper  characteristics 86  letterhead 87  preprinted forms 87  recycled 88  selecting 87  selecting weight 159  setting size 71  setting type 71  storing 88  unacceptable 87  Universal Paper Size 163  Universal size setting 71  paper feed troubleshooting  message remains after jam is  cleared 279  paper jams  avoiding 140  Paper Loading menu 161  Paper Size Type menu 153  paper sizes  supported by the printer 89  Paper Texture menu 157    Index    paper type  custom 84  paper types  duplex support 90  supported by finisher 91  supported by printer 90  where to load 90  Paper Weight menu 159  paper weights  supported by finisher 91  Parallel   x   menu 176  PCL Emul menu 226  PDF menu 225  photos  copying 94  pick rollers  ordering 257  port settings  configuring
103. Off    178    Description    Determines whether or not the printer honors printer hardware initialization  requests from the computer    Notes     e Off is the factory default setting       The computer requests initialization by activating the Init signal from the  parallel port  Many personal computers activate the Init signal each time the  computer is turned on        Parallel Mode 2  On  Off    Determines whether the parallel port data is sampled on the leading or trailing edge  of strobe    Notes       Onisthe factory default setting     This menu appears only if a standard or optional parallel port is available        Mac Binary PS  On  Off  Auto    Sets the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs  Notes       Auto is the factory default setting     The Off setting filters print jobs using the standard protocol       The On setting processes raw binary PostScript print jobs        Parallel With ENA  ENA Address  ENA Netmask  ENA Gateway       Sets the network address  netmask  or gateway information for an external print  server that is attached to the printer using a parallel cable     Note  This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print          server through a parallel port        Serial   Xx   menu    This menu appears only if an optional serial card is installed       Menu item  PCL SmartSwitch    On  Off       Description    Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  th
104. On  Off    Allows interruption of a print job to copy a page or document    Note  On is the factory default setting        Custom Job scanning  On  Off    Lets you copy in a single copy job a document that contains mixed paper sizes       Allow Save as Shortcut  On  Off    Lets you save custom copy settings as shortcuts    Note  On is the factory default setting        Background Removal   4 to  4    Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy       Auto Center  On  Off       Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  Note  Off is the factory default setting              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item    Color Dropout   Color Dropout  None  Red  Green  Blue   Default Red Threshold  0 255   Default Green Threshold  0 255   Default Blue Threshold  0 255       197    Description    Specifies which color to drop during copies  and how much to increase or decrease  the dropout    Notes       None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout       128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold        Contrast  0   5  Best for content    Specifies the contrast used for the copy job    Note  Best for content is the factory default setting        Mirror Image  On  Off    Creates a mirror image of the original document    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Negative Image    Creates a negative image of the original document       On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off   Sh
105. Potential Damage  Do not turn off the printer while the flash memory is  formatting     Notes       A flash memory option card must be installed in the printer and operating  properly for this menu item to be available  The flash memory option card  must not be Read Write or Write protected       Selecting Yes deletes all data stored in flash memory          Nocancels the format request           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       225    Understanding printer menus    Menu item   Delete Downloads on Disk  Delete Now  Do Not Delete    Description    Removes downloads from the printer hard disk  including all held Jobs  buffered jobs   and parked jobs  Job accounting information is not affected     Note  Delete Now is the default setting           Job Acct Stat Prints a list of all stored job statistics or deletes the information from the printer hard  Print disk  Clear Notes     A printer hard disk must be installed in the printer and operating properly for  this menu item to be available     Selecting Print prints a list of statistics     Clear deletes all job statistics stored on the printer hard disk     The Clear selection will not appear if Job Accounting is set to MarkTrack     using NPA   Hex Trace Assists in isolating the source of a print job problem  Activate    Notes       When Activate is selected  all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal  and character representation and control codes are not executed       To exit or deactivate Hex Tra
106. R GLASS MAY BE DIRTY    Clean the scanner glass with a clean  lint free cloth dampened with water  For more information  see    Cleaning the  scanner glass    on page 251     THE COPY IS TOO LIGHT OR TOO DARK    Adjust the density of the copy     CHECK THE QUALITY OF THE ORIGINAL DOCUMENT    Make sure the quality of the original document is satisfactory     CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT    Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner     UNWANTED TONER IS IN THE BACKGROUND    Increase the background removal setting       Adjust the darkness to a lighter setting     PATTERNS  MOIR    APPEAR IN THE OUTPUT      Onthe Copy screen  select the Text Photo or Printed Image icon     Rotate the original document on the scanner glass       On the Copy screen  adjust the scale setting     TEXT IS LIGHT OR DISAPPEARING      On the Copy screen  touch the Text icon     Decrease the background removal setting      ncrease the contrast setting       Decrease the shadow detail setting     THE OUTPUT APPEARS WASHED OUT OR OVEREXPOSED    Onthe Copy screen  select the Printed Image icon       Decrease the background removal setting     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 270    Partial document or photo copies    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT    Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner     CHECK TH
107. R ann 132  THPSOM I A eVe O E S ERI RT                                                                                            M  132  Tips onvusing labels   5 5  nit Terr Du E Cr Cel bao ase Ere hri Eg eeele PENIS dest texere DRE Y Fx capa C deer Pasa d 133  Tips on using card stock oc he ptem cre tite toga tite ee a ERE daga su ga Cbr a eda PEE Ra Tape EM RET EAREN 133  Printing confidential and other held jobs                       sess eee nnn nnne nnn 134  Holding  jobs  in the printer    cii eie cio ut vo te De n akin Lien ras ges ee v Rd x bun oda e TREO Pd Ru Ee ded dde 134  Printing confidential and other held jobs from Windows                     esses nennen nennen 135  Printing confidential and other held jobs from a Macintosh computer                     sees 135  Printing froma flash drive    teen ra keines aeta    ci Deu o cune ska Ee van een eco Diae aa edad ae Rd nu aaa ate dea ann nua 136  Printing information DagGs     sco endo e Knee aea eI sine caer tea paa saa Seu baa AR Lens E udo ra TRE PRA ES 137  Printing a  CirectOry ape T                                               137  Printing the print quality test pages             ccssccecesssseceeeesesseeeceesssssusecesceseeeecessssaeeeeesesesseeeeeseseeasaeesesesssesaeeeeess 137  Canceling  Herodi                       R  137  Canceling a print job from the printer control panel                      sess eene nennen nennen nennen 137  Canceling a print job from the computer            cccccceessssseceee
108. RESS SOFTWARE LIMITED WARRANTY     This Agreement is to be read in conjunction with certain statutory provisions  as that may be in force from time to  time  that imply warranties or conditions or impose obligations on Lexmark that cannot be excluded or modified   If any such provisions apply  then to the extent Lexmark is able  Lexmark hereby limits its liability for breach of those  provisions to one of the following  providing you a replacement copy of the Software Program or reimbursement  of the price paid for the Software Program     The Software Program may include internet links to other software applications and or internet web pages hosted  and operated by third parties unaffiliated with Lexmark  You acknowledge and agree that Lexmark is not responsible    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 305    in any way for the hosting  performance  operation  maintenance  or content of  such software applications and or  internet web pages     3 LIMITATION OF REMEDY  TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW  ANY AND ALL LIABILITY OF  LEXMARK UNDER THIS SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT IS EXPRESSLY LIMITED TO THE GREATER OF THE PRICE PAID  FOR THE SOFTWARE PROGRAM AND FIVE U S  DOLLARS  OR THE EQUIVALENT IN LOCAL CURRENCY   YOUR SOLE  REMEDY AGAINST LEXMARK IN ANY DISPUTE UNDER THIS SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT SHALL BE TO SEEK TO  RECOVER ONE OF THESE AMOUNTS  UPON PAYMENT OF WHICH LEXMARK SHALL BE RELEASED AND DISCHARGED  OF ALL FURTHER OBLIGATIONS AND 
109. RRANTIES  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WILL APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD  ALL INFORMATION  SPECIFICATIONS  PRICES   AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE     Limitation of liability    Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document  For any claim concerning performance or  nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty  you may recover actual  damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph     Lexmark s liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the product  that caused the damages  This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or damage to real  property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable  IN NO EVENT WILL LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR  ANY LOST PROFITS  LOST SAVINGS  INCIDENTAL DAMAGE  OR OTHER ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 304    This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the possibility of such damages  Lexmark is not liable for any  claim by you based on a third party claim     This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark  Lexmark s and its  Suppliers  and Remarketers  limitations of remedies are not cumulative  Such Suppliers and Remarketers are intended  beneficiaries of this limitation     Additional rights    Some states do not allow 
110. RRECTLY    Print a menu settings page and check to see if the option is listed in the Installed Options list  If the option is not  listed  then reinstall it  For more information  see the hardware setup documentation that came with the option  or  go to www lexmark com publications to view the option instruction sheet     IVIAKE SURE THE OPTION IS SELECTED    From the computer you are printing from  select the option  For more information  see  Updating available options  in the printer driver  on page 47     Paper trays    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     IVIAKE SURE THE PAPER IS LOADED CORRECTLY  1 Open the paper tray   2 Check for paper jams or misfeeds   3 Make sure paper guides are aligned against the edges of the paper     4 Make sure the paper tray closes properly     RESET THE PRINTER    Turn the printer off  wait about 10 seconds  and then turn the printer on     IVIAKE SURE THE PAPER TRAY IS INSTALLED CORRECTLY    If the paper tray is listed on the menu settings page  but paper jams when it enters or exits the tray  then it may not  be properly installed  Reinstall the paper tray  For more information  see the hardware setup documentation that  came with the paper tray  or go to www lexmark com publications to view the paper tray instruction sheet     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 277    2000 sheet tray    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     THE ELEVATOR TRAY IS NOT 
111. SSL    Required   SMTP Server Authentication Specifies the type of user authentication required for scan to e mail  No authentication required privileges  Login   Plain Note   No authentication required  is the factory default setting   CRAM MD5  Digest MD5  NTLM  Kerberos 5   Ne SJ       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer menus 170    Menu item Description    Device Initiated E mail Specifies server information  None  Use Device SMTP Credentials    Notes     The message boxes have a limitation of 512 characters   User Initiated E mail  None  Use Device SMTP Credentials  Use Session User ID and Password  Use Session E mail address and Password  Prompt User      None is the factory default setting for Device Initiated E mail and  User Initiated E mail     Device Userid  Device password    Kerberos 5 Realm          NTLM Domain  V       Network Reports menu    This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports    Standard Network or Network   x      Std Network Setup or Net   x   Setup    Reports or Network    M          Reports  Menu item Description  Print Setup Page Prints a report containing information about the current network setup  Print NetWare Setup Notes   Page  E   The Setup Page contains information about the network printer settings  such as the  TCP IP address     The NetWare Setup Page menu item appears only on models that support NetWare and  shows information about NetWare settings   Ne J             Netw
112. Server Address    DNS Server Address Lets you view or change the current DNS Server Address J   IPv6 menu    Use the following menu items to view or set the Internet Protocol version 6  IPv6  information   Note  This menu is available only for network models or printers attached to print servers   This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports  gt  Standard Network or Network  lt x gt   gt  Std Network Setup or Net  lt x gt  Setup  gt  IPv6                Menu item Description   Enable IPv6 Enables IPv6 in the printer  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off   Auto Configuration Specifies whether the network adapter accepts the automatic IPv6  On address configuration entries provided by a router  Off Note  On is the factory default setting    View Hostname Lets you view the current setting   View Address Note  These settings can be changed only from the Embedded Web   Server    View Router Address   Enable DHCPv6 Enables DHCPv6 in the printer  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off   XX A             Wireless menu   Use the following menu items to view or configure the wireless internal print server settings   Note  This menu is available only for models connected to a wireless network    This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports  gt  Network  lt x gt   gt  Net  lt x gt  Setup  gt  Wireless    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer menus    Menu item    173          802 11b
113. Type    5 Touch the arrows for the desired tray until the correct size or type setting appears   6 Touch Submit     7 Touch    to return to the home screen        Configuring Universal paper settings    The Universal Paper Size is a user defined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the printer  menus  Set the Paper Size for the specified tray to Universal when the size you want is not available from the Paper  Size menu  Then  specify all of the following Universal size settings for your paper       Units of measure  millimeters or inches     Portrait Width    Portrait Height    Note  The smallest supported Universal size is 76 x 76 mm  3 x 3 in    the largest size is 216 x 356 mm  8 5 x 14 in       Specify a unit of measurement   1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears    2 Onthe home screen  touch         3 Touch Paper Menu    4 Touch the down arrow until Universal Setup appears  and then touch Universal Setup   5 Touch the left or right arrow to select the desired unit of measure    6 Touch Portrait Width or Portrait Height     7 Touch the arrows to select the desired width or height     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 72    8 Touch Submit to save your selection   Submitting Selection appears  followed by the Paper menu     9 Touch Al to return to the home screen     Loading the standard or optional 250 sheet or 550 sheet tray    Although the 250 sheet tray and the 550 sheet tray are di
114. UT VALUE  1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   On the home screen  touch        Touch Settings   Touch General Settings   Touch the down arrow until Timeouts appears     Touch Timeouts     nv Oo Uu A VU N    Touch the left or right arrow next to Print Timeout until the desired value appears     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 268    8 Touch Submit     9 Touch   l        Solving copy problems    Copier does not respond    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES    Clear any error messages     CHECK THE POWER    Make sure the printer is plugged in  the power is on  and Ready appears     Scanner unit does not close  Make sure there are no obstructions   1 Lift the scanner unit   2 Remove any obstruction keeping the scanner unit open     3 Lower the scanner unit     Poor copy quality    These are some examples of poor copy quality     Blank pages    Checkerboard pattern    Distorted graphics or pictures    Missing characters    Faded print    Dark print    Skewed lines    Smudges    Streaks    Unexpected characters    White lines in print    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 269    CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES    Clear any error messages     THE TONER MAY BE LOW    When 88 Cartridge lowappears or when the print becomes faded  replace the print cartridge     THE SCANNE
115. WORKING PROPERLY      Make sure the printer is properly connected to the 2000 sheet tray       Make sure the printer is turned on     THE PAPER FEED ROLLERS DO NOT TURN TO ADVANCE PAPER      Make sure the printer is properly connected to the 2000 sheet tray       Make sure the printer is turned on     Envelope feeder    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     RESET THE PRINTER    Turn the printer off  wait about 10 seconds  and then turn the printer on     MAKE SURE THE ENVELOPES ARE LOADED CORRECTLY  1 Adjust the envelope support for the length of envelope you are using     2 For more information  see  Loading the envelope feeder  on page 81     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE AND PAPER SIZE SETTINGS  Make sure the paper type and paper size settings match the envelopes you are using   1 From the printer control panel  check the settings for the envelope feeder from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct settings from the computer     For Windows users  specify the settings from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the settings from the Print dialog     IVIAKE SURE THE ENVELOPE FEEDER IS INSTALLED CORRECTLY    If the envelope feeder is listed on the menu settings page  but an envelope jams when it enters or exits the feeder   then it may not be properly installed  Reinstall the envelope feeder  For more information  see the hardware setup  documentation that came with the envelope feeder  or go to www lexmark c
116. YOU ARE INSTALLING THIS PRODUCT FOR USE BY OTHER PARTIES  YOU AGREE TO INFORM THE  USERS THAT USE OF THE PRODUCT INDICATES ACCEPTANCE OF THESE TERMS     1 STATEMENT OF SOFTWARE LIMITED WARRANTY  Lexmark warrants that the media  e g   diskette or compact disk   on which the Software Program  if any  is furnished is free from defects in materials and workmanship under normal  use during the warranty period  The warranty period is ninety  90  days and commences on the date the Software  Program is delivered to the original end user  This limited warranty applies only to Software Program media  purchased new from Lexmark or an Authorized Lexmark Reseller or Distributor  Lexmark will replace the Software  Program should it be determined that the media does not conform to this limited warranty     2 DISCLAIMER AND LIMITATION OF WARRANTIES  EXCEPT AS PROVIDED IN THIS SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT  AND TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW  LEXMARK AND ITS SUPPLIERS PROVIDE THE  SOFTWARE PROGRAM  AS IS  AND HEREBY DISCLAIM ALL OTHER WARRANTIES AND CONDITIONS  EITHER EXPRESS  OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  TITLE  NON INFRINGEMENT  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR  A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  AND ABSENCE OF VIRUSES  ALL WITH REGARD TO THE SOFTWARE PROGRAM  TO THE  EXTENT LEXMARK CANNOT BY LAW DISCLAIM ANY COMPONENT OF THE IMPLIED WARRATIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  LEXMARK LIMITS THE DURATION OF SUCH  WARRANTIES TO THE 90 DAY TERM OF THE EXP
117. a document into the ADF  adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch E mail    Type an e mail address    Touch Options    Touch Subject    Type the e mail subject    Touch Done    Touch Message    Type an e mail message    Touch Done     Touch E mail It     Changing the output file type    1    OU A W N    Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch E mail    Type an e mail address    Touch Options     Touch the button that represents the file type you want to send       PDF   Creates a single file with multiple pages  viewable with Adobe Reader  Adobe Reader is provided free by  Adobe at www adobe com       Secure PDF   Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access      TIFF   Creates multiple files or a single file  If Multi page TIFF isturned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  Web Server  then TIFF saves one page in each file  The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing 110      JPEG    Creates and attaches a separate file for each page of your original document  viewable by most Web  browsers and graphics progra
118. a ea Pa EEE aa a a aaan 45  Printing a menu settings page    dri anoitar RE ARR SR EAR E aaa aa AEO AEDE ARR RR FR RE ARa 45  Printing a network setup PABE      i cccececccessccsssaieesnsctiecsedesssceacsacesacecndsecdasaddaedagenscdenddaedededdeascelgelvedeadedeccudedececendet 46   Setting Up  the printer softWaLle    1e a aaa e eas a A E EE E E 46  Installing printer software           cccccsscccccesesssseeeecesssseceecseseeecescsesseececesessaseeecesssssseeeescesseeseses Tingi i ahii Cai ita iai 46  Updating available options in the printer driver              ccccscccccesssssseeeescssnseececesseseeeceesesueceeseseaseeesesesseesaaeeesesses 47   Setting up wireless printing    nennen nennen enemies nnn nn nnne nena na nasi rsen rins a aane n nnn anas 48  Information you will need to set up the printer on a wireless network              ccsscccceessssseeeeeseseesesesssssseeeseeees 48  Installing the printer on a wireless network  Windows                      eeeeese seen nnne 49  Installing the printer on a wireless network  Macintosh                       esses nennen nnn 50   Installing the printer on a wired network                   sess nn nennen nnne 53   Changing port settings after installing a new network Internal Solutions Port                           esses 56   Setting up serial prihtilg  s eu cc ece edt eth a ee nno aee Mena aa eoo shal steavedtuatalecdendiedaddaesUvatiaedsecciae 58   Setting Up the printer to faX            rtr eo xe e ceo RR Reed a eoe ee Pos
119. actory default setting   Off  Negative Image Creates a negative image of the original document  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Shadow Detail Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image  0 4 Note  0 is the factory default setting   Scan edge to edge Specifies whether the original document is scanned edge to edge  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Sharpness Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a scanned image  0 5 Note  3 is the factory default setting   Use cc  bcc  Enables the use of the cc  and bcc  fields  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    FTP Settings menu       211                         Menu item Description  Format Specifies the format of the FTP file  PDF   pdf  Note  PDF   pdf  is the factory default setting   Secure PDF  TIFF   tif   JPEG   jpg   XPS   xps   PDF Version Sets the version level of the PDF file for FTP  1 2 1 6 Note  1 5 is the factory default setting   Content Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to FTP  Text Photo Notes   Photograph  Text   Text Photo is the factory default setting  Text Photo is used when the  documents are mostly text or line art     Photograph is used when the document is a high quality photograph or inkjet  print    Text is used when the document is mostly text   Color Specifies whether a job prints in grayscale or color  Gray Note  Gray is the factory default se
120. adow Detail Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a copy  0 4    Note  O is the factory default setting        Scan edge to edge    Specifies if the original document is scanned edge to edge prior to copying                On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Sharpness Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a copy  0 5 Note  3 is the factory default setting   Sample Copy Creates a sample copy of the original document  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off          Fax Settings menu    Fax Mode  Analog Fax Setup  menu    Analog Fax Setup mode sends the fax job by way of a telephone line     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       198    Understanding printer menus    General Fax Settings    Menu item    Fax Cover Page   Fax Cover Page  Off by default  On by default  Never Use  Always Use   Include To field  On  Off   Include From field  On  Off   From   Include Message field  On  Off   Message   Include Logo  On  Off   Include Footer  lt x gt   Footer  lt x gt     Description    Configures the fax cover page    Note  Off is the factory default setting for all Fax Cover Page options        Station Name    Specifies the name of the fax within the printer       Station Number    Specifies a number associated with the fax       Station ID  Station Name  Station Number    Specifies how the fax is identified       Enable Manual Fax  On  Off    Sets the printer to fax manually only  which requires a line splitter and a telephone  hand set    No
121. ads only until memory is needed  Downloads are  deleted in order to process print jobs       The On setting retains the downloads during language  changes and printer resets  If the printer runs out of  memory  38 Memory Full appears  and downloads are  not deleted        Print All Order  Alphabetically  Newest First  Oldest First       Specifies the order in which held and confidential jobs are printed  when Print All is selected    Notes       Alphabetically is the factory default setting       Print jobs always appear in alphabetical order on the printer  control panel           Finishing menu    Menu item  Sides  Duplex   2 sided  1 sided    Description    Specifies whether duplex  2 sided  printing is set as the default for all print jobs  Notes       1 sided is the factory default setting       To set 2 sided printing from the software program  for Windows users  click  File    Print  and then click Properties  Preferences  Options  or Setup  for  Macintosh users  choose File    Print  and then adjust the settings from the  Print dialog and pop up menus        Duplex Binding    Defines the way duplexed pages are bound and how the printing on the back of the                Long Edge page is oriented in relation to the printing on the front of the page  Short Edge Notes     Long Edge is the factory default setting     Long Edge specifies that binding be placed on the left edge of portrait pages  and the top edge of landscape pages     Short Edge specifies that binding be 
122. aha vana RE ra dad eaae dated ad 258  Recycling Lexmark eo do  P  ed CREER TEENS EE 258  Moving the Printers 2  eec e Ere ette ore ERR ke a ONERE e e dox ENS EEEE Dh eue tenga Due woe dep cere oen ako cue nU PRENNE 258  Before moving the    printer             ertet vasa ci dos E oda HE ERE VERA Ee e D eDA Xa ped ad E cua ERN Re VIS E aa aiaiai 258  Moving the printer to another location            cccccccsscccccesssssseccceessseecesssssseececescsaseeessesesseeeeeseseeasees rsen niani 259  Setting the printer up in a new location    eene ener nennen nine e rnnt senses e nnn nns 259  Shipping the Printer sis    iei etie aa E HAAS CV cata RURAL E E ZR CERE RN EEEa 259    Administrative SupDOFt   iiesevo esee taret a nor PRENSPEPE EE ea Eo Vau SFr VxPP PRISE REPE es vie tes aD    Finding advanced networking and administrator information              c ccccccceeseesecteceeeeeeeenaececeeeeseeseneees 260  Using the Embedded Web Sertyvet         1   2  eiae ete tke uera nnn RT A E ads EREe ER aa aaa naa crt EEE 260  Checking the device Status           cccccccccssccecsessneeceeseseaeecceseeeeeceeuaeceecesesecesseeeaeeeesseeaeeeceseeeesaeeeeeensaees 260  Setting Up e Mail alerts    itti eet ede tete ra ane kde a RE TEN S YR RAE E FER eae eaae varus 260  MISC                RR 261  Adjusting the brightness of the display    eese nennen enn ennnneis 261  Adjusting PoWet SaV6t    cr essetis nenne ene santlectisvee anch Causae n add gar acl a e aa dca aaa Eea iaaa Sei 262  Restoring the 
123. ail Settings    Click Setup E mail Server    Fill in the fields with the appropriate information     Click Add     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing 107    Configuring the e mail settings  1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings    3 Click E mail FTP Settings    4 Click E mail Settings    5 Fill in the fields with the appropriate information     6 Click Submit     Creating an e mail shortcut    Creating an e mail shortcut using the Embedded Web Server    1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     Click Settings   Under Other Settings  click Manage Shortcuts     Click E mail Shortcut Setup     Uu 5 U   N    Type a unique name for the recipient  and then enter the e mail address   Note  If you are entering multiple addresses  then separate each address with a comma       6 Select the scan settings  Format  Content  Color  and Resolution      7 Enter a shortcut number  and then click Add     If you enter a number that is already in use  then you are prompted to select another number     Creating an e mail shortcut using the touch screen  1 On the home screen  touch E mail     2 Type the reci
124. al document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch Copy     4 Touch Options     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 102    5 Touch Overlay   6 Touch the button containing the overlay you want to use   7 Touch Done     8 Touch Copy It     Canceling a copy job    Canceling a copy job while the document is in the ADF    When the ADF begins processing a document  the scanning screen appears  To cancel the copy job  touch Cancel Job  on the touch screen     A    Canceling scan job    screen appears  The ADF clears all pages in the ADF and cancels the job     Canceling a copy job while copying pages using the scanner glass    Touch Cancel Job on the touch screen     A    Canceling scan job    screen appears  Once the job is canceled  the copy screen appears     Canceling a copy job while the pages are being printed  1 Touch Cancel Job on the touch screen  or press o on the keypad   2 Touch the job you want to cancel     3 Touch Delete Selected Jobs     The remaining print job is canceled  The home screen appears     Understanding the copy screens and options    Copy from    This option opens a screen where you can enter the size of the documents 
125. al documents  or make one sided copies   simplex  from two sided original documents     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 104    Collate    This option keeps the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when printing multiple copies of the document  The  factory default setting for Collate is on  the output pages of your copies will be ordered  1 2 3   1 2 3   1 2 3   If you  want all the copies of each page to remain together  turn Collate off  and your copies will be ordered  1 1 1   2 2 2    3 3 3      Options   Touching the Options button opens a screen where you can change Paper Saver  Advanced Imaging  Custom Job   Separator Sheets  Margin Shift  Edge Erase  Header Footer  Overlay  Content  Advanced Duplex  and Save as Shortcut  settings     Paper Saver   This option lets you print two or more sheets of an original document together on the same page  Paper Saver is also  called N up printing  The N stands for Number  For example  2 up would print two pages of your document on a single  page  and 4 up would print four pages of your document on a single page  Touching Print Page Borders adds or removes  the outline border surrounding the original document pages on the output page    Advanced Imaging   This option lets you adjust Background Removal  Contrast  Shadow Detail  Scan Edge to Edge  Color Balance  and mirror  image before you copy the document     Custom Job    This option combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job     Separator Shee
126. al trays    4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Turn the printer back on     59 Incompatible envelope feeder    Try one or more of the following     Remove the envelope feeder       Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the envelope feeder     59 Incompatible output bin   x      Try one or more of the following     Remove the specified output bin       Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the specified output bin     59 Incompatible tray   x      Try one or more of the following     Remove the specified tray       Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the specified tray     61 Remove defective disk    Try one or more of the following       Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing        nstall a different printer hard disk before performing any operations that require a printer hard disk     62 Disk full    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue processing     Delete fonts  macros  and other data stored on the printer hard disk        nstall a larger printer hard disk     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       247    Understanding printer messages 248    63 Unformatted disk    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing       Format the printer hard disk     If the error message remains  the hard disk may be defective and requi
127. all end  earlier if it  or its original contents  are substantially used up  depleted  or consumed     To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase  You may be required to deliver  your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark  or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark designated location   You are responsible for loss of  or damage to  a product in transit to the Remarketer or the Lexmark designated location     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 303    When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part  the item replaced becomes the property of the  Remarketer or Lexmark  The replacement may be a new or repaired item     The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product     Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced  altered  in need of a repair not  included in warranty service  damaged beyond repair  or if the product is not free of all legal obligations  restrictions   liens  and encumbrances     Before you present this product for warranty service  remove all print cartridges  programs  data  and removable storage  media  unless directed otherwise by Lexmark      For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area contact  Lexmark on the World Wide Web at http   support lexmark com     Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its 
128. and the Embedded Web Server Administrator s Guide on the Lexmark  Web site at www lexmark com     Using the Embedded Web Server    If the printer is installed on a network  the Embedded Web Server is available for a range of functions including     Viewing a virtual display of the printer control panel    Checking the status of the printer supplies    Configuring printer settings    Configuring network settings    Viewing reports    To access the Embedded Web Server  type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Notes        f you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP address in  the TCP IP section       For more information  see the Networking Guide on the Software and Documentation CD and the Embedded  Web Server Administrator s Guide on the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com     Checking the device status    Using the Embedded Web Server  you can view paper tray settings  the level of toner in the print cartridge  the  percentage of life remaining in the maintenance kit  and capacity measurements of certain printer parts  To view the  device status     1 Type the printer IP address in the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Device Status     Setting up e mail alerts    You can have the printer send you an e mail when the supplies are getting
129. anner glass        b Touch Copy Quick Test   The scanner prints a copy of the Quick Test page     Touch Flatbed   Use the copy of the Quick Test page to adjust the Left Margin and Top Margin settings   Touch Submit      gt  0 Qa    Touch Copy Quick Test and compare the new copy to the original   Repeat the flatbed alignment steps until the position on the page of the Quick Test copy closely matches the  original   To align the ADF   a Do one of the following     To align the ADF front  place the Quick Test page faceup  short edge first into the ADF     To align the ADF back  place the Quick Test page facedown  short edge first into the ADF   b Touch Copy Quick Test   The scanner prints a copy of the Quick Test page     Touch ADF Front or ADF Back   Use the copy of the Quick Test page to adjust the Horizontal Adjust and Top Margin settings   Touch Submit      gt  0 Q O    Touch Copy Quick Test and compare the new copy to the original   Repeat the ADF alignment steps until the position on the page of the Quick Test copy closely matches the original     9 Touch Back     10 Touch Exit Configuration     Storing supplies    Choose a cool  clean storage area for the printer supplies  Store supplies right side up in their original packing until you  are ready to use them     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 254    Do not expose supplies to     Direct sunlight    Temperatures above 35  C  95  F     High humidity above 80     Salty air    Corrosi
130. anualsPrinter com Manuals       43    Additional printer setup 44    5 Insert the plug of the fax card interface cable into the receptacle of the system board              6 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door                                                        Attaching cables    Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable or Ethernet cable     Be sure to match the following     The USB symbol on the cable with the USB symbol on the printer    The appropriate Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 45                   Ethernet port       USB port      N   H8       Verifying printer setup  Once all hardware and software options are installed and the printer is turned on  verify that the printer is set up  correctly by printing the following         Menu settings page   Use this page to verify that all printer options are installed correctly  A list of installed options  appears toward the bottom of the page  If an option you installed is not listed  then it is not installed correctly   Remove the option and install it again       Network setup page    If your printer is a network model and is attached to a network  print a network setup page  to verify the network connection  This page also provides important information that aids network printing  configuration     Printing a menu settings page  Print a menu settings page to review the current menu settings and t
131. atthe flash memory  If the error message remains  the flash memory may be defective and require replacing     54 Network   x   software error    x   is the number of the network connection     Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to continue printing     Turn the printer off and then back on to reset the printer       Upgrade  flash  the network firmware in the printer or print server     54 Serial option   x   error    x   is the number of the serial option     Try one or more of the following     Check that the serial cable is connected correctly and is the proper one for the serial port       Check that the serial interface parameters  protocol  baud  parity  and data bits  are set correctly on the printer  and host computer       Touch Continue to continue printing       Turn the printer power off and then back on to reset the printer     54 Standard network software error    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to continue printing     Turn the printer off and then back on to reset the printer       Upgrade  flash  the network firmware in the printer or print server     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 245    55 Unsupported option in slot  lt x gt    lt x gt  is a slot on the printer system board   Try one or more of the following   1 Turn the printer power off   2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet   3 Remove the unsupported option card from the printer system board   4 Connect the powe
132. ault setting        Custom  lt x gt  Texture  Smooth  Normal       Rough    Specifies the relative texture of the custom paper loaded in a specific tray    Note  Normal is the factory default setting           Paper Weight menu    Menu item    i                         Description  Plain Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy  Card Stock Weight Specifies the relative weight of the card stock loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy  Transparency Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy  Recycled Weight Specifies the relative weight of the recycled paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy  Labels Weight Specifies the relative weight of the labels loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy  Vinyl Labels Weight Specifies the relative weight of the vinyl labels loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Heavy          M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 160                                     Menu item Description   Bond Weight Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  Light Note  Normal is the factory
133. ax call  Wait for the message to clear     Busy    Wait for the message to clear     Call complete    A fax call is completed  Wait for the message to clear     Change  lt src gt  to  lt x gt      lt src gt  is a tray or feeder  and  lt x gt  is a paper size or type     You can change the current paper source for the remainder of the print job  The formatted page will print on the paper    loaded in the selected tray  This may cause clipping of text or images  Try one or more of the following       Select the paper tray with the correct paper size or type       Touch Use current  src  to ignore the message and print from the tray selected for the print job       Touch Continue to continue the job if the correct size and type are loaded in the tray  and this size and type are    specified in the printer control panel Paper menu     Note  If you touch Continue when there is no paper in the tray  the job is not continued       Touch Cancel job to cancel the current job     Check tray   x   connection    Try one or more of the following     Turn the printer off and then back on   If the error occurs a second time   1 Turn the printer off   Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet   Remove the tray   Reattach the tray     Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     a uU 5 UN    Restart the printer     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 233    If the error occurs again    1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord f
134. bins       The Mail Overflow setting treats each bin as a  separate mailbox until a bin becomes full  and then  the printer automatically diverts sheets to an  overflow bin      The Link Optional setting links together all available  output bins except the standard bin and only appears  when at least two optional bins are installed       The Type Assignment setting assigns each paper type  to an output bin        Assign Type Bin Selects an output bin for each supported paper type  Plain Paper Bin Available selections for each type are   Card Stock Bin Disabled  Transparency Bin Standard Bin  Recycled Bin Bin  lt x gt   Labels Bin Note  Standard Bin is the factory default setting   Vinyl Labels Bin  Bond Bin  Envelope Bin    Rough Envelope Bin  Letterhead Bin  Preprinted Bin  Colored Bin   Light Bin   Heavy Bin   Rough Bin   Custom   x   Bin                Reports menu    Note  When you select a menu item from the Reports menu  the indicated report prints        Description    Menu Settings Page Prints a report containing information about paper loaded into trays  installed  memory  the total page count  alarms  timeouts  the control panel language  the  TCP IP address  the status of supplies  the status of the network connection  and  other information       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       Menu item    Device Statistics    166    Description    Prints a report containing printer statistics such as supply information and detai
135. bstitutions are  allowed     The Off setting indicates no size substitutions are allowed       Setting a substitution lets the job print without a Change Paper message  appearing           M       Paper Texture menu    Menu item    Plain Texture  Smooth  Normal  Rough    Note  Normal is the factory default setting     Description    Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray       Card Stock Texture  Smooth    Specifies the relative texture of the card stock loaded in a specific tray             Notes   Normal  Rough   Normal is the factory default setting     Settings appear only if card stock is supported   Transparency Texture Specifies the relative texture of the transparencies loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough       M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 158                                     Menu item Description   Recycled Texture Specifies the relative texture of the recycled paper loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Labels Texture Specifies the relative texture of the labels loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Vinyl Labels Texture Specifies the relative texture of the vinyl labels loaded in a specific tray  Smooth Note  Normal is the factory default setting   Normal  Rough   Bond Texture Specifies the relative texture
136. caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  surges     This equipment uses CA11A telephone jacks     Avis r  serv   aux utilisateurs du r  seau t  l  phonique du Canada    Ce produit est conforme aux sp  cifications techniques d Industrie Canada  Le num  ro REN  ringer equivalence number    num  ro d   quivalence de sonnerie  fournit une indication du nombre maximum de terminaux pouvant   tre connect  s     l interface t  l  phonique  En bout de ligne  le nombre d appareils qui peuvent   tre connect  s n est pas directement  limit    mais la somme des REN de ces appareils ne doit pas d  passer cinq  Le num  ro REN du modem est indiqu   sur  l   tiquette produit situ  e    l arri  re de l   quipement     Les compagnies de t  l  phone constatent que les surtensions   lectriques  en particulier celles dues    la foudre   entra  nent d importants d  g  ts sur les terminaux priv  s connect  s    des sources d alimentation CA  II s   agit la d un  probl  me majeur d   chelle nationale  En cons  quence  il vous est recommand   de brancher un parasurtenseur dans  la prise de courant    laquelle l   quipement est connect    Utilisez un parasurtenseur r  pondant    des caract  ristiques  nominales satisfaisantes et certifi   par le laboratoire d assureurs UL  Underwriter s Laboratories   un autre laboratoire  agr     detype NRTL  Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory  ou un organisme de certification agr     dans votre r  gion  ou pays  Ceci pr  vient tout endommagement 
137. ccccccceessesnceeeeseneeceeseseaeeceeseaeeeceeseeaaeeceeseseeeeceeseeeseaeeeees 71  Loading the standard or optional 250 sheet or 550 sheet tray    72  Loading the 2000 sheet tray    eee inene EISE Hae ERR da E RATE Ped dU E Eee d Fa ER e deoa anis 75  Loading the multipurpose feeder                     essere nennen nnne enn nni nnn ases e nennen aser 79  Loading the envelope feeder              rrt eei riri ote oen rena raa beo vaa eue Rete en ea a a Ya eR e pae De NENES 81  Linking and unlinking trays                  eesesssessseeeeeee eere nennen nennen nennen nnne n n rnn nnne sr sna n snas nnns e nnn 83  LAKINE trays  cu estt ett DET tn ren He te asd nati tide ter ete 83  Unlinking trays  e Eee ient eet ec utto ieu pa tutt rendi tin ilius Ion cu eques quse AE E E E eR Ron OP ee disi T i 83  Assigning a custom paper type NAME            cccssesssssnnesneeeeceeeeeceeeeesceesseseeeeeeseueeeauecesssessseeseeeasuauaueaseauaaaaaaeeesenes 84  Changing a Custom Type   X   name  s iih iiti tice em dance eda qaad de asa sdb pe ML AE dee eu td a eua eec den tea 84    Paper and specialty media guidelines                                                          86    Paper BUIM  AIEO DD MEE                     met 86  Paper characteristics  eor Goins MR OR UO MP eR Ped dS cU cM cg p sanyo saacedodaadwacceens SEN RNC VR RN EN ERR UNI TR EMUEE 86  Unacceptable paper cscs es e te ee a ila ea EE EE edd tie S bedi UER UU ea aie aaa 87  Selecting paper RM 87  Selecting preprinted forms a
138. ccess Cover  Open 240  scanning to acomputer 127  improving scan quality 130  scanning to a flash drive 128  scanning to an FTP address  creating shortcuts using the  computer 123  creating shortcuts using the touch  screen 124  improving FTP quality 126  using shortcut numbers 123  using the address book 123  using the keypad 122  Securely clearing disk space 240  Security Audit Log menu 183  Sending page  lt n gt  240  Serial  lt x gt  240  Serial  lt x gt  menu 178  serial port 58  serial printing  setting up 58  Set clock 240    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Set Date Time menu 184  setting  paper size 71  paper type 71  TCP IP address 171  Universal Paper Size 71  setting up  serial printing 58  setting up the printer  on a wired network   Macintosh  53  ona wired network  Windows  53  Settings menu 185  Setup menu 219  shipping the printer 259  shortcuts  creating  e mail 107  fax destination 114  115  FTP destination 123  124  SMTP server not set up  Contact  system administrator  240  SMTP Setup menu 169  Some held jobs were not  restored 241  Standard Network menu 167  standard tray  loading 72  Standard USB menu 175  staple cartridges  ordering 258  status of supplies  checking 254  storing  paper 88  supplies 253  subject and message information  adding to e mail 109  Substitute Size menu 157  supplies  conserving 254  status of 254  storing 253  supplies  ordering 255  ADF maintenance kit 257  ADF pick assembly 257  ADF separator roll 257  charge
139. ce  For example  if specialty media  is located in the multipurpose feeder  and you want to make copies on that media     1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides    3 On the home screen  touch Copy    4 Touch Copy from  and then identify the size of the original document    5 Touch Copy to  and then touch Manual Feeder or the tray that contains the paper type you want   Note  If you choose Manual Feeder  then you will need to also select the paper size and type     6 Touch Copy It     Copying a document that contains mixed paper sizes    Use the ADF to copy an original document that contains mixed paper sizes  Depending on the paper sizes loaded and  the  Copy to  and  Copy from  settings  each copy is either printed on mixed paper sizes  Example 1  or scaled to fit a  single paper size  Example 2     Example 1  Copying to mixed paper sizes    The printer has two paper trays  one tray loaded with letter size paper and the other with legal size paper  A document  that contains letter  and legal size pages needs to be copied     1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos 
140. ce  turn the printer off or reset the printer        Coverage Estimator    Provides an estimate of the percentage coverage of black on a page  The estimate is                         Off printed on a separate page at the end of each print job   On Note  Off is the factory default setting   LCD Contrast Adjusts the contrast lighting of the display  1 10 Notes     5 is the factory default setting     A higher setting makes the display appear lighter     A lower setting makes the display appear darker   LCD Brightness Adjusts the brightness of the backlight on the display  1 10 Notes     5 is the factory default setting     A higher setting makes the display appear lighter     A lower setting makes the display appear darker  J  NS  PDF menu  Menu item Description  Scale to Fit Scales page content to fit the selected paper size  Yes Note  No is the factory default setting   No       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item    Annotations  Do Not Print  Print    226    Description    Prints annotations in a PDF    Note  Do Not Print is the factory default setting        PostScript menu    Menu item  Print PS Error    On  Off    Description    Prints a page containing the PostScript error    Note  Off is the factory default setting           Font Priority  Resident  Flash Disk       r    Establishes the font search order    Notes       Resident is the factory default setting     e A formatted flash memory option card or printer hard 
141. cesesesuaee rasan sene rans nnn 271  Cannot scan froma COMPUTED sasite eieaa dava Pre pani ve E ERRE re eva GE i a a k a eye qudd guae 272  Solving fax Problem INED                                                  E EE 272  Caller IDIS NOt SHOWN e                                     272  Cannot serid OF receive a fax   ise ee UNE RHEINE ERE NR lage TES NER EEEE E E ERU ES te E eR exten 272  Can send but  not receiVe Taxes  ect eem ER HR IR NER E RREO ERI EERE ENS ede EQ QR eateries eee 274  Can receive but not send faxeS        eeeeeccceeeeseeeeseseeeesaeeeseaaeeceaaaessaeceesanecesaececeseeceeeaeesesaaeceeeaeececeeaeaeseeeaeeseaeeees 274  Received fax has poor print quality sssi irrisoria ornari ararnar a ra da anai nnne ennt na re ass net nasse 275  SOlVINE option problems  suisse m 276  Option does not operate correctly or quits after it is installed                       sesseeeesee eren 276  PODER UAVS EE 276  EVE 4dc AE             E                                                    277  Pin i i ejeI Mi I io   PME OTT QT TEUER 277   eUiseitisoreiloni PEE 277  Flash memory Card RE ECHHEH                                                    278  Hard disk with adapters sei iere ceti ro a oca epe Qv ires aa ttr lian dba peste ri bbs nre tes ERR Eas 278  Internal Solutions o 1a MM 278  Memory Card m                                                             278    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 11    Solving Paper feed Problem Siisera ted einen ee
142. cks the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies  Notes       Off is the factory default setting  No pages will be collated     The On setting stacks the print job sequentially              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       218       Menu item Description  Sides  Duplex  Enables duplex printing  two sided printing   On  Off  Staple Enables stapling  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off       Duplex Binding    Defines the way duplexed pages are bound and how the printing on the back of the       Long Edge page is oriented in relation to the printing on the front of the page  Short Edge Notes     Long Edge is the factory default setting     Long Edge specifies that binding be placed on the left edge of portrait pages  and the top edge of landscape pages     Short Edge specifies that binding be placed on the top edge of portrait pages  and the left edge of landscape pages   Orientation Specifies the orientation of the print job  Auto Note  Auto is the factory default setting   Portrait  Landscape       N up  pages side     Specifies that multiple page images be printed on one side of a sheet of paper        Off This is also referred to as Paper Saver   2 Up Notes   3 Up  4 Up e Off is the factory default setting   6 Up   The number selected is the number of page images that will print per side   9 Up  12 Up  16 Up  N up Border Prints a border around each page image when using N up  None Note  Non
143. compatible output bin    x   247  59 Incompatible tray   x   247  61 Remove defective disk 247  62 Disk full 247  63 Unformatted disk 248  80 Routine maintenance  needed 248  841 846 Scanner Service  Error 249  88 Cartridge low 248  88 yy Cartridge nearly low 248    Index    88 yy Replace cartridge 248  900   999 Service   message   249  Answering 232  Busy 232  Call complete 232  Change   src   to   x   232  Check tray   x   connection 232  Close door or insert cartridge 233  Close finisher side door 233  Connect   x  bps 233  Dialing 233  Disk corrupted 233  Disk Full   Scan Job Canceled 233  Fax failed 233  Fax memory full 234  Fax partition inoperative  Contact  system administrator  234  Fax server  To Format  not set up   Contact system  administrator  234  Fax Station Name not set up 234  Fax Station Number not set  up 234  Flushing buffer 234  Insert staple cartridge 234  Insert Tray   x   235  Install bin   x   235  Install envelope feeder 235  Install tray   x   235  Invalid PIN 235  Job stored for delayed  transmission 236  Line busy 236  Load   src  with   x   236  Load manual feeder with   x   236  Load staples 236  Memory full  cannot print  faxes 236  Network 236  Network   x   236  No analog phone line connected  to modem  fax is disabled  237  No answer 237  No dial tone 237  Queued for sending 237  Ready 237  Reattach bin   x   237  Reattach bin   x         y   238  Reattach envelope feeder 238  Receive complete 238  Receiving page   n   239    Downloaded Fr
144. containing all the held jobs       Lock Device    This button appears on the screen when the printer is unlocked and  Device Lockout Personal Identification Number  PIN  has been set    Touching this button opens a PIN entry screen  Entering the correct  PIN locks the printer control panel  touch screen and hard buttons            Unlock Device    This button appears on the screen when the printer is locked  The  printer control panel buttons and shortcuts cannot be used while it  appears     Touching this button opens a PIN entry screen  Entering the correct  PIN unlocks the printer control panel  touch screen and hard buttons            J       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer 21    Display item Function    Cancel Jobs Opens the Cancel Jobs screen  The Cancel Jobs screen shows three  headings  Print  Fax  and Network     The following items are available under the Print  Fax  and Network  headings      Print job     Copy job     Fax profile   e FTP     E mail send    Each heading has a list of jobs shown in a column under it which can  show only three jobs per screen  Each job appears as a button which  you can touch to access information about the job  If more than three  jobs exist in a column  then an arrow appears enabling you to scroll  through the jobs              Using the touch screen buttons    Note  Depending on your options and administrative setup  your screens and buttons may vary from those shown     Sample touch scr
145. crease or decrease the brightness     Brightness settings can be adjusted from 20 100  100 is the factory default setting      N    Touch Submit     8 Touch   l        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Administrative support 262    Adjusting Power Saver    Available settings range from 1   240 minutes  The factory default is 30 minutes     To increase or decrease the number of minutes before the printer enters Power Saver mode  do one of the following     Using the Embedded Web Server  1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings  and then click General Settings   3 Click Timeouts     4 In the Power Saver box  increase or decrease the number of minutes you want the printer to wait before it enters  Power Saver mode     5 Click Submit     Using the printer control panel   Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   On the home screen  touch         Touch Settings    Touch General Settings    Touch the down arrow until Timeouts appears     Touch Timeouts     NO U B U M H    Touch the left or right arrow next to Power Saver Mode to decrease or increase the time the printer waits  before entering Power Saver mode     The settings available range from 1 240 minutes     8 Touch Submit        9 Touch   l     Restoring the factory default settings    If you wantto retain a list 
146. ct the communications port where you attached the serial cable to your computer  example  COM1      Click Properties     aoa c    On the Port Settings tab  set the serial parameters to the same serial parameters in the printer   Look for the printer settings under the serial heading on the Menu Settings page you printed earlier      h    Click OK  and then close all the windows     g Printa test page to verify printer installation  When a test page prints successfully  printer setup is complete     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 60    Setting up the printer to fax    Note  Fax capabilities may not be available on all printer models   The following connection methods may not be applicable in all countries or regions     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm  Do not set up this product or  make any electrical or cabling connections  such as the fax feature  power cord  or telephone  during a lightning  storm     Choosing a fax connection  You can connect the printer with equipment such as a telephone  an answering machine  or a computer modem     Note  The printer is an analog device that works best when directly connected to the wall jack  Other devices  such  as a telephone or answering machine  can be successfully attached to pass through the printer  as described in the  setup steps  If you want a digital connection such as ISDN  DSL  or ADSL  a third party device  such as a DSL filter  is  req
147. dard exit bin supports this size    This size setting formats the page for 216 x 356 mm  8 5 x 14 in   unless the size is specified by the software application       To support duplexing  the Universal width must be between 148 mm  5 8 in  and 216 mm  8 5 in   Universal length must  be between 182 mm  7 2 in  and 356 mm  14 in     lt           d       Note  An optional 250 sheet Universally Adjustable Tray is available for sizes smaller than A5  such as index cards   Paper types and weights supported by the printer    The printer engine supports 60 176 g m   16 47 Ib  paper weights  The duplex unit supports 63 170 g m   17   45 Ib   paper weights     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper and specialty media guidelines 91    Paper type 250  or 550 sheet Optional 2000 sheet   Multipurpose feeder   Duplex unit    trays  standard or tray  optional     Paper V V V V    Plain     Bond     Colored         Custom     Letterhead     Light     Heavy     Preprinted     Rough Cotton               Recycled  Card stock JV J J  Envelopes X X vV X  Labels   V V V V    Paper     Vinyl                   Transparencies V V V V    1 Printing labels requires a special label fuser cleaner which prevents duplexing  The label fuser cleaner is included with the  special cartridge required for label applications    lt              d       Paper types and weights supported by the finisher    Use this table to determine the possible output destinations of print jobs which use supported 
148. dassadec  censtadadedinesdasvieysbtvaasts 267  Large jobs do not collate          ss iek eaae tete e eios intei gae sd o dE Ta pa ed pa FLEX i od pce gud Ea eva ER aa Fal MEG ERA gaah 267  Unexpected page breaks occur    i edic rea Rs ERR UR EZ RENE DEAE AEN EXE ACRES 267  Solving copy problemis         e oett eee tue Fee UE Eae Re eee ea Fera ee ee Rene bee eue e De ee exe Peu ea Dee RRAEEEE 268  Copier does not respond i  ees edi tetti ir ed FE DERE XU RE oE aaa ERE EE YN AR v e FERRE EEEE EEE 268  Scanner unit does TOL close    ree a er Rem P riui E ERR YN Ne REEKCR ER pe iaaea RAEI XE Laan ia ORRERA ia 268  POOF COPY GWallity eI      0SS                     M 268  Partial doc  ment or photo copies    i enisi a rere Ed LR LXI ARR EUR Ee XE REED DA Re YR Ad CR nds 270  Solving scanner probleris       3 ient eret iet a E Ede e e eoe Pesce Xe RUE De Y Re devi SEES 270  Checking an unresponsive scanrier        eiii eei eret nne e Ee nacen eda RIO ei aiaia EEE aa aE EEE 270  Scam was not  successful    encre emit cceysieascvaedegesancedsaheavevtebav  ocesandelccavatvssvsecdaddegategveauendaibeeteetnasbes 270  Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer                 ssssssssssesseeeeeenee eene nnne enne nnnnn innen nnne nennen 271  Poor scanned image  q  ality           2  ii cet ria edere E LL bed ERE ce AER RR E CERRAR EUR AZ Ro bud atrae RIO ad RNAs 271  Partial document or photo SCANS         c csccceecsssccecesssseceeeesesssseeceesseseusecssesseeeecesssssseeceseessse
149. de l   quipement caus   par les orages et autres surtensions   lectriques     Cet   quipement utilise des prises de t  l  phone CA11A     Notice to users of the New Zealand telephone network    Thefollowing are special conditions for the Facsimile User Instructions  The grant of a telepermit for any item of terminal  equipment indicates only that Telecom has accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions for connection  toits network  It indicates no endorsement of the product by Telecom  nor does it provide any sort of warranty  Above  all  it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another item of telepermitted  equipment of a different make or model  nor does it imply that any product is compatible with all of Telecom s network  services     This equipment shall not be set up to make automatic calls to the Telecom s 111 Emergency Service   This equipment may not provide for the effective hand over of a call to another device connected to the same line     This equipment should not be used under any circumstances that may constitute a nuisance to other Telecom  customers     Some parameters required for compliance with Telecom s telepermit requirements are dependent on the equipment  associated with this device  The associated equipment shall be set to operate within the following limits for compliance  to Telecom s specifications        There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute period 
150. ded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 64    There is a plug installed in the EXT port  s  of the printer  This plug is necessary for the proper functioning of the printer        Note  Do not remove the plug  If you remove it  other telecommunications devices in your home  such as telephones  or answering machines  may not work     Connecting directly to a telephone wall jack in Germany  Connect the printer directly to a telephone wall jack to send and receive faxes without using a computer     Note  In Germany  and some other countries   the printer ships with a special RJ 11 plug in the EXT port  Do not  remove the RJ 11 plug  It is required for both the fax and telephone to work properly     1 Make sure you have a telephone cord  provided with the product  and a telephone wall jack     2 Connect one end of the telephone cord into the LINE port of the printer        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 65    4 If you would like to use the same line for both fax and telephone communication  connect a second telephone line   not provided  between the telephone and the F slot of an active telephone wall jack        5  f you would like to use the same line for recording messages on your answering machine  connect a second  telephone line  not provided  between the answering machine and the other N slot of the telephone wall jack        Connecting to a telephone    Connect a telephone to the printer to use the fax 
151. dential and other held  jobs   from Macintosh computer 135   from Windows 135    Q    Quality menu 223  Queued for sending 237    R    Ready 237  Reattach bin   x   237  Reattach bin   x         y   238  Reattach envelope feeder 238  Receive complete 238  Receiving page   n   239  recycled paper   using 88  recycling   Lexmark products 258   WEEE statement 297  reducing a copy 97  Remove packaging material  check    x   239  Remove paper from   linked bin set  name   239  Remove paper from all bins 239  Remove paper from bin   x   239  Remove paper from standard  output bin 239  Repeat print jobs 134   printing from Macintosh   computer 135   printing from Windows 135  Replace all originals if restarting  job  239  Replace wiper 240  reports   viewing 261  Reports menu 165  Reserve print jobs 134   printing from Macintosh   computer 135  printing from Windows 135    Index    resolution  fax  changing 116   Restore Held Jobs  240   RJ11 adapter  using 61    S    safety information 12  13  Scan Document Too Long 240  scan quality  improving 130  scan troubleshooting  cannot scan from a computer 272  partial document or photo  scans 271  scan was not successful 270  scanner unit does not close 268  scanning takes too long or freezes  the computer 271  scanner  Automatic Document Feeder   ADF  17  functions 16  registration 252  scanner glass 17  Scanner ADF Cover Open 240  Scanner Disabled 249  scanner glass  cleaning 251  scanner glass  flatbed   copying using 94  Scanner Jam A
152. ding printer menus 206    Menu item Description    Orientation Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  Portrait  Landscape       Original Size Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  Letter Note  Letter is the US factory default setting  A4 is the international factory default  Legal setting   Executive  Folio  Statement  Universal  4x 6in   3x5 in   Business Card  Custom Scan Size  lt x gt   A4  A5  Oficio  Mexico   A6  JIS B5  Book Original  Auto Size Sense  Mixed Letter Legal       Use Multi Page TIFF Provides a choice between single page TIFF files and multiple page TIFF files  For a  On multiple page scan to fax job  either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages   Off or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job    Notes       Onisthe factory default setting       This menu item applies to all scan functions                 Enable Analog Receive Enables analog fax receive  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  V P       E mail Settings menu    Description       E mail Server Setup Specifies e mail server information  Subject Note  The message box has a limitation of 512 characters   Message       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item    E mail Server Setup  Send me a copy  Never appears  On by default  Off by default  Always On       207    Description    Sends a copy of the e mail back to the creator of the e mail       E mail Server S
153. disk must be  installed in the printer and operating properly for this menu item to be  available      The flash memory option or printer hard disk cannot be Read Write   Write  or password protected       Job Buffer Size must not be set to 10096           PCL Emul menu       Xx          r    Menu item Description  Font Source Specifies the set of fonts used by the Font Name menu item  Resident Notes   Disk  Download   Resident is the factory default setting  It shows the factory default set of  Flash fonts downloaded into printer RAM   All   Flash and Disk settings appear only if applicable and show all fonts  resident in that option     Flash and Disk options must be properly formatted and cannot be  Read Write  Write  or password protected     Download appears only if applicable and shows all the fonts downloaded  into printer RAM     All shows all fonts available to any option   Font Name Identifies a specific font and the option where it is stored    list of available fonts   Notes     Courier 10 is the factory default setting     The font source abbreviation is R for Resident  F for Flash  K for Disk  and  D for download           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          s    Understanding printer menus 227       Menu item Description    Symbol Set Specifies the symbol set for each font name  10U PC 8 Notes   12U PC 850      10U PC 8 is the US factory default setting     12U PC 850 is the international factory default setting       Asymbol set is a set of alp
154. document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Fax    Use the keypad to enter the fax number    Touch Options     From the Darkness area  touch the arrows to adjust the darkness of the fax     Nn ono uw A VV N    Touch Fax It     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 117    Sending a fax at a scheduled time  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Fax    Enter the fax number using the numbers on the touch screen or keypad   Touch Options     Touch Advanced Options     Nn Oo Uu A WVU N    Touch Delayed Send     Note  If Fax Mode is set to Fax Server  the Delayed Send button will not appear  Faxes waiting for transmission  are listed in the Fax Queue     8 Touch the arrows to adjust the time the fax will be transmitted     The time is increased or decreased in increments of 30 minutes  If the current time is sh
155. door and remove the paper from there   7 Align and reinstall the print cartridge   8 Close the front cover   9 Close the multipurpose feeder door     10 Touch Continue     202 paper jam    Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam  If the paper is exiting the printer  then pull the paper out   and then touch Continue     If the paper is not exiting the printer     1 Pull down the top rear door                    2 Remove the jammed paper   3 Close the top rear door     4 Touch Continue     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 144    230 239 paper jams  1 Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam   2 Pull the standard tray out     3 Pull down the bottom rear door           4 Push the tab down           5 Remove the jammed paper   6 Close the bottom rear door   7 Insert the standard tray     8 Touch Continue     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 145    240 249 paper jams  1 Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam     2 Pull the standard tray out           3 Remove any jammed paper  and then close the tray    4 Touch Continue    5  f the jam message persists  then pull out any optional trays   6 Remove the jammed paper  and then insert the trays     7 Touch Continue     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 146    250 paper jam  1 Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam     2 Remove the paper from the multipurpose feeder             
156. dpi  1200 Image Q  1200 dpi  or 2400 Image Q       Enable Enhance Fine Lines in the Quality menu     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 281    MAKE SURE DOWNLOADED FONTS ARE SUPPORTED    If you are using downloaded fonts  then verify that the fonts are supported by the printer  the host computer  and  the software program     Clipped images    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE GUIDES    Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded     CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING  Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct size setting     For Windows users  specify the size from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the size from the Page Setup dialog     Ghost images       CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting    Gray background       CHECK THE TONER DARKNESS SETTING    Select a 
157. dware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     Warning   Potential Damage  System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity  Touch  something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors     An optional memory card can be purchased separately and attached to the system board  To install the memory card     1 Access the system board           2 Unpack the memory card   Note  Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card     3 Open the memory card connector latches                 Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 29    4 Align the notches on the memory card with the ridges on the connector        1   Notches  2   Ridges    5 Push the memory card straight into the connector until it snaps into place           6 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door                       Installing a flash memory or firmware card    Note  This task requires a flathead screwdriver     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 30    The system board has two connections for an optional flash memory or firmware card  Only one of each may be installed   but the connectors are i
158. e  End of Life  Type of Message to Display  Default  Alternate  Default Message   lt text entry gt   Alternate Message   lt text entry gt     Specifies what is displayed on the upper left and right corners of  the home screen    For the Left side and Right side options  choose from the following  options   None  IP Address  Hostname  Contact Name  Location  Date Time  mDNS DDNS Service Name  Zero Configuration Name  Cartridge Level  Custom Text  lt x gt     Notes       IP Address is the factory default setting for Left side     Date Time is the factory default setting for Right side     e Off is the factory default setting for Display When Supply  Registers       Default is the factory default setting for Type of Message to  Display        Displayed Information  continued   Paper Jam  Load Paper  Service Errors    The displayed information for Paper Jam  Load Paper  and Service  Errors can be customized with the following options     Activate  Yes  No  Type of Message to Display  Default  Alternate  Default Message    text entry    Alternate Message    text entry      Notes       Noisthe factory default setting for Activate       Default is the factory default setting for Type of Message to  Display              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item   Home screen customization  Change Language  Copy  Copy Shortcuts  Fax  Fax Shortcuts  E mail  E mail Shortcuts  FTP  FTP Shortcuts  Search Held Jobs  Held Jobs  USB Drive  Prof
159. e  Tray  lt x gt   Multi Purpose Feeder  Envelope Feeder    Specifies the paper source for separator sheets  Notes       Tray 1  standard tray  is the factory default setting       From the Paper menu  Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order for  Multi Purpose Feeder to appear as a menu setting        N up  pages side    Off   2 Up   3 Up   4 Up   6 Up   9 Up   12 Up   16 Up    Specifies that multiple page images be printed on one side of a sheet of paper    Notes       Offis the factory default setting       The number selected is the number of page images that will print per side        N up Ordering  Horizontal  Reverse Horizontal  Reverse Vertical    Specifies the positioning of multiple page images when using N up  pages sides   Notes       Horizontal is the factory default setting              Vertical   Positioning depends on the number of images and whether the images are in  portrait or landscape orientation   Orientation Specifies the orientation of a multiple page sheet  Auto Note  Auto is the factory default setting  The printer chooses between portrait and  Landscape landscape   Portrait          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 223    a    Menu item Description       N up Border Prints a border around each page image when using N up  pages sides   None Note  None is the factory default setting   Solid  Staple Job Specifies whether print jobs are stapled  Off Notes   On      This menu item is available only when t
160. e Corporation   ITC Zapf Chancery International Typeface Corporation  Joanna The Monotype Corporation plc  Marigold Arthur Baker   Monaco Apple Computer  Inc    New York Apple Computer  Inc    Oxford Arthur Baker   Palatino Linotype Hell AG and or its subsidiaries  Stempel Garamond Linotype Hell AG and or its subsidiaries  Taffy Agfa Corporation   Times New Roman The Monotype Corporation plc    Univers Linotype Hell AG and or its subsidiaries J       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 293    All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners        AirPrint    AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple  Inc     Federal Communications Commission  FCC  compliance information statement    This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device  pursuant to Part 15 of the  FCC Rules  Operation is subject to the following two conditions   1  this device may not cause harmful interference   and  2  this device must accept any interference received  including interference that may cause undesired operation     The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  is operated in a commercial environment  This equipment generates  uses  and can radiate radio frequency energy  and  if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual  may cause harmful interference to radio  communications  Operation of this equipment in a 
161. e E Eee ERR YER ERE WEE FER EXE a X FH REP DENS Fe REUS 114   CREGLINE SMOFECUES E E I                                   e 114  Creating a fax destination shortcut using the Embedded Web Server            ccccccsssesssceecessseseeeesesesseeeseessnenees 114  Creating a fax destination shortcut using the touch screen           ccceessecceeeesesseecceesesenseessssuseeecesessaeeeesssesnenaaes 115   Using shortcuts and the address book                    eerte reet eesn erae eee ha erae nere ta nene ia ae bo ean a EG 115  Using TAX SMOMECUTS RETI DL ML 115  Using the address book    eem ee e E e URS E URL EU vies HE SRN RENS NE ERE SERIEN NS EE M RER URS NASA RE a 115   Customizing TAX Settllngs   eio eerte n rene e ie etie Ente e sve ate eeua eeu vA esee to uua ia E Eee 116  Changing the fax resolution    ci eterne kac ree E eR AE EAE A READ CERRAR V S e o Rueda PER QE eR Ene 116  Making a fax lighter or darker           cccccccccsssssscceescssssececeessesssececcsssssuseeecesesseecssssasseeesceseaseseeesesecesusaeeceseaaeeesens 116  Sending a fax at a sched  led time                   cedes a e E sa er a eR Elo pede sad De sabactedeadevedaadas 117  WIC WING a tax ADMI                                        O                   117  Blocking JUNK TAXES  de iste este fe auda to ste save totu ci Cea pe tede dera aea a eaaa aaa i i cai Qe ca SIR E ETERNA 117   Canceling an outgoing  aX       0  cerita aver erneuern an eaaa aiea Eee eE a aai 118  Canceling a fax while the original docu
162. e SCrEON          ccccsccccccesssssssnsneeceeceeseesnsaeeeseecesesesesnssueseeeeeeeescssssusesseseeeeesesesseees 19  Using the touch screen DUttOns      1 s i irren rire anrea eoe teens a paene Foo sea g Ee Ye pee ses s es cheeeesesasavencneyedbesdess 21    Additional printer setUp           ssessessosessecssssecsssssecssosssosseseosessecossoesessosesseese 2D    Installing  internal OptlOns       ecre ono tret orae evene oy ere e eee key RE Ven dee eese EEE AEE EE Ta 25  Available internal Options              ccccsccccsssssseececessnssececesesseseecessessseecesaseseceseseaseeesessessaeeeceseseueaaaseesseceaeeeeeeeseenaes 25  Accessing the system board to install internal options              cccssccessssseceecssseceecessesseeecessseeseeseseseeeeeseessenees 26  stalling a memory Card dia Gi ies teet eee tecti dest hor iere Eee te i iai vi vu e ori aE EE sa deucdiecsdessansesieanstnas 28  Installing a flash memory or firmware card                   sess eee nnne nnns nne annees nenne 29  Installing an Internal Solutions Port                     sees eene nnne enne enhn nennen nain ener sensns seni rinse nn 32  Installing a  printer  Nard disk  sssrin iainta eaea aaaea o aaia dedeasl a E EEEE EAEE aa E EEEa ia 38  stalling a fax CONG iscseesctcacesegetartenaesdgeneeacerdegeosatavisgeraalbasgerlacasvcgansseadesensataeadgeedsieiscacoasedgacedseabavanetedvacdesedeenetadeurss 42   Attaching cable S na E HEU AR EROR E E R E nen  44   Verifying printer SetU Pionieer aa eda a aa aeaae
163. e a Qna fa cud ade grata a dope od red E E AE dace E AEREE 183  Set Date e Menu a a a a aa N aa TE 184  edu 185  General Settings MeNU ascese e                                                                                           185  Copy Setting AD PRETI LIT ID TIL 192  Fax Settings menu  iiec cepe tite tb cu rna o ada td saa qa pe ae E TR Ra ka p aba a Fk Ta   s Ra pasan faa Ra CEP CARN A PES DE adag cra RM asa Yao Nena QDCE DERE 197  E mail Settings MEN   ERROR OTT MR                   206  FTP Settings WMO NIU EUES TESTE 211  Flash Drive  men zi ceste irte tertiae e a etd de sap asia po aa EREKE E RE E Aaa Eria 214  elsuisidui nhe I                                                                  S 219  Help MENU CTEOENOU IL                                     231    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 9    Understanding printer messages                           e ecce eee ee eene eene eene eee eese 2 32     List of status and   rror miessages       eere reinen epe arnei IUe v E RyS ERE EE EA ERE E EE e 232    Maintaining the DrIDnter   ceo sunsuke eser nU EX DE pE PEN MER PEESRPLN FERE PERE QN OI EUR erp R DEM Ou    Cleaning the exterior of the printer              siiis eene nennen nnne nennen nennen iaaa sa nasa sanis 251  Cleaning the scanner glass    eec a center ERE Rue veu tesa n dex mua que uaa ER  lt aedtaceagetanaatinwsgiurdldcedaddananoneaenecs 251  Adjusting scanner registratiOn             ssesseessese eese enne nennt ue SE aan ren
164. e and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings   3 Under Other Settings  click Manage Shortcuts     Note  A password may be required  If you do not have an ID and password  get one from your system support  person     4 Click FTP Shortcut Setup     5 Enter the appropriate information into the boxes     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to an FTP address 124    6 Enter a shortcut number     If you enter a number that is already in use  then you are prompted to select another number     7 Click Add     Creating an FTP shortcut using the touch screen  1 On the home screen  touch FTP    2 Type the address of the FTP site    3 Touch Save as Shortcut    4 Enter a name for the shortcut    5    Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct  and then touch OK  If the name or number is incorrect  then  touch Cancel  and then reenter the information     If you enter a number that is already in use  then you are prompted to select another number        6 Touch Send It to start the scan  or touch      to return to the home screen     Understanding FTP options    Original Size    This option opens a screen where you can choose the size of the documents you are going to copy       Touch a paper size button to select that size as the Original Size setting  The FTP screen appears with your new  setting displayed       When  Original Size  is set to Mixed Letter Legal  you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper  sizes    
165. e as  possible        Run Initial setup    Instructs the printer to run the setup wizard       Francais Canadien  Deutsch  Italiano  Espanol  Dansk  Norsk  Nederlands  Svenska  Suomi  Portuguese  Russian  Polski  Swiss German  Swiss French  Turkce  Korean  Custom Key   x    Accents Symbols Tab  On  Off  Russian Polish Tab  On  Off  Korean Tab  On  Off    Yes Notes   No    Yes is the factory default setting     After completing the setup wizard by selecting Done at the  Country select screen  the default becomes No   Keyboard Specifies a language and custom key information for the printer  Keyboard Type control panel keyboard  The additional tabs enable access to accent  English marks and symbols from the printer control panel keyboard   Francais       Paper Sizes  U S   Metric       Specifies the printer factory default measurements  The default is  determined by the country region selection in the initial setup  wizard              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       Menu item    Scan to PC Port Range   lt port range gt     187    Description    Specifies a valid port range for printers behind a port blocking  firewall  The valid ports are specified by two sets of numbers  separated by a semicolon     Note  9751 12000 is the factory default setting           Displayed Information  Left side  Right side  Custom Text  lt x gt    lt text entry gt   Black Toner  Display When Supply Registers  Off  Early Warning  Low  Near End of Lif
166. e ba pd ea RT HORT REN R uS d Ru ERA Ran Ro Sada 284  Solid black or white streaks  0       cceceeceeeeseeenseeeeseaeeeeseeeeeeaaeeceaeecssaeceseanecesaececsaeeceseaeesenaaecesaee reset nenne enne nne aiei 285  Print cS reroMil i ETT T                                                             285  aleman rique 286  Solid COO PARES EET TEE DL DD LLL LOL 287  Streaked vertical lines  us ertet ree SEE URS RARE RENE RECEN E FEX AE iaa E Eaa BER Pe NUTS XURERE EY RUE NYSE Pon 288  Toner fog or background shading appears on the page                   esssssseeeseeee eene emen enne nnne nne 288  Tonerrubs OFF me                                                        v                 289  Mure                                                     289  Transparency print quality is POOP            cccccesscceccsssseseecessessseeceesscssusecescessseasesesssseecescsesseseseseseaseaaeseessseesesesens 290   Embedded Web Server does not open                 sssssssssssssssssesesese seen nnne enne nne nennen taesten nn 290  Check the network connections                   ssesssessesessssseeesee seinen eee enhn senti sen thnistirns ret tne sitne sets ee ness ennnn nsn 290  Check the network settings crcire neonan e aaia Ea aE EEE Ea AA EEA TEREA PAEA EGE OEE a AAEE Eaei 290   Contacting Customer SUuppoOLL      tee ote rere Pec tain leis EASE ANE ERRA EERE ENERE 290    NOt  ICeS         sseesssseessscssssoessoesscccessccsssscoessososssccosssssesssosessscessssesssosessssessssessse ZOL    sisi
167. e factory default setting        Custom Job scanning  On  Off    Lets you copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single job       Scan Preview  On  Off       Specifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  Note  Off is the factory default setting              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 210       Menu item Description    Allow Save as Shortcut Lets you save e mail addresses as shortcuts  On Notes   Off    e Off is the factory default setting       When set to Off  the Save as Shortcut button does not appear on the E mail  Destination screen                                            Background Removal Adjusts the amount of background visible on a scanned image   4 to  4 Note  0 is the factory default setting   Auto Center Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Color Dropout Specifies which color to drop during scanning  and how much to increase or decrease  Color Dropout the dropout  None Notes   Red  TRES   Noneis the factory default setting for Color Dropout   Blue   128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold   Default Red Threshold  0 255  Default Green Threshold  0 255  Default Blue Threshold  0 255  Contrast Specifies the contrast of the output  0 5 Note   Best for content  is the factory default setting   Best for content  Mirror Image Creates a mirror image of the original document  On Note  Off is the f
168. e file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG   JPEG   Creates and attaches a separate file for each page of your original document  viewable by most Web browsers  and graphics programs    XPS   Creates a single XPS file with multiple pages  viewable using an Internet Explorer hosted viewer and the  NET  Framework  or by downloading a third party standalone viewer    Content    This option tells the printer the original document type  Choose from Text  Text Photo  or Photo  Color can be turned  on or off with any of the Content choices  Content affects the quality and size of your FTP file     Text   Emphasize sharp  black  high resolution text against a clean  white background  Text Photo   Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures    Photograph   Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures  This setting increases the time it  takes to scan  but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document  This  increases the amount of information saved     Color   Sets the scan type and output for the FTP file  Color documents can be scanned and sent to an FTP site   computer  e mail address  or the printer     Advanced Options    Touching this button opens a screen where you can change Advanced Imaging  Custom Job  Transmission Log  Scan  Preview  Edge Erase  and Darkness settings     Advanced Imaging   Adjusts image output settings before you scan the document        Background Re
169. e hee Yo Hue SRR DR Ec PAR ERRARE E EAR faasd sage ciad ease s a E aE ER Re EEE EEA KEE a 167  Standard Network or Network   x   MENUS                 cesses eene nennen nnne nnns nenne rins isse nein sneren see nnns nnns 167  UR ANTE                                                        169  Network Reports meri    etii red er A EO CE ad ae ds E CER AE E RN Feud cede TO Vea a NE d eR een 170  Network Card menu  deret peeicer ber agria rid Deae qua dat eO depu pas espe aa iade es aa Pu ea RENE La EAR Ioa Pa a dao 170  MESI IUE 171  IPV lee ETE 172  Wireless meriti nie eene esed seta cra s doce da aene e ra pr pa sad nO pea Dada POE Ee ee ha the Eae pega Ta ga E S2 hated ndo dU QUERER 172  AppleTalk MOM bte    R             173  NetWare  mer t rese save e tete en Ens UE eee ee uei eR coup ede aeos Urss det weed satan 0k deg sate Ee A Eye NUR S M e cas cee Ae ate ER EX Qu UNE ease 173  PEORES II ILLIUS 174  Standard imu                                                         H    175  Parallel   x   men    et te ei dre AERE MEHR RE ERR LEE EXE RA FE RDAE ERR VR MERE a E ae a RERO RU UR E ca Eee dn 176  SOrial ex gt  MENU EHE SEE 178  Ife yid MENU  ee ea a ga e E IT                      m 181  Miscellaneous MENU siesena aae aa a ofa a depu pase cgo Cine e es org epa eaa A aaka aa hiaai EE ai 181  Confidential Print Men   sasini a A EER EA EE EA EE E Tons EE NGENE A EAE Eaa 181  Disk  W ipl MEMU MERE TEE Ra E OEE EEE E A A E EOE Eo EERE RENARE 182  Security A  dit Log MENU seiat
170. e is the factory default setting   Solid       N up Ordering  Horizontal  Reverse Horizontal  Reverse Vertical  Vertical    Specifies the positioning of multiple page images when using N up  Notes       Horizontal is the factory default setting       Positioning depends on the number of images and whether the images are in  portrait or landscape orientation        Separator Sheets  None  Between Copies  Between Jobs       Between Pages    Places a sheet of paper between pages  copies  or jobs based on the value selected    Note  None is the factory default setting              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    a    Separator Source  Tray  lt x gt   Manual Feeder  Envelope Feeder    Menu item    21    9    Description    Specifies a paper source                M       Blank Pages Specifies whether blank pages are inserted in a print job  Do Not Print Note  Do Not Print is the factory default setting   Print  XX  Print Settings  Setup menu    Menu item Description    Printer Language  PCL Emulation  PS Emulation    Sets the default printer language    Notes     e PCL emulation uses a PCL interpreter for processing print  jobs  PostScript emulation uses a PS interpreter for  processing print jobs       PCLis the factory default printer language       Setting a printer language as the default does not prevent a  software program from sending print jobs that use another  printer language        Job Waiting  On  Off       r       Specif
171. e maximum  the printer uses the maximum  width allowed       8 5 inches is the US factory default setting  Inches can be increased  in 0 01 inch increments     e 216mm is the international factory default setting  Millimeters can  be increased in 1 mm increments        Portrait Height Sets the portrait height  3 14 inches Notes   76 360 mm      Ifthe height exceeds the maximum  the printer uses the maximum  height allowed       14 inches is the US factory default setting  Inches can be increased in  0 01 inch increments       356 mm is the international factory default setting  Millimeters can  be increased in 1 mm increments        Feed Direction Specifies the feed direction if the paper can be loaded in either direction  Short Edge Notes   Long Edge      Short Edge is the factory default setting       Long Edge appears only if the longest edge is shorter than the  maximum width supported in the tray                 Bin Setup menu       Description    Output Bin Identifies installed output bins  Standard Bin Note  Standard Bin is the factory default setting   Bin  lt x gt        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 165    Menu Item Description    Configure Bins Specifies configuration options for output bins  Mailbox Notes   Link  Mail Overflow   Mailbox is the factory default setting   Link Optional   The Mailbox setting treats each bin as a separate  Type Assignment mailbox       The Link setting links together all available output  
172. e message on the display  and the  troubleshooting steps you have already taken to find a solution     You need to know your printer model type and serial number  For more information  see the label on the inside top  front cover of the printer  The serial number is also listed on the menu settings page     In the U S  or Canada  call  1 800 539 6275   For other countries regions  visit the Lexmark Web site at  www lexmark com     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 291    Notices    Product name     Lexmark X651de  Lexmark X652de  Lexmark X654de  Lexmark X656de  Lexmark X656dte  Lexmark X658d  Lexmark  X658de  Lexmark X658dme  Lexmark X658dfe  Lexmark X658dte  Lexmark X658dtme  Lexmark X658dtfe    Machine type    7462   Model s     OA1  0A5  2A1  2A2  2A5  2A6  4A2  4A6  031  035  231  232  235  236  432  436    Edition notice    March 2012    The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law   LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL  INC   PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION    AS IS    WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EITHER  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS  FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  Some states do not allow disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain  transactions  therefore  this statement may not apply to you     This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors  Changes are periodically made to the  information h
173. e of the following     Load the specified paper in the tray     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing     If the printer finds a tray that has the correct paper type and size  it feeds from that tray  If the printer cannot find  atray with the correct paper type and size  it prints from the default source       Cancel the current job     Load manual feeder with   x      x   is a paper type or size   Try one or more of the following     Load the specified paper in the multipurpose feeder     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing     If the printer finds a tray that has the correct paper type and size  then it feeds from that tray  If the printer cannot  find a tray with the correct paper type and size  then it prints from the default source     Cancel the current job     Load staples    Try one or more of the following     Replace the specified staple cartridge in the finisher     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing       Touch Cancel job to cancel the print job     Memory full  cannot print faxes  There is not enough memory to print the fax job     Touch Continue to clear the message without printing  Held faxes will attempt to print after the printer has been  restarted     Network Network   x      The printer is connected to the network     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 237    Network indicates that the printer is using the standard network port built into the pri
174. e of the network input buffer  Auto    3K to   maximum size allowed      Notes       Auto is the factory default setting     The value can be changed in 1 K increments       The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer   the size of the other link buffers  and whether Resource Save is set to On or  Off       To increase the maximum size range for the Network Buffer  disable or  reduce the size of the parallel  serial  and USB buffers       Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Job Buffering  Off  On  Auto    Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing  This menu only  appears if a formatted disk is installed     Notes       Offis the factory default setting       The On value buffers jobs on the printer hard disk  This menu selection  appears only when a formatted disk is installed and is not defective      The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  from another input port       Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Mac Binary PS  On  Off  Auto       Sets the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs    Notes       Auto is the factory default setting     The Off setting filters print jobs using the standard protocol          The On setting processes raw bina
175. e possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE PAPER    Use recommended paper and specialty media  For more information  see the chapter about paper and specialty  media guidelines     IVIAKE SURE THERE IS NOT TOO MUCH PAPER IN THE PAPER TRAY    Make sure the stack of paper you load does not exceed the maximum stack height indicated in the tray or on the  multipurpose feeder     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 279    CHECK THE PAPER GUIDES    Move the guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded     THE PAPER MAY HAVE ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY      Load paper from a fresh package       Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it     Paper jam message remains after jam is cleared    CHECK THE PAPER PATH    The paper path is not clear  Clear jammed paper from the entire paper path  and then touch Continue     Page that jammed does not reprint after you clear the jam    Turn ON Jam RECOVERY  In the Setup menu  Jam Recovery is set to Off  Set Jam Recovery to Auto or On   1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears    On the home screen  touch         Touch Settings    Touch General Settings    Touch the down arrow until Print Recovery appears    Touch Print Recovery    Touch the right arrow next to Jam Recovery until On or Auto appears     Touch Submit     O aon oOo Ui A UU NM       Touch   l     Solving print quality problems    The information in the following topics may he
176. e quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  image    Notes        Best for content    is the factory default setting     5 reduces the file size  but the quality of the image is lessened     90 provides the best image quality  but the file size is very large       This menu item applies to all scan functions        E mail images sent as  Attachment  Web Link    Specifies how the images will be sent    Note  Attachment is the factory default setting        Use Multi Page TIFF  On  Off    Provides a choice between single page TIFF files and multiple page TIFF files  For a  multiple page scan to e mail job  either one TIFF file is created containing all the  pages  or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job     Notes       Onisthe factory default setting       This menu item applies to all scan functions        Transmission Log  Print log  Do not print log  Print only for error    Specifies whether the transmission log prints    Note   Print log  is the factory default setting        Log Paper Source  Tray  lt x gt   Manual Feeder  Manual Env  MP Feeder    Specifies a paper source for printing e mail logs    Note  Tray 1 is the factory default setting        Log Output Bin  Standard Bin  Bin   x      Specifies an output bin for the printed e mail log       E mail Bit Depth  8 bit  1 bit    Enables the Text Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1 bit images when  Color is set to Off     Note  8 bit is th
177. e sure the Paper Texture setting matches the paper loaded in the  tray     Toner specks       These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE    Replace the print cartridge     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 290    THERE IS TONER IN THE PAPER PATH    Contact Customer Support     Transparency print quality is poor    Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE TRANSPARENCIES    Use only transparencies recommended by the printer manufacturer     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     Embedded Web Server does not open    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE NETWORK CONNECTIONS    Make sure the printer and computer are turned on and connected to the same network     CHECK THE NETWORK SETTINGS    Depending on the network settings  you may need to type https     instead of http     before the printer IP  address to access the Embedded Web Server  For more information  see your system administrator     Contacting Customer Support    When you call Customer Support  describe the problem you are experiencing  th
178. e using an Internet Explorer hosted viewer and the  NET  Framework  or by downloading a third party standalone viewer    Content  This option tells the printer the original document type  Choose from Text  Text Photo  or Photo  Color can be turned  on or off with any of the Content choices  Content affects the quality and size of your e mail      Text   Emphasizes sharp  black  high resolution text against a clean  white background     Text Photo   Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures      Photograph   Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures  This setting increases the time it  takes to scan  but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document  This  increases the amount of information saved       Color   Sets the scan type and output for the e mail  Color documents can be scanned and sent to an e mail address     Advanced Options  Touching this button opens a screen where you change Advanced Imaging  Custom Job  Transmission Log  Scan Preview   Edge Erase  and Darkness settings       Advanced Imaging   Adjusts Background Removal  Contrast  Scan Edge to Edge  Shadow Detail  and Mirror Image  before you copy the document      Custom Job  Job Build    Combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job      Transmission Log    Prints the transmission log or transmission error log    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing 112      Scan Preview   Displays t
179. e whatever is within the  area selected  leaving nothing on that portion of the scan       Darkness   Adjusts how light or dark your scanned documents will turn out    Improving FTP quality       Question Tip  When should I use Text   Use Text mode when text preservation is the main goal of sending a document to an FTP site   mode  and preserving images copied from the original document is not a concern       Text mode is recommended for receipts  carbon copy forms  and documents that only contain  text or fine line art        When should I use   Use Text Photo mode when sending a document to an FTP site that contains a mixture of  Text Photo mode  text and graphics     Text Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles  business graphics  and brochures        When should I use Photo   Use Photo mode when the original document is composed mostly of photos printed on a laser  mode  printer or taken from a magazine or newspaper                 Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Scanning to a computer or flash drive 127    Scanning to a computer or flash drive       ADF Scanner glass             Use the ADF for multiple page documents    Use the scanner glass for single pages  small items  such as postcards or  photos   transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings      LS P                The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a computer or a flash drive  The computer does not have to be directly  connected to the printer fo
180. eader footer information for the bottom left of the page  Bottom left Notes   Bottom left  Off   Offis the factory default setting for Bottom left   Date Time    All pages  is the factory default setting for Print on     Page number   Bates number   Custom text  Print on   All pages   First page only   All but first page  Enter custom text       Header Footer Specifies header footer information for the bottom middle of the page  Bottom middle Notes   Bottom middle  Off   Offis the factory default setting for Bottom middle   Date Time      All pages  is the factory default setting for Print on     Page number   Bates number   Custom text  Print on   All pages   First page only   All but first page             Enter custom text       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item    Header Footer  Bottom right   Bottom right  Off  Date Time  Page number  Bates number  Custom text   Print on  All pages  First page only  All but first page   Enter custom text       196    Description    Specifies header footer information for the bottom right of the page    Notes       Offis the factory default setting for Bottom right          All pages  is the factory default setting for Print on        Overlay  Off  Confidential  Copy  Draft  Urgent  Custom    Specifies overlay text that is printed on each page of the copy job  Note  Off is the factory default setting        Custom Overlay    Specifies custom overlay text       Allow priority copies  
181. ecifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Allow Save as Shortcut Enables shortcut creation for FTP addresses  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off  Background Removal Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy   4 to  4 Note  0 is the factory default setting   Auto Center Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Color Dropout Specifies which color to drop during scanning  and how much to increase or decrease  Color Dropout the dropout  None Notes   Red  Green   None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout   Blue   128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold   Default Red Threshold  0 255  Default Green Threshold  0 255  Default Blue Threshold  0 255                Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 214                         Menu item Description  Contrast Specifies the contrast of the output  0 5 Note     Best for content    is the factory default setting   Best for content  Mirror Image Creates a mirror image of the original document  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Negative Image Creates a negative image of the original document  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Shadow Detail Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image  0 4 Note  0 is the factory default setting   Scan edge to edge Specifies whe
182. ed after this product is not used for a specified period of time   called the Power Saver Timeout            Factory default Power Saver Timeout for this product  in minutes   110V   45 minutes  220V   60 minutes         By using the configuration menus  the Power Saver Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 240 minutes   Setting the Power Saver Timeout to a low value reduces energy consumption  but may increase the response time of  the product  Setting the Power Saver Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response  but uses more energy     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 302    Off mode    If this product has an off mode which still consumes a small amount of power  then to completely stop product power  consumption  disconnect the power supply cord from the wall outlet     Total energy usage    It is sometimes helpful to calculate the total product energy usage  Since power consumption claims are provided in  power units of Watts  the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends in each mode in  order to calculate energy usage  The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode s energy usage     Statement of Limited Warranty    Lexmark X651de  Lexmark X652de  Lexmark X654de  Lexmark X656de  Lexmark X656dte  Lexmark X658d  Lexmark  X658de  Lexmark X658dme  Lexmark X658dfe  Lexmark X658dte  Lexmark X658dtme  Lexmark X658dtfe    Lexmark International  Inc   Lexington  KY    This limited warranty applies to the Un
183. eeder       550 sheet tray  Tray 1        550 sheet tray  Tray 2        NJlolulalwlnie    Optional output bin                Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer 16    Selecting a location for the printer    When selecting a location for the printer  leave enough room to open trays  covers  and doors  If you plan to install any  options  leave enough room for them also  It is important to       Make sure airflow in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard     Provide a flat  sturdy  and stable surface     Keep the printer        Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners  heaters  or ventilators       Free from direct sunlight  humidity extremes  or temperature fluctuations       Clean  dry  and free of dust      Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer for proper ventilation                                  1 Right Side   20 cm  8 in      2 Left Side  31cm  12 in    3 Front 51 cm  20 in    4 Rear 20 cm  8 in     i 5  Top 31cm  12 in              Basic functions of the scanner    The scanner provides copy  fax  and scan to network capability for large workgroups  You can     Make quick copies  or change the settings on the printer control panel to perform specific copy jobs     Send a fax using the printer control panel     Send a fax to multiple fax destinations at the same time     Scan documents and send them to your computer  an e mail address  a flash drive  or an FTP destination  
184. een       Copy from  Letter  8 5x11 in     Sides  Duplex    1             Copy to  Letter  B 5x1 1 in   Plain Paper             EE          Scale  P  Auto  I   a  ccs  al El    Darkness    a m9   2 jenny  ee                                        Button Function   Home Returns to the home screen   Scroll down Opens a drop down list  V A          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Learning about the printer    Button    Left scroll decrease    E    22    Function    Scrolls to another value in decreasing order       Right scroll increase    2       Scrolls to another value in increasing order          Left arrow Scrolls left  mm  Right arrow Scrolls right    V          Submit       Saves a value as the new user default setting       Back             Navigates back to the previous screen          Other touch screen buttons    Button       Function  Down arrow Moves down to the next screen  Up arrow Moves up to the next screen          Unselected radio button       This is an unselected radio button  The radio button is gray to show it is unselected           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Learning about the printer    Button    Selected radio button          23    Function    This is a selected radio button  The radio button is blue to show it is selected        Cancel Jobs       Opens the Cancel Jobs screen  The Cancel Jobs screen shows three headings  Print   Fax  and Network     The following items are available under the Print  Fax  and
185. ement parts if you experience problems with paper double feeding or failing to feed through the  automatic document feeder     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 258      Part number    ADF pick assembly 3017345              ADF separator roll 3017348         Ordering staple cartridges    When Staples Lowor Staples Empty appears  order the specified staple cartridge     For more information  see the illustrations inside the stapler door        Part number    Staple Cartridges   3 pack 25A0013       Recycling Lexmark products    To return Lexmark products to Lexmark for recycling   1 Visit our Web site at www lexmark com recycle   2 Find the product type you want to recycle  and then select your country from the list     3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen     Moving the printer    Before moving the printer    A CAUTION   POTENTIAL INJURY  The printer weight is greater than 18 kg  40 Ib  and requires two or more  trained personnel to move it safely        CAUTION    POTENTIAL INJURY  Before moving the printer  follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  printer damage     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 259      Turn the printer off using the power switch  and then unplug the power cord from the wall outlet     Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it       Lift the printer off of the optional drawer and set it aside instead of trying to lift the drawer
186. emory or on a printer hard disk  places them in permanent storage  Downloads remain in  flash memory or on the printer hard disk even when the  printer is turned off       Storing downloads in RAM is temporary       This menu appears only if a flash and or disk option is  installed        Job Accounting  On  Off          Specifies whether the printer stores statistical information about  the most recent print jobs on the hard disk    Notes       Offisthe factory default setting  Off means the printer does  not store job statistics       The statistics include a record of print errors  the print time   the job size in bytes  the requested paper size and type  the  total number of printed pages  and the total number of  copies requested       Job Accounting is available only when a printer hard disk is  installed and working properly  It should not be Read Write  or Write protected  Job Buffer Size should not be set to  10096       Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then  exiting the menus causes the printer to reset  The menu  selection is updated           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item  Resource Save  On  Off    221    Description    Specifies how the printer handles temporary downloads  such as  fonts and macros stored in RAM  when the printer receives a job  that requires more memory than is available    Notes       Off is the factory default setting  Off sets the printer to retain  the downlo
187. ems on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy     Touch Copy from  and then identify the size of the original document     Uu 5 U   N    Touch Copy to  and then touch Manual Feeder and place letterhead face up  top edge first in the multipurpose  feeder     Touch the desired size of the letterhead  and then touch Continue   Touch the arrows until Letterhead appears     Touch Letterhead  and then touch Continue     O on Q    Touch Copy It     Customizing copy settings    Copying from one size to another  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy     Touch Copy from  and then identify the size of the original document     Uu A U N    Touch Copy to  and then select the size you want the copy to be     Note  If you select a paper size that is different from the    Copy from    size  then the printer will scale the size  automatically     6 Touch Copy It     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 96    Making copies using paper from a selected tray    During the copy process  you can select the tray that contains the paper type of choi
188. ent TCP IP hostname    Note  This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server        IP Address Lets you view or change the current TCP IP Address    Note  Manually setting the IP address sets the Enable DHCP and Enable Auto IP  settings to Off  It also sets Enable BOOTP and Enable RARP to Off on systems that  support BOOTP and RARP                             Netmask Lets you view or change the current TCP IP Netmask  Gateway Lets you view or change the current TCP IP Gateway  Enable DHCP Specifies the DHCP address and parameter assignment setting  On  Off  Enable RARP Specifies the RARP address assignment setting  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off  Enable BOOTP Specifies the BOOTP address assignment setting  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off  Ne d       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 172                            Menu item Description   AutolP Specifies the Zero Configuration Networking setting  Yes Note  Yes is the factory default setting   No   Enable FTP TFTP Enables the built in FTP server  which allows you to send files to the printer using the  Yes File Transfer Protocol   No Note  Yes is the factory default setting    Enable HTTP Server Enables the built in web server  Embedded Web Server   When enabled  the printer  Yes can be monitored and managed remotely using a web browser   No Note  Yes is the factory default setting    WINS Server Address Lets you view or change the current WINS 
189. er Type  Envelope  Rough Envelope  Custom Type   x      Specifies the type of envelope loaded in the envelope feeder  Notes       Envelope is the factory default setting       The Custom Type setting can be used to store up to six types of  envelopes        Manual Paper Size  A4  A5  A6  JIS B5  Letter  Legal  Executive  Oficio  Folio  Statement  Universal       Specifies the size of the paper being manually loaded    Note  A4 is the international factory default setting  Letter is the US factory  default setting           t Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off     Note  Only installed trays  drawers  and feeders are listed in this menu   V          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 156    Menu item Description    Manual Paper Type Specifies the type of paper being manually loaded  Plain Paper Note  Plain Paper is the factory default setting   Card Stock  Transparency  Recycled  Labels  Vinyl Labels  Bond  Letterhead  Preprinted  Colored Paper  Light Paper  Heavy Paper  Rough Cotton Paper  Custom Type  lt x gt           Manual Envelope Size Specifies the size of the envelope being manually loaded  7 3 4 Envelope Note  DL Envelope is the international factory default setting  10 Envelope is  9 Envelope the US factory default setting   10 Envelope  DL Envelope  Other Envelope  Manual Envelope Type Specifies the type of envelope being manually loaded  Envelope Note  Envelope is the factory default setting     Rough Envelope  
190. er com Manuals       Learning about the printer 19    Item Description    6 Start   Press KD to initiate the current job indicated on the display     From the home screen  press Kj  to start a copy job with the default settings        f pressed while a job is scanning  the button has no effect        7 Indicator light Indicates the printer status      Off   The power is off      Blinking green   The printer is warming up  processing data  or printing     Solid green    The printer is on  but idle       Blinking red   Operator intervention is needed        8   Stop Stops all printer activity  x A list of options is offered once Stopped appears on the display                    Understanding the home screen    After the printer is turned on and a short warm up period occurs  the display shows the following basic screen which  is referred to as the home screen  Use the home screen buttons to initiate an action such as copying  faxing  or scanning   to open the menu screen  or to respond to messages                                 H  Ready    mij Touch any button to begin  v                7 6 5 4  Display item Description  1 Copy Opens the Copy menus  Note  From the home screen  you can also access the Copy menus by pressing a number on  the keypad   2 E mail Opens the E mail menus  3   Menus Opens the menus  These menus are available only when the printer is in the Ready state   4 FTP Opens the File Transfer Protocol  FTP  menus    Note  This function must be set up by your sys
191. er the  time and date you would like to send your fax  and then touch Done  This setting can be especially useful in sending  information to fax lines that are not readily available during certain hours  or when transmission times are cheaper     Note  If the printer is turned off when the delayed fax is scheduled to be sent  the fax is sent the next time the  printer is turned on       Advanced Imaging   Adjusts Background Removal  Contrast  Scan Edge to Edge  Shadow Detail  and Mirror Image  before you fax the document      Custom Job  Job Build    Combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job    Transmission Log    Prints the transmission log or transmission error log      Scan Preview    Displays the image before it is included in the fax  When the first page is scanned  the scanning is  paused  and a preview image appears       Edge Erase   Eliminates smudges or information around the edges of a document  You can choose to eliminate an  equal area around all four sides of the paper  or pick a particular edge  Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the  area selected  leaving nothing on that portion of the scan       Advanced Duplex    Controls how many sides and what orientation an original document has  and whether original  documents are bound along the long edge or the short edge    Note  Some Advanced Duplex options may not be available on all printer models     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing    120    Improving fax quality    e    Ques
192. erein  these changes will be incorporated in later editions  Improvements or changes in the products or  the programs described may be made at any time     References in this publication to products  programs  or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to make  these available in all countries in which it operates  Any reference to a product  program  or service is not intended to  state or imply that only that product  program  or service may be used  Any functionally equivalent product  program   or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be used instead  Evaluation and verification  of operation in conjunction with other products  programs  or services  except those expressly designated by the  manufacturer  are the user s responsibility     For Lexmark technical support  visit support lexmark com   For information on supplies and downloads  visit www lexmark com   If you don t have access to the Internet  you can contact Lexmark by mail     Lexmark International  Inc   Bldg 004 2 CSC   740 New Circle Road NW  Lexington  KY 40550       2008 Lexmark International  Inc     All rights reserved     UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT RIGHTS    This software and any accompanying documentation provided under this agreement are commercial computer  software and documentation developed exclusively at private expense     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 292    Trademarks    Lexmark  Lexmark with diamond design  MarkNet  a
193. escription    Enables a print mode preferable for files such as architectural drawings  maps  electrical  circuit diagrams  and flow charts    Notes     e Off is the factory default setting       To set Enhance Fine Lines using the Embedded Web Server  type the network  printer IP address in a browser window        Gray Correction    Adjusts the gray value of printed output          Auto Note  Auto is the factory default setting   Off  Brightness Adjusts or darkens printed output and conserves toner   6 to  6 Notes     0 is the factory default setting     A negative value will darken text  images  and graphics  A positive value will  lighten them and conserve toner   Contrast Adjusts the degree of difference between levels of gray in printed output  0 5       Notes       Ois the factory default setting             Higher settings show more difference between levels of gray        Utilities menu    Menu item  Remove Held Jobs  Confidential  Held  Not Restored  All    Description    Removes confidential and held jobs from the printer hard disk    Notes     Selecting a setting affects only print jobs that are resident in the printer   Bookmarks  jobs on flash drives  and other types of held jobs are not affected       Selecting Not Restored removes all Print and Hold jobs that were not restored  from the disk        Format Flash  Yes  No       Formats the flash memory  Flash memory refers to the memory added by installing  a flash memory option card in the printer     Warning   
194. escription    PCL SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job requires  On it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes       Onisthe factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data       When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PostScript emulation if PS  SmartSwitch is set to On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off        PS SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job requires  On it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes       Onisthe factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data       When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PCL emulation if PCL  SmartSwitch is set to On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off                 Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       168          Menu item Description  NPA Mode Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  Off communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  Auto Notes     Auto is the factory default setting     Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated   Network Buffer Sets the siz
195. eshooting 271    Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     OTHER SOFTWARE PROGRAMS MAY BE INTERFERING WITH SCANNING    Close all programs not being used   THE SCAN RESOLUTION MAY BE SET TOO HIGH    Select a lower scan resolution     Poor scanned image quality    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES    Clear any error messages     THE SCANNER GLASS MAY BE DIRTY    Clean the scanner glass with a clean  lint free cloth dampened with water  For more information  see    Cleaning the  scanner glass    on page 251     ADJUST THE SCAN RESOLUTION    Increase the resolution of the scan for a higher quality output     CHECK THE QUALITY OF THE ORIGINAL DOCUMENT    Make sure the quality of the original document is satisfactory     CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT    Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner     Partial document or photo scans    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT    Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 272    CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING  Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu     
196. ess Specifies the level of darkness for the copy job  1 9   Output Bin Specifies which output bin receives the copy after it is printed  Standard Bin  Bin  lt x gt        Number of Copies    Specifies the number of copies for the copy job       Header Footer  Top left   Top left  Off  Date Time  Page number  Bates number  Custom text   Print on  All pages  First page only  All but first page   Enter custom text    Specifies header footer information for the top left of the page    Notes     e Off is the factory default setting for Top left      All pages  is the factory default setting for Print on           Header Footer  Top middle  Top middle  Off  Date Time  Page number  Bates number  Custom text  Print on  All pages  First page only  All but first page  Enter custom text       Specifies header footer information for the middle of the page    Notes     e Off is the factory default setting for Top middle        All pages  is the factory default setting for Print on           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 195    a    Menu item Description    Header Footer Specifies header footer information for the top right of the page  Top right Notes   Top right  Off e Off is the factory default setting for Top right   Date Time      All pages  is the factory default setting for Print on     Page number   Bates number   Custom text  Print on   All pages   First page only   All but first page  Enter custom text       Header Footer Specifies h
197. etup  Max e mail size  0 65535 KB    Specifies the maximum e mail size in kilobytes    Note  E mail above the specified size is not sent        E mail Server Setup  Size Error Message    Sends a message when an e mail is greater than the configured size limit       E mail Server Setup  Limit destinations    Sends an e mail only when the address contains the domain name  such as a company  domain name    Notes       E mail can only be sent to the specified domain       The limit is one domain        E mail Server Setup  Web Link Setup    Defines the path name    Note  Defines the path  For example   directory path                Server The following characters or symbols are invalid entries for a path name            Login  gt      Password  Path  Base file name  Web Link  Format Specifies the format of the file  PDF   pdf   Secure PDF  TIFF   tif   JPEG   jpg   XPS   xps   PDF Version Sets the version of the PDF file that will be scanned to e mail  1 2 1 6 Note  1 5 is the factory default setting   Content Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to e mail  Text Photo Notes   Photograph  Text   Text Photo is the factory default setting  Text Photo is used when the    documents are mostly text or line art       Photograph is used when the document is a high quality photograph or inkjet  print       Text is used when the document is mostly text              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    a    208                Business
198. etup page  You will need the IP address if you  are configuring access for computers on a different subnet than the printer     3 Add the printer     For IP printing     n Mac OS X version 10 5   From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   Click Print  amp  Fax    Click      Select the printer from the list    Click Add     0 C0 O 9o    Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier  From the Go menu  choose Applications   Double click Utilities   Double click Printer Setup Utility or Print Center   From the Printer List  click Add   Select the printer from the list    f Click Add       For AppleTalk printing     5    oao0ono5   o    5    Mac OS X version 10 5   From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   Click Print  amp  Fax    Click 4    Click AppleTalk    Select the printer from the list    Click Add      gt    ao O 9    Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier  From the Go menu  choose Applications   Double click Utilities   Double click Print Center or Printer Setup Utility   From the Printer List  click Add   Choose the Default Browser tab     5    Click More Printers   From the first pop up menu  choose AppleTalk     zn   07 Qa   o    From the second pop up menu  select Local AppleTalk zone     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 58    i Select the printer from the list   j Click Add     Setting up serial printing    In serial printing  data is transferred one bit at a time  Although serial printing is usually slower than parallel printing 
199. etwork  If no default  network gt  zone exists  the zone marked with an   is the default setting           NetWare menu    This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports  gt  Standard Network or Network  lt x gt   gt  Std Network Setup or Net  lt x gt  Setup  gt  NetWare    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 174       Menu item Description       Activate Activates NetWare support  Yes Note  No is the factory default setting   No  View Login Name Lets you view the assigned NetWare login name    Note  This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server        Print Mode Lets you view the assigned NetWare print mode    Note  This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server        Network Number Lets you view the assigned NetWare network number    Note  This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server                       Select SAP Frames Enables the Ethernet frame type setting  Ethernet 802 2 Note  On is the factory default setting for all menu items   Ethernet 802 3  Ethernet Type II  Ethernet SNAP   Packet Burst Reduces network traffic by allowing the transfer and acknowledgement of  Yes multiple data packets to and from the NetWare server  No Note  Yes is the factory default setting    NSQ GSQ Mode Specifies the NSQ GSQ Mode setting  Yes Note  Yes is the factory default setting   No   s A       LexLink menu  This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports    Standard Network or 
200. factory default setting        Enable Color Fax Scans  On by default  Never use  Always use  Off by default    Enables color faxing  Note     Off by default    is the factory default setting        Auto Convert Color Faxes to Mono  Faxes   On   off       Converts all outgoing faxes to black and white    Note  On is the factory default setting              Fax Receive Settings    Menu item    Enable Fax Receive  On  off       Description    Allows fax jobs to be received by the printer    Note  On is the factory default setting        Rings to Answer  1 25    Specifies the number of rings before answering an incoming fax job    Note  1 is the factory default setting        Auto Reduction  On  off    Scales an incoming fax job so it fits the size of the paper loaded in the designated fax  source    Note  On is the factory default setting        Paper Source  Auto  Tray  lt x gt   Multi Purpose Feeder    Specifies the paper source selected to supply paper for the printer to printan incoming  fax                Output Bin Specifies an output bin for received faxes  Standard Bin Note  Bin 1 is available only when the finisher is installed   Bin 1 lt x gt   Sides  Duplex  Enables duplex printing  two sided printing  for incoming fax jobs  On  off  Fax Footer Prints the transmission information at the bottom of each page from a received fax  On Note  On is the factory default setting   off             Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Me
201. factory default settings                  essssssssssssssssssseseee seen eene nnne nemen nennen nennen enne 262    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 10    TROUDISSAOOT ING cc                           REY ED    Solving basic printer problems                     ssssssssssssesseseseeee eene eene nennen sen ene nenn aiiai 264  Printer control panel display is blank or displays only diamonds                            sse 264  Solving printing Problem S  ssnin aee ee raga e erede rasa eo een Duae ce eu EE EEE AE DRSF ege Regu ewe 264  Multiple language PDFs do not Print             cccscccsssseceecessessececesssssesecescsssseecesesasseeescesesseeeecsesesaeecesessasaaaeeeeess 264  Error message about reading USB drive appears                  esssssssseseeseee eene tennn nnne nennt nennen 264  Jobs do not prilit iicet ritenere eure he EER odes ca grasa dvd ze oto ge Ra ed cera dad 265  Confidential and other held jobs do not print              cccccccccssssssecescessssaeecessssssececssueeeecssessaseeecesesseaeeaeeseeseseaaes 265  Job takes longer than expected to print            ccccccsssscccesssssseeecessssssecescessseesecessessseeesscsseeeeeseseseseessesesssenseeesens 266  Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper    nennen nennen nennen nnne nnnnn n nnne 266  Inicorrect characters print    tenti ede san eria ro eee etre Fen a a SES AE ER a Hd ERR eR EVA Ea E YR DR ER Ele VR EEEE 266  Tray linking does riot WOLF    i erri Fer reete shadeddade
202. fferent in appearance  they require the same process for  loading paper  Use these instructions to load paper in either tray     1 Pull the tray out   Note  Do not remove trays while a job prints or while Busy appears on the display  Doing so may cause a jam           2 Squeeze the width guide tab inward as shown  and move the width guide to the correct position for the paper size    being loaded        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 73    3 Unlock the length guide  squeeze the length guide tab inward as shown  and slide the guide to the correct position  for the paper size being loaded        Notes       Usethe size indicators on the bottom of the tray to help position the guides       For standard paper sizes  lock the length guide     4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them  and then fan them  Do not fold or crease the paper  Straighten the  edges on a level surface        5 Load the paper stack     Print side facedown for single sided printing      Print side faceup for duplex printing    Note  Paper must be loaded differently in the trays if an optional StapleSmart    II Finisher is installed     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 74    Without an optional StapleSmart II Finisher With an optional StapleSmart II Finisher       Single sided printing Single sided printing                  Duplex  two sided  printing Duplex  two sided  printing       P4       Note  Not
203. fidential  Reserve  Repeat  or Verify   and then assign a user name  For a confidential job   also enter a four digit PIN     Click OK or Print  and then go to the printer to release the job     6 On the home screen  touch Held jobs     Touch your user name     Note  A maximum of 500 results can be displayed for held jobs  If your name does not appear  touch the down  arrow until your name appears  or touch Search Held Jobs if there are a large number of held jobs in the printer     Touch Confidential Jobs     9 Enter your PIN     10  11    Touch the job you want to print     Touch Print  or touch the arrows to increase or decrease the number of copies  and then touch Print     Printing confidential and other held jobs from a Macintosh computer    Note  Confidential and Verify print jobs are automatically deleted from memory after they print  Repeat and Reserve  jobs continue to be held in the printer until you choose to delete them     1    10    With a document open  choose File    Print     If necessary  click the disclosure triangle to see more options   From the print options or Copies  amp  Pages pop up menu  choose Job Routing     Select your job type  Confidential  Reserve  Repeat  or Verify   and then assign a user name  For a confidential job   also enter a four digit PIN     Click OK or Print  and then go to the printer to release the job   On the home screen  touch Held jobs   Touch your user name     Note  A maximum of 500 results can be displayed for held jobs  
204. following     Touch Continue to clear the message       Turn the printer off and then back on to reset the printer  If the message appears again  then contact your system  support person     Fax server  To Format  not set up  Contact system administrator   The printer is in Fax Server mode  but the Fax Server setup has not been completed     Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message       Complete the Fax Server setup  If the message appears again  contact your system support person     Fax Station Name not set up  The Fax Station Name has not been entered  Sending and receiving faxes is disabled until fax is configured properly     Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message       Complete the Analog Fax Setup  If the message appears again  contact your system support person     Fax Station Number not set up  The Fax Station Number has not been entered  Sending and receiving faxes is disabled until fax is configured properly     Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message       Complete the Analog Fax Setup  If the message appears again  contact your system support person     Flushing buffer    Wait for the message to clear     Insert staple cartridge    Try one or more of the following      nsert a staple cartridge to clear the message       Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the staple feature     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding p
205. following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product     Note  Some modes may not apply to your product     Description Power consumption   Watts                                         Printing The product is generating hard copy output from electronic inputs  700 W   Copying The product is generating hard copy output from hard copy original 765 W  documents    Scanning The product is scanning hard copy documents  165 W   Ready The product is waiting for a print job  95 W   Power Saver The product is in energy saving mode  21W  24W  26W   High Off The product is plugged into a wall outlet  but the power switch is turned   N A  off    Low Off   lt 1 W Off    The product is plugged into a wall outlet  the power switch is turned off    N A  and the product is in the lowest possible power consumption mode    Off The product is plugged into a wall outlet  but the power switch is turned   110V 2 0 15W  220V   1 25W  off        The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time averaged measurements  Instantaneous  power draws may be substantially higher than the average     Values are subject to change  See www lexmark com for current values     Power Saver    This product is designed with an energy saving mode called Power Saver  The Power Saver Mode is equivalent to the  EPA Sleep Mode  The Power Saver Mode saves energy by lowering power consumption during extended periods of  inactivity  The Power Saver Mode is automatically engag
206. for ad hoc networks    The channel defaults to auto for infrastructure networks     Some ad hoc networks will also require the auto setting  Check with your system support person if you are not sure  which channel to select       Security Method   There are three basic options for Security Method         WEP key    If your network uses more than one WEP key  enter up to four in the provided spaces  Select the key currently  in use on the network by selecting the Default WEP Transmit Key     or        WPA or WPA2 passphrase    WPA includes encryption as an additional layer of security  The choices are AES or TKIP  Encryption must be set  for the same type on the router and on the printer  or the printer will not be able to communicate on the  network         No security  If your wireless network does not use any type of security  then you will not have any security information     Note  Using an unsecured wireless network is not recommended     If you are installing the printer on an 802 1X network using the Advanced method  then you may need the following     Authentication type     nner authentication type    802 1X username and password    Certificates    Note  For more information on configuring 802 1X security  see the Networking Guide on the Software and  Documentation CD     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup    Installing the printer on a wireless network  Windows     Before you install the printer on a wireless network  make sure
207. for any single manual  call initiation  and      The equipment shall go on hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of one attempt and the  beginning of the next call attempt       The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to different numbers are spaced such that there is not  less than 5 seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of another     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 300    South Africa telecommunications notice    This modem must be used in conjunction with an approved surge protection device when connected to the PSTN     Using this product in Switzerland    This product requires a Swiss billing tone filter  Lexmark part number 14B5109 or 80D1877  to be installed on any line  which receives metering pulses in Switzerland  The Lexmark filter must be used  as metering pulses are present on all  analog telephone lines in Switzerland     Utilisation de ce produit en Suisse    Cet appareil n  cessite l utilisation d un filtre de tonalit   de facturation suisse  n9 de r  f  rence Lexmark   14B5109 ou  80D1877  devant   tre install   sur toute ligne recevant des impulsions de comptage en Suisse  Ce filtre doit   tre utilis    pour toute installation car ces impulsions existent sur toutes les lignes t  l  phoniques suisses     Verwendung dieses Produkts in der Schweiz    F  r dieses Produkt muss ein schweizerischer Billing Tone Filter zur Z  hlzeichen  bertragung  Lexmark Teilenummer  14B510
208. for the upgrade  After upgrading  you may no longer use the original  Software Program that formed the basis for your upgrade eligibility     LIMITATION ON REVERSE ENGINEERING  You may not alter  decrypt  reverse engineer  reverse assemble  reverse  compile or otherwise translate the Software Program or assist or otherwise facilitate others to do so  except as and  to the extent expressly permitted to do so by applicable law for the purposes of inter operability  error correction   and security testing  If you have such statutory rights  you will notify Lexmark in writing of any intended reverse  engineering  reverse assembly  or reverse compilation  You may not decrypt the Software Program unless necessary  for the legitimate Use of the Software Program     ADDITIONAL SOFTWARE  This Software License Agreement applies to updates or supplements to the original  Software Program provided by Lexmark unless Lexmark provides other terms along with the update or supplement     TERM  This Software License Agreement is effective unless terminated or rejected  You may reject or terminate  this license at any time by destroying all copies of the Software Program  together with all modifications   documentation  and merged portions in any form  or as otherwise described herein  Lexmark may terminate your  license upon notice if you fail to comply with any of the terms of this Software License Agreement  Upon such  termination  you agree to destroy all copies of the Software Program toge
209. g is used  the printer examines data  determines the  format  and then processes it appropriately       Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Serial Buffer  Disabled  Auto  3K to   maximum size allowed      Sets the size of the serial input buffer  Notes       Auto is the factory default setting       The Disabled setting turns off job buffering  Any jobs already buffered on the  disk are printed before normal processing is resumed       The serial buffer size setting can be changed in 1 K increments       The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer   the size of the other link buffers  and whether Resource Save is set to On or  Off       To increase the maximum size range for the Serial Buffer  disable or reduce  the size of the parallel  USB  and network buffers       Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated           Job Buffering  Off  On  Auto    Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing    Notes     e Offis the factory default setting     The Off setting does not buffer print jobs to the hard disk     The On setting buffers jobs on the printer hard disk       The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  from another input port       Changing this setting from the printer contr
210. g paper and specialty media                                       Duplex  two sided  printing Duplex  two sided  printing       Notes     Do not exceed the maximum stack height by forcing paper under the stack height limiter   e Do not load or close a tray while a job is printing     Load only one size and type of media at a time       Load envelopes with the flap side up     Warning    Potential Damage  Never use envelopes with stamps  clasps  snaps  windows  coated linings  or  self stick adhesives  These envelopes may severely damage the printer     6 Adjust the width guide to lightly touch the edge of the paper stack  Make sure the paper fits loosely in the  multipurpose feeder  lies flat  and is not bent or wrinkled     7 From the printer control panel  set the Paper Size and Paper Type     Loading the envelope feeder    1 Adjust the envelope support for the length of envelope you are loading     Short envelopes   Fully close the envelope support     Medium length envelopes    Extend the envelope support to the middle position       Long envelopes   Fully open the envelope support     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       81    Loading paper and specialty media 82    2 Lift the envelope weight back toward the printer           3 Slide the width guide to the right           4 Prepare the envelopes for loading     Flex the envelopes back and forth to loosen them  and then fan them  Do not fold or crease the paper  Straighten  the edges on a level surface        
211. gnore  Honor DSR Determines whether the printer uses the DSR Signal  DSR is a handshaking signal used  On by most serial cables   Off Notes    e Offis the factory default setting      The serial port uses DSR to distinguish data sent by the computer from data  created by electrical noise in the serial cable  The electrical noise can cause  stray characters to print  Select On to prevent stray characters from printing      This menu item appears only if Serial RS 232 RS 422 is set to RS 232              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Security menu    Miscellaneous menu    Menu item    Panel Logins  Login failures  Failure time frame  Lockout time  Login timeout    181    Description    Limits the number and time frames of failed login attempts from the printer control  panel before all users are locked out    Notes        Login failures  specifies the number of failed login attempts before users are  locked out  Settings range from 1   50  3 attempts is the factory default setting        Failure time frame  specifies the time frame during which failed login  attempts can be made before users are locked out  Settings range from 1 60  minutes  5 minutes is the factory default setting          Lockout time  specifies how long users are locked out after exceeding the  login failures limit  Settings range from 0   60 minutes  5 minutes is the factory  default setting  O indicates the printer does not impose a lockout time        Logi
212. habetic and numeric characters  punctuation   and special symbols  Symbol sets support the different languages or  specific programs such as math symbols for scientific text  Only the  supported symbol sets are shown        PCL Emulation Settings Specifies the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts  Pitch Notes   0 08 100      10 is the factory default setting     Pitch refers to the number of fixed space characters per inch  cpi      Pitch can be increased or decreased in 0 01 cpi increments       For nonscalable monospaced fonts  the pitch appears on the display but  cannot be changed                             PCL Emulation Settings Specifies the orientation of text and graphics on the page  Orientation Notes   Portrait  Landscape   Portrait is the factory default setting     Portrait prints text and graphics parallel to the short edge of the page     Landscape prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the page   PCL Emulation Settings Specifies the number of lines that print on each page  Lines per Page Notes   1 255    60 is the US factory default setting  64 is the international default setting     The printer sets the amount of space between each line based on the  Lines per Page  Paper Size  and Orientation settings  Select the desired  Paper Size and Orientation before setting Lines per Page   PCL Emulation Settings Sets the printer to print on A4 size paper  A4 Width Notes   198 mm  203 mm   198 mm is the factory default setting     The 203 mm setting
213. he Paper Type is Card Stock       Select the appropriate Paper Texture setting     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 134    Be aware that preprinting  perforation  and creasing may significantly affect the print quality and cause jams or  other paper handling problems     Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure the card stock can withstand temperatures up to 230  C  446  F   without releasing hazardous emissions      Do not use preprinted card stock manufactured with chemicals that may contaminate the printer  Preprinting  introduces semi liquid and volatile components into the printer     Use grain short card stock when possible     Printing confidential and other held jobs    Holding jobs in the printer    When sending a job to the printer  you can specify that you want the printer to hold the job in memory until you start  the job from the printer control panel  All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs     Note  Confidential  Verify  Reserve  and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to    Description    process additional held jobs        Confidential When you send a Confidential print job to the printer  you must create a PIN from  the computer  The PIN must be four digits using the numbers 0   9  The job is held  in printer memory until you enter the PIN from the printer control panel and  choose to print or delete the job        Verify When you send a Verify prin
214. he StapleSmart Finisher is installed   e Off is the factory default setting  Print jobs are not stapled     Envelopes are not stapled        Offset Pages Stacks copies or print jobs into staggered sets in an output bin  Off Notes   Between Jobs   jl  T  Between Copies   This menu item appears only when the StapleSmart Finisher is installed       Off is the factory default setting  No pages are offset during the print job     Between Jobs offsets each print job          Between Copies offsets each copy of a print job              Quality menu    Menu item Description       Print Resolution Specifies the printed output resolution  300 dpi Note  600 dpi is the factory default setting  The printer driver default is 1200 IQ   600 dpi  1200 dpi  1200 Image Q  2400 Image Q  Pixel Boost Enhances the printed quality of small fonts and graphics  Off Notes   Fonts  Horizontally e Off is the factory default setting   Vertically   Fonts applies this setting only to text   Both Directions   Horizontally darkens horizontal lines of text and images       Vertically darkens vertical lines of text and images     Both Directions darkens horizontal and vertical lines on text and images        Toner Darkness Lightens or darkens the printed output    1 10 Notes       8isthe factory default setting                Selecting a smaller number can help conserve toner        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item  Enhance Fine Lines  On  Off    224    D
215. he first page of the image before it is included in the e mail  When the first page is scanned   the scanning is paused and a preview image appears       Edge Erase   Eliminates smudges or information around the edges of a document  You can choose to eliminate an  equal area around all four sides of the paper  or pick a particular edge  Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the  area selected  leaving nothing on that portion of the scan       Darkness   Adjusts how light or dark your scanned e mails will turn out    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 113    Faxing    Note  Fax capabilities may not be available on all printer models     ADF Scanner glass       d                   Use the ADF for multiple page documents    Use the scanner glass for single pages  small items  such as postcards or  photos   transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine    clippings                  Sending a fax    Sending a fax using the printer control panel  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch Fax     4 Enter the fax number or a shortcut using the touch screen or keypad     To add recipients  touch Next Number
216. he information     If you enter a number that is already in use  then you are prompted to select another number        8 Touch Fax It to send the fax  or touch     to return to the home screen     Using shortcuts and the address book    Using fax shortcuts    Fax shortcuts are just like the speed dial numbers on a telephone or fax machine  You can assign shortcut numbers  when creating permanent fax destinations  Permanent fax destinations or speed dial numbers are created in the  Manage Shortcuts link located under Settings on the Embedded Web Server  A shortcut number  1   99999  can contain  a single recipient or multiple recipients  By creating a group fax shortcut with a shortcut number  you can quickly and  easily fax broadcast information to an entire group     1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not place postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as  magazine clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides     3 Press      and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad     Using the address book  Note  If the address book feature is not enabled  then contact your system support person   1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  phot
217. he paper guides     3 Press        and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad     To enter additional recipients  press Next address  and then enter the address or shortcut number you want to  add     4 Touch E mail It     Sending an e mail using the address book  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch E mail   Touch Search Address Book     Enter the name or part of the name you are searching for  and then touch Search     oc u P   U N    Touch the name that you want to add to the To  box     To enter additional recipients  press Next address  and then enter the address or shortcut number you want to  add  or search the address book     7 Touch E mail It     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing 109    Customizing e mail settings    Adding e mail subject and message information    1    O on ou A W N    e e e  N e O    Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading 
218. heet  printable stock   and topcoats can withstand up to 25 psi  172 kPa  pressure without  delaminating  oozing around the edges  or releasing hazardous fumes       Do not use labels with slick backing material       Use full label sheets  Partial sheets may cause labels to peel off during printing  resulting in a jam  Partial sheets  also contaminate the printer and the cartridge with adhesive  and could void the printer and cartridge warranties       Do not use labels with exposed adhesive     Do not print within 1 mm  0 04 in   of the edge of the label  of the perforations  or between die cuts of the label       Be sure adhesive backing does not reach to the sheet edge  Zone coating of the adhesive at least 1 mm  0 04 in    away from edges is recommended  Adhesive material contaminates the printer and could void the warranty        f zone coating of the adhesive is not possible  remove a 1 6 mm  0 06 in   strip on the leading and driver edge  and  use a non oozing adhesive       Portrait orientation works best  especially when printing bar codes     Tips on using card stock    Card stock is heavy  single ply specialty media  Many of its variable characteristics  such as moisture content  thickness   and texture  can significantly impact print quality  Print samples on the card stock being considered for use before  buying large quantities   When printing on card stock      Feed card stock from a 250 sheet tray  a 550 sheet tray  or the multipurpose feeder      Make sure t
219. hin media  such as magazine  clippings      Ne P                The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a File Transfer Protocol  FTP  server  Only one FTP address may be sent  to the server at a time     Once an FTP destination has been configured by your system support person  the name of the destination becomes  available as a shortcut number  or it is listed as a profile under the Held Jobs icon  An FTP destination could also be  another PostScript printer  for example  a color document can be scanned and then sent to a color printer  Sending a  document to an FTP server is similar to sending a fax  The difference is that you are sending the information over your  network instead of over the phone line     Scanning to an FTP address    Scanning to an FTP address using the keypad  1 Loadan original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch FTP    4 Type the FTP address    5 Touch Send It     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to an FTP address 123    Scanning to an FTP address using a shortcut number  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postca
220. ice the maximum fill line on the side of the tray which indicates the maximum height for loading  paper  Do not overload the tray        6 If necessary  adjust the paper guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack  and lock the length guide for the paper  sizes indicated on the tray     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 75    7 Insert the tray        8 If a different type of paper was loaded than the type previously loaded in the tray  then change the Paper Type  setting for the tray from the printer control panel     Loading the 2000 sheet tray    1 Pull the tray out     2 Pull up and slide the width guide to the correct position for the paper size being loaded        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 76    3 Unlock the length guide              4 Push the length guide release latch to raise the length guide  slide the guide to the correct position for the paper  size being loaded  and then lock the guide        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 77    5 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them  and then fan them  Do not fold or crease the paper  Straighten the    edges on a level surface        6 Load the paper stack     Print side facedown for single sided printing    Print side faceup for duplex printing  Note  Paper must be loaded differently in the trays if an optional StapleSmart II Finisher is installed       Without
221. ield points produces the best print quality     Moisture content    The amount of moisture in paper affects both print quality and the ability of the printer to feed the paper correctly   Leave paper in its original wrapper until it is time to use it  This limits the exposure of paper to moisture changes that  can degrade its performance     Condition paper before printing by storing it in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to  48 hours before printing  Extend the time several days if the storage or transportation environment is very different  from the printer environment  Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning period     Grain direction    Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper  Grain is either grain long  running the length of  the paper  or grain short  running the width of the paper     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper and specialty media guidelines 87    For 60 176 g m   16 47 Ib bond  paper  grain long paper is recommended  For paper heavier than 176 g m  grain  short is recommended     Fiber content    Most high quality xerographic paper is made from 100  chemically treated pulped wood  This content provides the  paper with a high degree of stability resulting in fewer paper feeding problems and better print quality  Paper containing  fibers such as cotton can negatively affect paper handling     For detailed information on paper with recycled fiber content  see  Using rec
222. ies that print jobs be removed from the print queue if they  require unavailable printer options or custom settings  They are  stored ina separate print queue  so other jobs print normally  When  the missing information and or options are obtained  the stored  jobs print     Notes     e Offis the factory default setting       This menu appears only if a non Read Only printer hard disk  is installed  This requirement ensures that stored jobs are  not deleted if the printer loses power        M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       Menu item    Print Area  Normal  Whole Page    220    Description    Sets the logical and physical printable area  Notes       This menu does not appear if Edge to Edge is enabled in the  printer Setup menu       Normal is the factory default setting  When attempting to  print data in the non printable area defined by the Normal  setting  the printer clips the image at the boundary       The Whole Page setting allows the image to be moved into  the non printable area defined by the Normal setting  but  the printer will clip the image at the Normal setting  boundary       The Whole Page setting only affects pages printed using a  PCL 5e interpreter  This setting has no effect on pages  printed using the PCL XL or PostScript interpreter        Download Target  RAM  Flash  Disk    Sets the storage location for downloads    Notes       RAM is the factory default setting       Storing downloads in flash m
223. if page jam recovery is active  Scanning resumes from the scanner glass immediately after  the last successfully scanned page     Touch Finish job without further scanning if page jam recovery is active  The job ends at the last successfully scanned  page  but the job is not canceled  Successfully scanned pages go to their destination  copy  fax  e mail  or FTP     Touch Restart job if job recovery is active  The message clears  A new scan job containing the same parameters as  the previous job starts     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 240    Replace wiper    Replace the fuser wiper  or try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing       Touch Ignore to clear the message  but at the next power on  the message appears again     Restore Held Jobs     Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to restore all held jobs stored on the printer hard disk       Touch Do not restore if you do not want any print jobs to be restored     Scan Document Too Long    The scan job exceeds the maximum number of pages  Touch Cancel Job to clear the message     Scanner ADF Cover Open    The ADF cover is open  The message clears when the cover is closed     Scanner Jam Access Cover Open    Close the bottom ADF door to clear the message     Securely clearing disk space    The printer hard disk wiping process needs to recover  The message clears when all blocks are cleared     Sending page   n 
224. ifies the orientation of the scanned image  Portrait Note  Portrait is the factory default setting   Landscape  Original Size Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  Letter Note  Letter is the US factory default setting  A4 is the international factory default  Legal setting   Executive  Folio  Statement  Universal  4x6in   3x5in        Sides  Duplex   Off  Long edge  Short edge       Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  Notes     e Offis the factory default setting       Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page  left edge for  portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation        Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page  top edge for  portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation               Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item    Photo JPEG Quality       216    Description    Sets the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the       5 90 image  Notes     50 is the factory default setting     5 reduces the file size  but the quality of the image is lessened     90 provides the best image quality  but the file size is very large     This menu item applies to all scan functions   JPEG Quality Sets the quality of a JPEG text or text photo image in relation to file size and the  Best for content quality of the image   5 90 Notes        Best for content  is the factory default set
225. il  Sharpness  and Color Dropout before you  scan the document  It also lets you Scan edge to edge  as a Mirror Image  or as a Negative Image       Background Removal   Adjusts the white portion of the output  Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease  the white portion       Contrast   Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the contrast     Shadow Detail    Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the visible detail in the shadows     Sharpness   Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the sharpness       Color Dropout    Color dropout is used for form Optical Character Recognition  OCR  processing  Selecting a color  eliminates the color from a form  enabling improved OCR capabilities       Color Dropout Threshold   Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the amount of color dropout     Scan edge to edge   Select this box to scan edge to edge     Mirror Image   Select this box to create a mirror image scan       Negative Image   Select this box to create a negative image scan     Improving scan quality       Question Tip  When should   use Text   Use Text mode when text preservation is the main goal of the scan  and preserving images  mode  copied from the original document is not a concern       Text mode is recommended for receipts  carbon copy forms  and documents that only  contain text or fine line art        When should I use   Use Text Photo mode when scanning an original document that contains a mixture of text  Text Photo mode 
226. iles  Bookmarks  Jobs by user    188    Description    Additional buttons can be added to the Home screen  and default  buttons can be removed     Available selections for each button are   Display  Do Not Display       Date Format  MM DD YYYY  DD MM YYYY  YYYY MM DD    Formats the printer date       Time Format  12 hour A M  P M   24 hour clock    Formats the printer time       Screen Brightness  20 100    Specifies the brightness of the printer control panel screen       One Page Copy  On  Off       Sets the copies from the scanner glass to only one page at a time    Note  Off is the factory default setting              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       Menu item    Output Lighting  Standard Bin LED  Normal Standby Mode  Bright  Dim  Off  Power Saver  Bright  Dim  Off  Output Option Bin LEDs  Normal Standby Mode  Bright  Dim  Off  Power Saver  Bright  Dim  Off    189    Description    Sets the amount of light from the standard bin or an optional output  bin  Notes       n Normal Standby Mode  the factory default is Bright        n Power Saver Mode  the factory default is Dim        Show Bookmarks  On  Off    Specifies whether bookmarks are displayed from the Held Jobs area    Note  On is the factory default setting  When On is selected   bookmarks appear in the Held Jobs area        Allow Background Removal  On  Off    Specifies whether image background removal is allowed during  copy  fax  e mail  FTP  or scan to USB    Note
227. ing     CHECK THE PAPER GUIDES    Move the guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded     CHECK THE PAPER    Make sure you are using paper that meets the printer specifications     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 285    Solid black or white streaks    N N  A   BC  D LEF    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     IVIAKE SURE THE FILL PATTERN IS CORRECT    If the fill pattern is incorrect  then choose a different fill pattern from your software program or application     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE    Try a different type of paper     Use only transparencies recommended by the printer manufacturer       Make sure the Paper Type and Paper Texture settings match the paper loaded in the tray or feeder     IVIAKE SURE THE TONER IS DISTRIBUTED EVENLY IN THE PRINT CARTRIDGE    Remove the print cartridge and shake it from side to side to redistribute the toner  and then reinstall it   THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE OR LOW ON TONER    Replace the used print cartridge with a new one     Print is too light    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DARKNESS  BRIGHTNESS  AND CONTRAST SETTINGS    The Toner Darkness setting is too light  the Brightness setting is too light  or the Contrast setting is too low     From the printer control panel  change these settings from the Quality menu     For Windows users  change these settings from Print Properties       For Macinto
228. ing 28  troubleshooting 278  Memory full  cannot print  faxes 236  menu settings page  printing 45  menus  Active NIC 167  AppleTalk 173  Bin Setup 164  Confidential Print 181  Configure MP 156  Copy Settings 192  Custom Bin Names 163  Custom Names 162  Custom Scan Sizes 163  Custom Types 162  Default Source 153  diagram of 152  Disk Wiping 182  Envelope Enhance 157  E mail Settings 206  Fax Mode  Analog Fax Setup  197  Fax Mode  Fax Server Setup  205  Finishing 221  Flash Drive 214  FTP Settings 211  Help 231  HTML 229  Image 230  IPv6 172  LexLink 174  Miscellaneous 181  NetWare 173  Network  lt x gt  167  Network Card 170  Network Reports 170  Paper Loading 161    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper Size Type 153  Paper Texture 157  Paper Weight 159  Parallel   x   menu 176  PCL Emul 226   PDF 225   PostScript 226   Quality 223   Reports 165   Security Audit Log 183  Serial   x   178   Set Date Time 184  Settings 185   Setup 219   SMTP Setup menu 169  Standard Network 167  Standard USB 175  Substitute Size 157  TCP IP 171   Universal Setup 163  Utilities 224   Wireless 172   XPS 230  Miscellaneous menu 181  moving the printer 258  259  multiple pages on one sheet 99  multipurpose feeder  loading 79    N   NetWare menu 173   Network 236   Network   x   236   Network   x   menu 167  Network Card menu 170  Network Reports menu 170  network setup page 46  Networking Guide 260   No analog phone line connected to  modem  fax is disabled  237   No answer 237   
229. ing photos    1  2  3  4  5  6  7  8    Place a photo facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner   On the home screen  touch Copy    Touch Options    Touch Content    Touch Photograph    Touch Done    Touch Copy It     Touch Scan the Next Page or Finish the Job     Copying on specialty media    Making transparencies    1    uU A   W N    Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy   Touch Copy from  and then identify the size of the original document     Touch Copy to  and then touch the tray that contains transparencies  or touch Manual Feeder and then place  transparencies in the multipurpose feeder     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 95    6 Touch the desired size of the transparencies  and then touch Continue   7 Touch the arrows until Transparency appears   8 Touch Transparency  and then touch Continue     9 Touch Copy It     Copying to letterhead  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these it
230. ing scan profile OPtions              ccceccceessnceeceeeseeeeeeceeseaceceecesnaececeeeesnaeeeeeeseauaeeeeeeseenaeeseeeeeeaes 128  Quick Setup  socer tendientes Gute itunes UDINE AL E 128  Helme                                                                      129  COMMPFCSSI REL RETINEO LIQUI LL LLLI 129  Default  Coliterit     oio conr tre NE OE tea D E ms 129  eng                                                                                               129  Original SIZE er P                   H       129  ed 129  Sides  Duplex   utet Ite LII MEMINI IUNII MI 129  DarKr8ss arret Eee Yee RAE Ye ER ERE Aa Ta E ND x MTYAREN EAS Aa aa a VAR REN KASER EUER RENE UFER EEEE 130  sce ccencasancsseaacadcvaiaeaaucscevgua tes sacesenaanias sAuacustcetadaanadesiadesaaaucaneataneatecsa etnies caigacadteteeese easter 130  Advanced Ma NE                                                     130  IMPROVING scan quality  3  ite tte aiara a e a EA E SE EOE Se Eee RSEN EUER 130    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 7    Printing a document    arii icio sssassdeedusedessusaisveeveencaesselaoususstseasbersviecectusetoutedensesgclapeleedeness EEE 131  Printing on specialty media  oe teet test estei eio exe teer E HM MM exec Ute ie e ePi estela eee enia 131  Tips onusing letterhead    1  ree edicere etie E erexit aa Eie russa Cue atus rris 131  Tips on using transpareficleS  5        2 cc rere unen ve sa n naiean iE sca EEE AEAEE RR Rao nod aea arse ege a e dug cd Pa CE
231. installed     Single pass is the default setting       Highly confidential information should be wiped using the Multiple pass  method only        Manual Method  Single pass  Multiple pass    Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  from the printer hard disk  All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved   such as downloaded fonts  macros  and held jobs     Both manual and scheduled wiping allow the file system to reuse marked disk space  without first having to wipe it   Notes     This menu item appears only if a formatted  non defective printer hard disk is  installed     Single pass is the default setting       Highly confidential information should be wiped using the Multiple Pass  method only        Scheduled Method  Single pass  Multiple pass       Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  from the printer hard disk  All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved   such as downloaded fonts  macros  and held jobs     Both manual and scheduled wiping allow the file system to reuse marked disk space  without first having to wipe it     Notes       This menu item appears only if a formatted  non defective printer hard disk is  installed     Single pass is the default setting     Highly confidential information should be wiped using the Multiple Pass  method only     Scheduled wipes are initiated without displaying a user warning or       confirmation message   
232. int   If necessary  click the disclosure triangle to see more options   2 From the Print dialog and pop up menus  adjust the settings as needed     Note  To print on a specific paper type  adjust the paper type setting to match the loaded paper  or  select the appropriate tray or feeder     3 Click Print     Printing on specialty media    Tips on using letterhead    Useletterhead designed specifically for laser printers       Print samples on the letterhead being considered for use before buying large quantities       Before loading letterhead  fan the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 132    Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead  For information on how to load letterhead  see          Loading the standard or optional 250 sheet or 550 sheet tray    on page 72         Loading the 2000 sheet tray    on page 75           Loading the multipurpose feeder    on page 79    Tips on using transparencies    Print samples on the transparencies being considered for use before buying large quantities     When printing on transparencies     Feed transparencies from a 250 sheet tray  a 550 sheet tray  or the multipurpose feeder     Use transparencies designed specifically for laser printers  Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure  transparencies are able to withstand temperatures up to 230  C  446  F  without melting  discoloring  offsetting  or  releasing hazardous emissions     Use tran
233. int job     6 Select one of the following     Between Copies    Between Jobs      Between Pages  7 Touch Done   8 Touch Copy It     Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet    In order to save paper  you can copy either two or four consecutive pages of a multiple page document onto a single  sheet of paper     Notes       The Paper Size must be set to Letter  Legal  A4  or B5 JIS     The Copy Size must be set to 100      1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy    Select a duplex setting    Touch Options     Touch Paper Saver     yY Oc Uu A VU N    Select the desired output     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 100    8 Touch Print Page Borders if you want a box drawn around each page of the copies   9 Touch Done     10 Touch Copy It     Creating a custom job  job build     The custom job or job build is used to combine one or more sets of original documents into a single copy job  Each set  may be scanned using different job parameters  When a copy job is submitted and Custom Job is enabled  the scanner  scans the first set of original documents using the supplied parameters  and then it scans the next set wi
234. internal options  Note  This operation requires a flathead screwdriver     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     1 Open the system board door              2 Loosen the screw s  on the system board cover                    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 27    3 Remove the system board cover                                   4 Use the illustration below to locate the appropriate connector     Warning   Potential Damage  System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity   Touch something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors        ii                                                                                 1 Firmware and flash memory card connectors    2  Memory card connector  3   Lexmark Internal Solutions Port or printer hard disk connector  i 4   Fax card connector J       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 28    Installing a memory card  Note  This task requires a flathead screwdriver     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional har
235. ion about fax shortcuts       FTP Shortcuts    Prints a report containing information about FTP shortcuts       Profiles List    Prints a list of profiles stored in the printer       NetWare Setup Page    Prints a report containing NetWare specific information about the network  settings    Note  This menu item appears only for printers with an internal print server  installed           Print Fonts       Prints a report of all the fonts available for the printer language currently set in  the printer          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 167    Menu item Description    Print Directory Prints a list of all the resources stored on an optional flash memory card or printer  hard disk    Notes       Job Buffer Size must be set to 100        The optional flash memory or printer hard disk must be installed correctly  and working properly        Asset Report Prints a report containing asset information including the printer serial number  and model name  The report contains text and UPC barcodes that can be scanned    into an asset database   S    i                Network Ports menu    Active NIC menu       Description    Active NIC Notes   Auto   lt list of available network cards gt       Auto is the factory default setting     This menu item appears only if an optional network card is installed        Standard Network or Network   x   menus    Note  Only active ports appear in this menu  all inactive ports are omitted     Menu item D
236. it  takes to scan  but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document  This  increases the amount of information saved       Color   Sets the scan type and output for the fax  Color documents can be scanned and sent to a fax destination     Sides  Duplex     This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex  printed on one side  or duplex  printed on both  sides   This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the fax     Resolution    This options increases how closely the scanner examines the document you want to fax  If you are faxing a photo  a  drawing with fine lines  or a document with very small text  increase the Resolution setting  This will increase the amount  of time required for the scan and will increase the quality of the fax output       Standard   Suitable for most documents    Fine   Recommended for documents with small print    Super fine   Recommended for original documents with fine detail      Ultra fine   Recommended for documents with pictures or photos    Darkness    This option adjusts how light or dark your faxes will turn out in relation to the original document     Advanced Options  Touching this button opens a screen where you can change Delayed Send  Advanced Imaging  Custom Job  Transmission  Log  Scan Preview  Edge Erase  and Advanced Duplex settings       Delayed Send   Lets you send a fax at a later time or date  After setting up your fax  touch Delayed Send  ent
237. ited States and Canada  For customers outside the U S   refer to the country   specific warranty information that came with your product     This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use  and not for resale  from  Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer  referred to in this statement as    Remarketer        Limited warranty   Lexmark warrants that this product       ls manufactured from new parts  or new and serviceable used parts  which perform like new parts     ls  during normal use  free from defects in material and workmanship    If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period  contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for repair  or replacement  at Lexmark s option      If this product is a feature or option  this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the product  for which it was intended  To obtain warranty service  you may be required to present the feature or option with the  product     If you transfer this product to another user  warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to that user  for the remainder of the warranty period  You should transfer proof of original purchase and this statement to that  user     Limited warranty service    The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12 months later  provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with the printer sh
238. iting into a bin  then pull the paper straight out  and then touch Continue     If not  then continue with step 3    Pull down the output bin door or doors   Remove the jammed paper    Close the output bin door or doors     Touch Continue     280 282 paper jams    1  2  3  4  5    Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam   Pull down the StapleSmart finisher door    Remove the jammed paper    Close the StapleSmart finisher door     Touch Continue     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 148    283 staple jams    1 Touch Status Supplies to identify the location of the jam     2 Press the latch to open the stapler door        3 Pull the latch of the staple cartridge holder down  and then pull the holder out of the printer        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 149    4 Use the metal tab to lift the staple guard  and then remove any loose staples        5 Close the staple guard        6 Press down on the staple guard until it snaps into place        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 150    7 Push the cartridge holder firmly back into the stapler unit until the cartridge holder clicks into place     8 Close the stapler door     290 294 paper jams  1 Remove all original documents from the ADF     2 Open the ADF cover  and then remove any jammed paper        3 Close the ADF cover     4 Open the scanner cover  and then remove any jammed pages                 Downloaded From ManualsP
239. its original wrapper until you use it     Print irregularities       These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     THE PAPER MAY HAVE ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY    Load paper from a fresh package       Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     CHECK THE PAPER    Avoid textured paper with rough finishes     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       283    Troubleshooting 284    THE TONER MAY BE LOW    When 88 Cartridge lowappears or when the print becomes faded  replace the print cartridge     THE FUSER MAY BE WORN OR DEFECTIVE    Replace the fuser     Repeating defects    BS       REPEATING MARKS OCCUR EVENLY DOWN THE PAGE    Replace the charge rolls if the defects occur every 28 3 mm  1 11 in     Replace the transfer roller if the defects occur every 51 7 mm  2 04 in       Replace the print cartridge if the defects occur every     47 8 mm  1 88 in      96 8 mm  3 81 in      Replace the fuser if the defects occur every     88 0 mm  3 46 in      95 2 mm  3 75 in      Skewed print    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the follow
240. jobs     M       Custom Types menu    Menu item Description             Custom Type  lt x gt  Associates a paper or specialty media type with a factory default Custom  Paper Type   x   name or a user defined Custom Name created from the Embedded  Card Stock Web Server or MarkVision Professional  Transparency Notes    Labels      Paper is the factory default setting   Vinyl Labels    The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or  Envelope      gt   multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source   Recycled Specifies a paper type when the Recycled setting is selected in other menus  Paper Notes   Card Stock  Transparency   Paper is the factory default setting   Labels   The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or  Vinyl Labels multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source   Envelope  M A          Custom Names menu    Definition       Custom Name  lt x gt    lt none gt     Specify a custom name for a paper type  This name replaces a Custom Type   lt x gt  name in the printer menus        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 163    Custom Scan Sizes menu    Menu item Description       Custom Scan Size  lt x gt  Specifies a custom scan size name and options  This name replaces a Custom  Scan Size Name Scan Size  lt x gt name inthe printer menus   Width Notes   3 14 17 inches  76 360 mm       8 5 Inches is the US factory default setting for Width  216 millimeters is    Height  8   the inte
241. k Control Panel     Click Hardware and Sound     aoa Oc o    Click Printers     In Windows XP  a Click Start     b Click Printers and Faxes     In Windows 2000  a Click Start   b Click Settings    Printers     Select the printer   Right click the printer  and then select Properties   Click the Install Options tab     Under Available Options  add any installed hardware options     a uu A U N    Click Apply     For Macintosh users    In Mac OS X version 10 5  1 From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   2 Click Print  amp  Fax     3 Select the printer  and then click Options  amp  Supplies     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 48    4 Click Driver  and then add any installed hardware options     5 Click OK     In Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier   1 From the Go menu  choose Applications    2 Double click Utilities  and then double click Print Center or Printer Setup Utility   3 Select the printer  and then from the Printers menu  choose Show Info    4 From the pop up menu  choose Installable Options     5 Add any installed hardware options  and then click Apply Changes   Setting up wireless printing    Information you will need to set up the printer on a wireless network    Note  Do not connect the installation or network cables until prompted to do so by the setup software     SSID   The SSID is also referred to as the network name     Wireless Mode  or Network Mode    The mode will be either infrastructure or ad hoc     Channel  
242. l  recycled paper will feed well     Lexmark consistently tests its printers with recycled paper  20   10096 post consumer waste  and a variety of test paper  from around the world  using chamber tests for different temperature and humidity conditions  Lexmark has found no  reason to discourage the use of today s recycled office papers  but generally the following property guidelines apply  to recycled paper      Low moisture content  4   596       Suitable smoothness  100 200 Sheffield units  or 140   350 Bendtsen units  European     Note  Some much smoother papers  such as premium 24 Ib laser papers  50 90 Sheffield units  and much  rougher papers  such as premium cotton papers  200 300 Sheffield units  have been engineered to work very  well in laser printers  despite surface texture  Before using these types of paper  consult your paper supplier       Suitable sheet to sheet coefficient of friction  0 4   0 6      Sufficient bending resistance in the direction of feed  Recycled paper  paper of lower weight    60 g m   16 Ib bond   and or lower caliper    3 8 mils  0 1 mm    and paper  that is cut grain short for portrait  or short edge  fed printers may have lower bending resistance than is required for  reliable paper feeding  Before using these types of paper for laser  electrophotographic  printing  consult your paper  supplier  Remember that these are general guidelines only and that paper meeting these guidelines may still cause  paper feeding problems in any laser p
243. last successfully scanned page     last successfully scanned page     Touch Scan from Automatic Document Feeder if the page jam recovery is active  Scanning resumes from the ADF  Touch Scan from flatbed if page jam recovery is active  Scanning resumes from the flatbed immediately after the    Touch Finish job without further scanning if page jam recovery is active  The job ends atthe last successfully scanned  page  but the job is not canceled  Successfully scanned pages go to their destination  copy  fax  e mail  or FTP       Touch Restart job if job recovery is active and you are able to restart the job  The message clears  A new scan job    containing the same parameters as the previous job starts     293 02 Flatbed Cover Open    Close the scanner cover     840 01 Scanner Disabled    This message indicates that the scanner has been disabled by the system support person     841 846 Scanner Service Error   1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Check all cable connections    4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Turn the printer back on     If the service message appears again  then contact Customer Support  and report the message     900   999 Service   message     1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Check all cable connections    4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet   5 Turn the printer back on     If the service message appears again  contact Customer Supp
244. le       For the Asia Pacific Region  including Australia and New Zealand                   Print cartridge X651A21P X651A11P       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 256    Lexmark Return Program Regular cartridge  Cartridge                High Yield Print Cartridge X651H21P X651H11P  Extra High Yield Print Cartridge X654X21P X654X11P  High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X651H04P Not applicable  Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications   X654X04P Not applicable       For Latin America                               Print cartridge X651A21L X651A11L  High Yield Print Cartridge X651H21L X651H11L  Extra High Yield Print Cartridge X654X21L X654X11L  High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X651H04L Not applicable   Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications   X654X04L Not applicable       Ordering a maintenance kit    When 80 Routine maintenance needed appears  order a maintenance kit  The maintenance kit contains all  the items necessary to replace the pick rollers  the charge roll  the transfer roller  and the fuser     Notes       Using certain types of paper may require more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit  The charge roll   fuser  pick rollers  and transfer roller can also be individually ordered and replaced as necessary       To check the fuser type  T1 or T2  installed in the printer  remove the print cartridge to
245. les 44    B    Bin Setup menu 164   brightness  adjusting 261   Busy 232   buttons  home screen 19  buttons  printer control panel 18  buttons  touch screen 21    C    cables   Ethernet 44   USB 44  Call complete 232  calling Customer Support 290  canceling a job   from Macintosh 138   from the printer control   panel 137   from Windows 138  card stock   loading 79   tips on using 133  Change   src   to   x   232  charge rolls   ordering 257  Check tray   x   connection 232  checking an unresponsive  printer 264  checking an unresponsive  scanner 270  checking device status   on Embedded Web Server 260  cleaning   exterior of the printer 251   scanner glass 251  Close door or insert cartridge 233  Close finisher side door 233  collating copies 98  Confidential print jobs 134   printing from Macintosh   computer 135   printing from Windows 135   Confidential Print menu 181    Index    configuration information  wireless network 48  configurations  printer 15  Configure MP menu 156  configuring  port settings 56  configuring the e mail settings 107  Connect  lt x gt bps 233  connecting fax  using RJ11 adapter 61  connecting the printer to  answering machine 66  computer modem 68  telephone 65  telephone wall jack in  Germany 64  conserving supplies 254  contacting Customer Support 290  control panel  printer 18  copy quality  adjusting 98  improving 105  copy screen  options 102  103  104  Copy Settings menu 192  copy troubleshooting  copier does not respond 268  partial docume
246. lighter Toner Darkness setting     From the printer control panel  change the setting from the Quality menu     For Windows users  change the setting from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  change the setting from the Print dialog     Incorrect margins       These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE PAPER GUIDES    Move the guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded     CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING    Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray     1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct size setting     For Windows users  specify the size from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the size from the Page Setup dialog     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       282    Troubleshooting    Paper curl    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING    Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray     1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     THE PAPER HAS ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY    Load paper from a fresh package       Store paper in 
247. limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts  or do not allow the exclusion or limitation  of incidental or consequential damages  so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not apply to you     This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights  You may also have other rights that vary from state to state     LEXMARK SOFTWARE LIMITED WARRANTY AND LICENSE AGREEMENT    PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE USING THIS PRODUCT  This License Agreement   Software License Agreement   is a  legal agreement between you  either an individual or a single entity  and Lexmark International  Inc    Lexmark   that   to the extent your Lexmark product or Software Program is not otherwise subject to a written software license  agreement between you and Lexmark or its suppliers  governs your use of any Software Program installed on or provided  by Lexmark for use in connection with your Lexmark product  The term  Software Program  includes machine readable  instructions  audio visual content  such as images and recordings   and associated media  printed materials and  electronic documentation  whether incorporated into  distributed with or for use with your Lexmark product     BY USING THIS PRODUCT  YOU AGREE TO BE BOUND BY ALL THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THIS SOFTWARE LIMITED  WARRANTY AND LICENSE AGREEMENT  IF YOU DO NOT AGREE WITH THE TERMS OF THIS SOFTWARE LIMITED  WARRANTY AND LICENSE AGREEMENT  PROMPTLY RETURN THE PRODUCT UNUSED AND REQUEST A REFUND OF THE  AMOUNT YOU PAID  IF 
248. line as a normal telephone line  Then set up the printer wherever  your telephone is located to make copies or to send and receive faxes without using a computer     Note  Setup steps may vary depending on your country or region     1 Make sure you have the following     Atelephone    Two telephone cords      Atelephone wall jack    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 66    2 Connect one telephone cord to the LINE port 4  of the printer  and then plug it into an active telephone wall jack        Connecting to an answering machine  Connect an answering machine to the printer to receive both incoming voice messages and faxes   Note  Setup steps may vary depending on your country or region     1 Make sure you have the following     Atelephone    Ananswering machine    Three telephone cords      Atelephone wall jack    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 67    2 Connect one telephone cord into the LINE port    of the printer  and then plug it into an active telephone wall jack        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 68    Connecting to a computer with a modem  Connect the printer to a computer with a modem to send faxes from the software program   Note  Setup steps may vary depending on your country or region     1 Make sure you have the following     Atelephone    A computer with a modem    Three telephone cords      Atelephone wall jack    2 Connect a telephone c
249. lp you solve print quality problems  If these suggestions still do not  correct the problem  contact Customer Support  You may have a printer part that requires adjustment or replacement     Isolating print quality problems   To help isolate print quality problems  print the print quality test pages   1 Turn the printer off   2 Load Letter  or A4 size paper in the tray   3 Hold down and while turning the printer on     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 280    4 Release the buttons when the screen with the progress bar appears     The printer performs a power on sequence  and then the Configuration menu appears   5 Touch the down arrow until Print Quality Pages appears     6 Touch Print Quality Pages   The print quality test pages print   7 Touch Back     8 Touch Exit Configuration     Blank pages    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     PACKING MATERIAL MAY BE ON THE PRINT CARTRIDGE    Remove the print cartridge and make sure the packing material is properly removed  Reinstall the print cartridge     THE TONER MAY BE LOW    When 88 Cartridge low appears  order a new print cartridge     If the problem continues  the printer may need to be serviced  For more information  contact Customer Support     Characters have jagged or uneven edges    N  ABC  Der    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE PRINT QUALITY SETTINGS    Change the Print Resolution setting in the Quality menu to 600 
250. ls  about printed pages       Network Setup Page    Prints a report containing information about the network printer settings  such  as the TCP IP address information    Note  This menu item appears only for network printers or printers connected  to print servers        Network  lt x gt  Setup Page    Prints a report containing information about the network printer settings  such  as the TCP IP address information    Notes     This menu item is available when more than one network option is  installed       This menu item appears only for network printers or printers connected to  print servers        Wireless Setup Page    Prints a report containing information about the wireless network printer  settings  such as the TCP IP address information    Notes     This menu item is available when a wireless card is installed and Lexmark  Document Solutions Suite is enabled       This menu item appears only for network printers or printers connected to  print servers        Shortcut List    Prints a report containing information about configured shortcuts             Fax Job Log Prints a report containing information about the last 200 completed faxes   Fax Call Log Prints a report containing information about the last 100 attempted  received   and blocked calls   Copy Shortcuts Prints a report containing information about copy shortcuts       E mail Shortcuts    Prints a report containing information about e mail shortcuts       Fax Shortcuts    Prints a report containing informat
251. lt setting     5 reduces the file size  but the quality of the image is lessened     90 provides the best image quality  but the file size is very large       This menu item applies to all scan functions        Use Multi Page TIFF  On  Off       Provides a choice between single page TIFF files and multiple page TIFF files  For a  multiple page scan to FTP job  either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages   or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job     Notes       Onisthe factory default setting       This menu item applies to all scan functions           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer menus 213                                     Menu item Description  Transmission Log Specifies whether the transmission log prints  Print log Note     Print log    is the factory default setting   Do not print log  Print only for error  Log Paper Source Specifies a paper source for FTP logs  Tray  lt x gt  Note  Tray 1 is the factory default setting   Manual Feeder  Manual Env  MP Feeder  Log Output Bin Specifies an output bin for the FTP log  Standard Bin  Bin  lt x gt   FTP bit Depth Enables the Text Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1 bit images when  8 bit Color is set to Off  1 bit Note  8 bit is the factory default setting   Base File Name Lets you enter a base file name  Custom Job Scanning Lets you copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single job  On  Off  Scan Preview Sp
252. magazine articles  business graphics  and  brochures        When should I use Printed   Use Printed Image mode when copying halftone photographs  graphics such as documents                Image mode  printed on a laser printer  or pages from a magazine or newspaper  When should   use Use Photograph mode when the original document is a high quality photograph or inkjet  Photograph mode  print        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing    E mailing       X       ADF          Use the ADF for multiple page documents    Use the scanner glass for single pages  small items  such as postcards or    photos   transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings         106    Scanner glass       ed       You can use the printer to e mail scanned documents to one or more recipients  There are three ways to send an e mail  from the printer  You can type the e mail address  use a shortcut number  or use the address book     Getting ready to e mail    Setting up the e mail function    For e mail to operate  it must be turned on in the printer configuration and have a valid IP address or gateway address   To set up the e mail function     1    yY OAU A W N    Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     Click Settings    Under Default Settings  click E mail FTP Settings   Click E m
253. makes a grayscale or color  image printable by transforming it to a pattern of small spots with a limited  number of colors       Text emphasizes sharp  black  high resolution text against a clean  white  background        Sides  Duplex   1 sided to 1 sided  1 sided to 2 sided  2 sided to 1 sided  2 sided to 2 sided       r    Specifies whether an original document is duplex  two sided  or simplex  one sided    and then specifies whether the copy should be duplex or simplex    Notes       1 sided to 1 sided   The original page has printing on one side  The copied  page will have printing on one side       1 sided to 2 sided   The original page has printing on one side  The copied  page will have printing on both sides  For example  if the original is six sheets   the copy is three sheets with printing on both sides       2 sided to 1 sided   The original page has printing on both sides  The copied  page will have printing on only one side  For example  if the original draft is  three sheets of paper with an image on each side of each sheet  then the copy  is six sheets with only one image on one side of each sheet       2 sided to 2 sided   The original page has printing on both sides  The copy  mimics the original exactly           Mh       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 193    Menu item Description    Paper Saver Sets two or four sheets of an original document together on the same page  Off Note  Off is the factory default setti
254. ments are still SCANNING              ccccccssceceesssssseeescesseaeeeesssseeeesessase essre 118  Canceling a fax after the original documents have been scanned to MEMOLSY            ccccssesseceeesesssseeescessneaees 118   Understanding fax  optiOrs         reote citro ore aa enit bete sede ax ae ee euo E E eee eiae UR deae koe Ege 118  Snc                                                        ai 118  COMMON e                                   M 118  Sides  Duplex   cette uie eee E E IM MM Md 119  acre                                                                    E 119  DIKMESS PEE EODD TU DID CDD UU LLLI DLL ET 119  Advanced ODtIONnS  aire rerit ae Son IDs cp teorie lastre petente duci E stupid lusu ve ond Aa Ponce duen deme pin Gages eed 119    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 6    Improving TAX quality    eus ioter esee een tane aeuo ated a e e aa eaea a aa aen aE Kaaa EA Eaa 120  Holding and forwarding fAaxes          c cccccesesseeceesssenseeceeseseaeeceeseaaeeeceeeaeeeceeseeeseeeeeesesneeeseeseeneeesaeeeeeeseaes 120  Holding fase 120  Forwarding di laK ener E MM EE MEIN M E Loi 121    Scanning to an FTP address                           eee e eee eee eee eee eee eee eee ese esee sess 12 2     SCaNMINg rex ustlbar pror coL 122  Scanning to an FTP address using the keypad              cssccccccsssssscccscessseaeecessessseeeccssseeeecessssuseeeceseaeseeeseueessaaaaes 122  Scanning to an FTP address using a shortcut number                   e
255. message  make sure the link buffers are set to Auto  and then exit the  menus to activate the link buffer changes  When Ready appears  enable Resource Save       Install additional memory     37 Insufficient memory to collate job    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to print the portion of the job already stored and begin collating the rest of the print job       Cancel the current print job     37 Insufficient memory for Flash Memory Defragment operation    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to stop the defragment operation and continue printing     Delete fonts  macros  and other data in printer memory        nstall additional printer memory     37 Insufficient memory  some Held Jobs were deleted    The printer deleted some held jobs in order to process current jobs     Touch Continue to clear the message     37 Insufficient memory  some held jobs will not be restored  The printer was unable to restore some or all of the confidential or held jobs on the printer hard disk     Touch Continue to clear the message     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 243    38 Memory full    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message     Cancel the current print job        nstall additional printer memory     39 Complex page  some data may not have printed    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing     Cancel the current print job
256. moval   Adjusts the white portion of the output  Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease  the white portion         Color Dropout   Color dropout is used for form Optical Character Recognition  OCR  processing  Selecting a  color eliminates the color from a form  enabling improved OCR capabilities         Contrast   Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the contrast        JPEG Quality   Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the image compression       Mirror Image   Select this box to create a mirror image scan        Negative Image    Select this box to create a negative image scan         Shadow Detail    Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the visible detail in the shadows     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to an FTP address 126        Scan edge to edge   Select this box to scan edge to edge       Sharpness   Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the sharpness      Custom Job  Job Build    Combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job     Transmission Log    Prints the transmission log or transmission error log     ScanPreview    Displays the first page of an image before itis included in the FTP file  When the first page is scanned   the scanning is paused and a preview image appears       Edge Erase   Eliminates smudges or information around the edges of a document  You can choose to eliminate an  equal area around all four sides of the paper  or pick a particular edge  Edge Erase will eras
257. mponents or connectors     1 Access the system board        2 Unpack the printer hard disk        Note  Avoid touching the components on the card     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 39    3 Locate the appropriate connector on the system board                                            Note  If an optional ISP is currently installed  then the printer hard disk must be installed onto the ISP     To install a printer hard disk onto the ISP     a Using a flathead screwdriver to loosen the screws  remove the thumbscrews that attach the printer hard disk  mounting bracket to the printer hard disk  and then remove the bracket        b Align the standoffs of the printer hard disk with the holes in the ISP  and then press downward on the printer  hard disk until the standoffs have seated into place     IL                Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 40    C Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the ISP     Note  The plugs and receptacles are color coded              To install a printer hard disk directly onto the system board     a Align the standoffs of the printer hard disk with the holes in the system board  and then press downward on  the printer hard disk until the standoffs have seated into place     LL                              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 41    b Attach the two provided screws to secure
258. ms      XPS   Creates a single XML Paper Specification  XPS  file with multiple pages  viewable using an Internet  Explorer hosted viewer and the  NET Framework  or by downloading a third party standalone viewer    7 Touch E mail It     Note  If you selected Encrypted PDF  then enter your password twice     Canceling an e mail      When using the ADF  touch Cancel Job while Scanning   appears       When using the scanner glass  touch Cancel Job while Scanning    appears or while Scan the Next Page   Finish the Job appears     Understanding e mail options    Original Size    This option opens a screen where you can choose the size of the documents you are going to e mail       Touch a paper size button to select that size as the Original Size setting  The e mail screen appears with your new  setting displayed       When  Original Size  is set to Mixed Letter Legal  you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper  sizes       When  Original Size  is set to Auto Size Sense  the scanner automatically determines the size of the original  document     Sides  Duplex     This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex  printed on one side  or duplex  printed on both  sides   This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the e mail     Orientation    This option tells the printer whether the original documentis in portrait or landscape orientation and then changes the  Sides and Binding settings to match the original document orie
259. n tere d Fecerunt DE aaa aae Deed gua euh 278  Paper frequently jars    tec re rre E ERE RE CREER HE a Ra Aa a a R AA a aara 278  Paper jam message remains after jam is cleared                    sesssssssssssesssessesee eene enne nennen nne rennen nns 279  Page that jammed does not reprint after you clear the jam                     esses eene nennen ens 279   Solving print quality problems                   ssssssssseseseeeeeeeene nennen EEEE EN iE nennen 279  Isolating print quality problems    o e aec nia tei cagaasa RETRO NER AER a RYE ERI CAEN RR OO YA and 279  Blain a Bes   eite battu ett con te met LI de tette 280  Characters have jagged or uneven edges          c ccccccsssssseeceeesssssuecesceesssaeeccueceeseseeesuesesessususeeeeeseaeaeeaeeeeessaaaaes 280  Clipped images    ertet tese catt etnia aka eL aad RE Un Ra RR E E EEEa E eR TRAE RE SR ER VU Cu RYE Xn Eo eR ED RR 281  Cleo iE T ETOILE OL a E E 281  Gray lleri ciim                                               282  lricorrect matgitisi i oec etes emere Enero REN RIDE OPERAR ead ania NR ERE EEEa RR ERRARE NR E o CAR x RR RR ERE RES Dag CER ets 282   Lie dL aa a e eaa a E eaa aap a eiaa a aR eaa EE in 283  AAE O EE E A E tee A E A A E E E E E A 283  Repeating defects  cesicecescecesz se atecatgenbadvalasssaseessenadeecicansesanas ddaaedsielensacaasayeledanvsadetegdiacdotadiaes Seo S RR RI SER DRE TR RE CAE NC 284  Skewed DEDE  icem corteo peti Pede dto ic Pede qua Dr er eere ua S UD GL aed ds Da RR Qa Cea pupa Eg
260. n timeout  specifies how long the printer remains idle on the Home  screen before automatically logging the user off  Settings range from 1 900  seconds  300 seconds is the factory default setting        Remote Logins  Login failures  Failure time frame  Lockout time  Login timeout          Limits the number and time frames of failed login attempts from a computer before  all remote users are locked out    Notes        Login failures  specifies the number of failed login attempts before users are  locked out  Settings range from 1   50  3 attempts is the factory default setting        Failure time frame  specifies the time frame during which failed login  attempts can be made before users are locked out  Settings range from 1   60  minutes  5 minutes is the factory default setting          Lockout time  specifies how long a user is locked out after exceeding the  login failures limit  Settings range from 0   60 minutes  5 minutes is the factory  default setting  O indicates the printer does not impose a lockout time        Login timeout  specifies how long the remote interface remains idle before  automatically logging the user off  Settings range from 1   900 seconds  300  seconds is the factory default setting           Confidential Print menu       Menu item    Max Invalid PIN  Off  2 10       Description    Limits the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered  Notes     e Off is the default setting     This menu item appears only if a printer hard disk is installed   
261. nal Lexmark Internal Solutions Port  ISP   Install an ISP for additional connectivity  options     Note  This operation requires a flathead screwdriver     A CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     Warning   Potential Damage  System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity  Touch  something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors     1 Access the system board              2 Unpack the ISP and plastic tee   Note  Avoid touching the components on the card     3 Locate the appropriate connector on the system board     LL                          l  ai M     a     XD a                               Note  If an optional printer hard disk is currently installed  then the printer hard disk must first be removed  To  remove the hard disk     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 33    a Unplug the printer hard disk interface cable from the system board  leaving the cable attached to the printer  hard disk  To unplug the cable  squeeze the paddle at the plug of the interface cable to disengage the latch  before pulling the cable out        
262. nd MarkVision are trademarks of Lexmark International  Inc    registered in the United States and or other countries     MarkTrack  PrintCryption  and StapleSmart are trademarks of Lexmark International  Inc     PCL  is a registered trademark of the Hewlett Packard Company  PCL is Hewlett Packard Company s designation of a  set of printer commands  language  and functions included in its printer products  This printer is intended to be  compatible with the PCL language  This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used in various application  programs  and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands     The following terms are trademarks or registered trademarks of these companies                       Albertus The Monotype Corporation plc    Antique Olive Monsieur Marcel OLIVE   Apple Chancery Apple Computer  Inc    Arial The Monotype Corporation plc   CG Times Based on Times New Roman under license from The Monotype Corporation plc  is a product of    Agfa Corporation                         Chicago Apple Computer  Inc    Clarendon Linotype Hell AG and or its subsidiaries  Eurostile Nebiolo   Geneva Apple Computer  Inc    GillSans The Monotype Corporation plc  Helvetica Linotype Hell AG and or its subsidiaries  Hoefler Jonathan Hoefler Type Foundry       ITC Avant Garde Gothic   International Typeface Corporation                                                    ITC Bookman International Typeface Corporation   ITC Mona Lisa International Typefac
263. nd feeder assignments to the factory default settings  Restore Defaults  Yes  No                Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus          229                            HTML menu  Menu item Description  Font Name Intl CG Times Sets the default font for HTML documents  Albertus MT Intl Courier Notes   Antique Olive Intl Univers  Apple Chancery Joanna MT   The Times font will be used in HTML documents that do not specify a  Arial MT Letter Gothic Tent  Avant Garde Lubalin Gothic e The following fonts appear only if the appropriate DBCS font card is      installed  HG GothicB  MSung Light  MD DotumChe  and MingMT   Bodoni Marigold Light   Bookman Monalisa Recut  Chicago Monaco  Clarendon New CenturySbk  Cooper Black New York  Copperplate Optima  Coronet Oxford  Courier Palatino  Eurostile StempelGaramond  Garamond Taffy  Geneva Times  Gill Sans TimesNewRoman  Goudy Univers  Helvetica Zapf Chancery  Hoefler Text  X a  Menu item Description  Font Size Sets the default font size for HTML documents  1 255 pt Notes     12 ptis the factory default setting     Font size can be increased in 1 point increments   Scale Scales the default font for HTML documents  1 400  Notes     100  is the factory default setting     Scaling can be increased in 1  increments   Orientation Sets the page orientation for HTML documents  Portrait Note  Portrait is the factory default setting   Landscape  Margin Size Sets the page margin for HTML documents  8 255 mm
264. nd letterhead             ce eececeeessceeesnceeeneceeeeneeeeaeeeeeaeceeeaeeeceeaecessaeeceseaeeeseceaaeeseeaeenes 87  Using recycled paper and other office papers    sees eene enne nennen nnne nens entree tenerte nnne 88  Seer lem cM EID 88   Supported paper sizes  types  and weights    eene e nennen ens 89  Paper sizes supported by the pririter             creed cip idea i debris poe EE RR EEEE ESEE SEN ERRARE RR 89  Paper types and weights supported by the printer                   eese nennen enne nenne nennen 90  Paper types and weights supported by the finisher               ccccccssssscceessessscececeeseseeeecessueceeseseaseeesesesssaeaeeeeeeees 91    alot mee eR                                    M  gt     Making COPIES TC IEEE DEO LT 93  MIELInezpoioi u euo                                                   EREE 93  Copying using the ADP e              93  Copying using the scanner glass              2 e ni aaia deed cM aa FERA RR AR UG LX YR RR E eu EATER ERR EE 94   COPYING PROTOS eR 94   Copying on specialty media    ccs ckcdeseenncvessdetodessowastendoueneatesssbanceaguodeadesseseadeboenati eusededoanacuionsesencedees 94    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Contents 4    Making transparencies seesinane iae a Sd AT da Ego iR eds so ERE PEU XY de ERE a iiaii 94  Copying to  uir                             95  G  stomizing Copy Setting Sensasi                                            95  Copying from one size to another                  esses enne ne
265. nditions of this Software License Agreement  all or any portion of  the Software Program that constitutes software provided under public license by third parties   Freeware   is  licensed to you subject to the terms and conditions of the software license agreement accompanying such  Freeware  whether in the form of a discrete agreement  shrink wrap license  or electronic license terms at the  time of download or installation  Use of the Freeware by you shall be governed entirely by the terms and  conditions of such license     6 TRANSFER  You may transfer the Software Program to another end user  Any transfer must include all software  components  media  printed materials  and this Software License Agreement and you may not retain copies of the  Software Program or components thereof  The transfer may not be an indirect transfer  such as a consignment   Prior to the transfer  the end user receiving the transferred Software Program must agree to all these Software  License Agreement terms  Upon transfer of the Software Program  your license is automatically terminated  You    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 306    10    11    12    13    14    15    16    17    18    19    may not rent  sublicense  or assign the Software Program except to the extent provided in this Software License  Agreement     UPGRADES  To Use a Software Program identified as an upgrade  you must first be licensed to the original Software  Program identified by Lexmark as eligible 
266. ne or more of the following     Turn the printer off and then back on   If the error occurs a second time   1 Turn the printer off   Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet   Remove the specified bins     Reattach the bins     uU FB WN    Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet   6 Restart the printer    If the error occurs again    1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Remove the specified bins    4 Contact Customer Support       Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the specified bins     Reattach envelope feeder    Try one or more of the following     Turn the printer off and then back on   If the error occurs a second time   1 Turn the printer off   Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet   Remove the envelope feeder     Reattach the envelope feeder     uU B U N    Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet   6 Restart the printer    If the error occurs again    1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Remove the envelope feeder     4 Contact Customer Support       Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the envelope feeder     Receive complete    The printer has received an entire fax job  Wait for the message to clear     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       238    Understanding printer messages 239    Receiving page  lt n gt     The printer receives page  lt n gt  of the fax job  where  lt n gt  is the number of the
267. nen nian 252  Storing SUPPI S serie IRI                                   253  Conserving SUpplles    ioci ee dt te RR ER EE ERR ER EE aE E exe EEEE RER ES 254  Checking the Status of supplies    cereo toto ene e te erae on eo ehe rene ee Ron aye ee ERR EEEa 254  Checking the status of supplies from the printer control panel              cceecessccccesesceeeecesseseeeesseseeeeseeseeeeaes 254  Checking the status of supplies from a network computer    enne nennen nennen 254  Ordering  SUP PINES a5 1 9  cerei POE Ier deti eetecri oe e e ee 255  Ordering print cartridges                  can des sna easi paced pe saa gati me asa pa oa pmi Saa sa REDE E aae A ORDER PRA REOR a desi 255  Ordering a maintenance Kiteeseen ern a a E AAE EA EE a a a E EAEE EREE dai 256  Ordering a TUSEM os cire a a LR Roe aa a Ea E ia RARE en do REEE EEEE 256  Ordering an ADF maintenance Kit            cccccccssssccecesssesseeeceessneseecescessssesecesesssseescsessececesseusaseeeseseasussueeeseeseaaaaes 257  Ordering  a transfer roller    rm e a aa aE a E AE EEE E A EEE AEEA RA EO EE EEEN aE Eai 257  Ordering  charge TONS sssri d cr c eei e a e e E o ERE UL EE E EEE aED EEEE EE 257  Ordering pick Follets            rte prt te eventi bas cedere RIO is aa e aaa a AE PE xpo been do aa Rea dcn Ed Ce daa REIR dada 257  Ordering ADF replacement parts    c rte rore decer Ee eae Vous at e EY ER e Ce eve E Un lecuecevocdnassccensavevesdtves 257  Ordering staple cartridges                 cnet cerei Eaa aa EE n 
268. ng   2 on 1 Portrait  2 on 1 Landscape  4 on 1 Portrait  4 on 1 Landscape       Print Page Borders Specifies whether a border is printed around the edge of the page at the margins    On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off       Collate Keeps the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when making multiple copies of  On the job    Off Note  On is the factory default setting        Staple Enables stapling    On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off       Original Size Specifies the paper size of the original document  Letter  Legal  Executive  Folio  Statement  Universal  4x 6in   3x 5in   Business Card  Custom Scan Size  lt x gt   A4  AS  Oficio  Mexico   A6  JIS BS  Book Original  Auto Size Sense  Mixed Letter Legal       Copy To Source Specifies the paper source for copy jobs  Tray  lt x gt  Note  Tray 1 is the factory default setting   Single Sheet Feeder  Multi Sheet Feeder  Auto Size Match                Transparency Separators Places a sheet of paper between transparencies  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       Menu item    Separator Sheets  None  Between Copies  Between Jobs  Between Pages    194    Description    Places a sheet of paper between pages  copies  or jobs based on the value selected    Note  None is the factory default setting        Separator Source  Tray  lt x gt   Manual Feeder  Envelope Feeder    Specifies a paper source          Darkn
269. ng rights provided you comply with all terms and conditions of this  Software License Agreement     a Use You may Use one  1  copy of the Software Program  The term  Use  means storing  loading  installing   executing  or displaying the Software Program  If Lexmark has licensed the Software Program to you for  concurrent use  you must limit the number of authorized users to the number specified in your agreement with  Lexmark  You may not separate the components of the Software Program for use on more than one computer   You agree that you will not Use the Software Program  in whole or in part  in any manner that has the effect of  overriding  modifying  eliminating  obscuring  altering or de emphasizing the visual appearance of any  trademark  trade name  trade dress or intellectual property notice that appears on any computer display screens  normally generated by  or as a result of  the Software Program     b Copying  You may make one  1  copy of the Software Program solely for purposes of backup  archiving  or  installation  provided the copy contains all of the original Software Program s proprietary notices  You may not  copy the Software Program to any public or distributed network     c Reservation of Rights  The Software Program  including all fonts  is copyrighted and owned by Lexmark  International  Inc  and or its suppliers  Lexmark reserves all rights not expressly granted to you in this Software  License Agreement     d Freeware  Notwithstanding the terms and co
270. nized USB hub     USB USB  lt x gt     The printer is using a USB cable connection  The USB port is the active communication link     Waiting for redial    The printer is waiting to redial the fax number  Wait for the message to clear     30 Invalid refill  change cartridge    Remove the print cartridge  and then install a supported one     31 Replace defective cartridge    Remove the defective print cartridge  and then install a new one     32 Cartridge part number unsupported by device    Remove the print cartridge  and then install a supported one     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 242    34 Short paper    Try one or more of the following     Load the appropriate paper or other specialty media in the proper tray     Touch Continue to clear the message and print the job using a different paper tray       Check tray length and width guides and make sure the paper is properly loaded in the tray     Check the Print Properties or Print dialog settings to make sure the print job is requesting the correct paper size  and type     Check that the paper size is correctly set  For example  if the MP Feeder Size is set to Universal  make sure the paper  is large enough for the data being printed     Cancel the current print job     35 Insufficient memory to support Resource Save feature    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to disable Resource Save and continue printing       Toenable Resource Save after receiving this 
271. nnen nnne nennen nnntnn snis inet nasi risen serias sre nnns annus 95  Making copies using paper from a selected tray                       esses enne nennen nnne nn nnns nenne 96  Copying a document that contains mixed paper sizes                  ssssesssssseseeee eene enne nennen nennen nnne rennen 96  Copying on both sides of the paper  duplexing                     eeseesessessseeseeseee nennen nnne nnne enn nnne nnn nnn 97  Reducing or enlarging copies    ie deperit tree lr guides regi HasuE drea res kisses a rr bea ems uaria gs 97  Adjusting COPY deii                                                              98  Collating  Copies    estie ce ertt aea cane ERA EY shade Red EORR XE NR R SERA E Ee HERE LER e RO NR M La Ro REIR e NY a Eaa 98  Placing separator sheets between copies    seen nennen enne ennennn nai nn rini nn se ense n enean nennen 99  Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet   0 0    ccessccccsssssnseceecsesseececeesseeecesucsseeeeeesessaseeesceeeaseseeaeeeesesssaeeees 99  Creating    c  stom job  job b  ild           iecit tees tnter eie EE VERE CERE et Rua EE AE Yide iR tied Va Edad 100  Job interrupt    reiecit eoe ete ices dean ei eei EE Eu Feu aUe EE a a E E YR de de La exe vE Su Secure ae Yee a 101  Placing information on COPICS             ccceceseeeceeceeeeeeceeceseaeceeecsseneceeceseeeceseeseseeeeeeesaeeceeeeseeesesseeeaeaaeeseeenees 101  Placing the date and time at the top of each page          ccesscccccssssssseceecseseceeeescsssseeeccesssa
272. nt or photo  copies 270  poor copy quality 268  poor scanned image quality 271  scanner unit does not close 268  copying  adding a date and time stamp 101  adding an overlay message 101  adjusting quality 98  canceling a copy job 102  collating copies 98  custom job  job build  100  document containing mixed paper  sizes 96  enlarging 97  from one size to another 95  improving copy quality 105  making transparencies 94  multiple pages on one sheet 99  on both sides of the paper   duplexing  97  photos 94  placing separator sheets between  copies 99    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       quick copy 93   reducing 97   selecting a tray 96   to letterhead 95   using the ADF 93   using the scanner glass    flatbed  94   Custom Bin Names menu 163  Custom Names menu 162  custom paper type   assigning 84  Custom Scan Sizes menu 163  Custom Type   x     changing name 84  Custom Types menu 162    D    date and time  setting 70  Default Source menu 153  Dialing 233  directory list  printing 137  Disk corrupted 233  Disk Full   Scan Job Canceled 233  Disk Wiping menu 182  display troubleshooting  display is blank 264  display shows only diamonds 264  display  printer control panel 18  adjusting brightness 261  documents  printing  from Macintosh 131  from Windows 131  duplexing 97    E  Embedded Web Server 260  administrator settings 260  checking device status 260  does not open 290  networking settings 260  setting up e mail alerts 260  Embedded Web Server  Administrator s
273. ntation     Binding    Tells the printer whether the original document is bound on the long edge or short edge side     E mail Subject    This option lets you enter a subject line for your e mail  You can enter up to 255 characters     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing 111    E mail File Name    This option lets you customize the attachment file name     E mail Message    This option lets you enter a message that will be sent with your scanned attachment     Resolution    Adjusts the output quality of your e mail  Increasing the image resolution increases the e mail file size and the time  needed to scan your original document  Image resolution can be decreased to reduce the e mail file size     Send As    This option sets the output  PDF  TIFF  JPEG or XPS  for the scanned image       PDF   Creates a single file with multiple pages  viewable with Adobe Reader  Adobe Reader is provided free by  Adobe at www adobe com     Secure PDF   Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access      TIFF   Creates multiple files or a single file  If Multi page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  Web Server  then TIFF saves one page in each file  The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG       JPEG   Creates and attaches a separate file for each page of your original document  viewable by most Web browsers  and graphics programs    e XPS   Creates a single XPS file with multiple pages  viewabl
274. nter system board  Network   lt x gt  indicates that an internal print server is installed inside the printer or that the printer is connected to an external  print server     No analog phone line connected to modem  fax is disabled     The printer is not detecting an analog phone line  so the fax is disabled  Connect the printer to an analog phone line     No answer    A fax number is dialed  but no connection is made  Wait for the message to clear     No dial tone    The printer does not have a dial tone  Wait for the message to clear     Queued for sending    The scanning process of a fax job completed  but the job is not sent yet because another fax job is being sent or received   Wait for the message to clear     Ready    The printer is ready to receive print jobs     Reattach bin  lt x gt     Try one or more of the following     Turn the printer off and then back on   If the error occurs a second time   1 Turn the printer off   Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet   Remove the specified bin     Reattach the bin     Uu A WN    Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet   6 Restart the printer    If the error occurs again    1 Turn the printer off    2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet    3 Remove the specified bin    4 Contact Customer Support       Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the specified bin     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages    Reattach bin   x       y      Try o
275. nterchangeable     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  devices sometime after setting up the printer  then turn the printer off  and unplug the power cord from the  wall outlet before continuing  If you have any other devices attached to the printer  then turn them off as well   and unplug any cables going into the printer     Warning   Potential Damage  System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity  Touch  something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors     1 Access the system board                          2 Unpack the card   Note  Avoid touching any electrical components on the card   3 Holding the card by its sides  align the plastic pins on the card with the holes on the system board   1    6          Plastic pins          N  e    Metal pins         Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup    4 Push the card firmly into place        Notes     The entire length of the connector on the card must touch and be flush against the system board       Be careful not to damage the connectors     5 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door        TII                             a  y                                        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       31    Additional printer setup 32    Installing an Internal Solutions Port    The system board supports one optio
276. nu item  Max Speed  2400  4800  9600  14400  33600    203    Description    Specifies the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are received       Fax Forwarding  Forward  Print  Print and Forward    Enables forwarding of received faxes to another recipient       Forward to  Fax  E mail  FTP  LDSS  eSF    Specifies the type of recipient to which faxes will be forwarded    Note  This item is available only from the printer Embedded Web Server        Forward to Shortcut    Lets you enter the shortcut number which matches the recipient type  Fax  E mail   FPT  LDSS  or eSF        Block No Name Fax  On  Off    Enables blocking of incoming faxes sent from devices with no station ID specified       Banned Fax List    Enables the list of banned fax numbers stored in the printer       Holding Faxes  Held Fax Mode  Off  Always On  Manual  Scheduled  Fax Holding Schedule    Enables fax holding all of the time or according to a set schedule    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Staple  On  Off       S    Specifies the default staple setting for the attached finisher    Note  Only the settings associated with the installed finisher appear              Fax Log Settings    Menu item    Transmission Log  Print log  Do not print log  Print only for error    Description    Enables printing of a transmission log after each fax job          Receive Error Log  Print Never       Print on Error    Enables printing of a receive error log following a receive error             Downloaded 
277. o  scan  but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document  This increases the  amount of information saved     Color    This option tells the printer the color of the original documents  You can select Gray  BW  Black and White   or Color     Original Size    This option sets the size of the documents you are going to scan  When Original Size is set to Mixed Sizes  you can scan  an original document that contains mixed paper sizes  letter  and legal size pages      Orientation    This option tells the printer whether the original document is in portrait or landscape orientation and then changes the  Sides and Binding settings to match the original document orientation     Sides  Duplex     This option informs the printer if your original document is simplex  printed on one side  or duplex  printed on both  sides   This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the document     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to a computer or flash drive 130    Darkness    This option adjusts how light or dark your scanned documents will turn out in relation to the original document     Resolution    This option adjusts the output quality of your file  Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the time  needed to scan your original document  Image resolution can be decreased to reduce the file size     Advanced Imaging  This option lets you adjust Background Removal  Contrast  Shadow Deta
278. o paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides     3 On the home screen  touch Fax     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 116    4 Touch Search Address Book     uw    Using the virtual keyboard  type the name or part of the name of the person whose fax number you want to find    Do not attempt to search for multiple names at the same time      Touch Search   Touch the name to add it to the    Fax to    list     Repeat steps 4 through 7 to enter additional addresses     O on Q    Touch Fax It     Customizing fax settings    Changing the fax resolution    Adjusting the resolution setting changes the quality of the fax  Settings range from Standard  fastest speed  to Ultra  Fine  slowest speed  best quality      1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Fax    Use the keypad to enter the fax number    Touch Options     From the Resolution area  touch the arrows to change to the resolution you want     Nn Oo uU A VU N    Touch Fax It     Making a fax lighter or darker  1 Load an original 
279. o verify printer options are installed correctly     Note  If you have not made any menu item settings changes yet  then the menu settings page lists all the factory  default settings  Once you select and save other settings from the menus  they replace the factory default settings as  user default settings    user default setting remains in effect until you access the menu again  choose another value   and save it  To restore the factory default settings  see  Restoring the factory default settings  on page 262     1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears     2 On the home screen  touch          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 46    3 Touch Reports     4 Touch Menu Settings Page     The menu settings page prints and the printer returns to the home screen     Printing a network setup page    If the printer is attached to a network  then print a network setup page to verify the network connection  This page  also provides important information that aids network printing configuration     1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   2 On the home screen  touch         3 Touch Reports   4    Touch Network Setup Page     The network setup page prints and the printer returns to the home screen     5 Check the first section on the network setup page  and confirm that Status is  Connected      If Status is  Not Connected   the LAN drop may not be active  or the network cable may be malfunctioning  Consult  a system support person
280. oad an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch Copy     4 From the Sides  Duplex  area  touch the button that looks the way you want your copies duplexed     The first number represents sides of the original documents  the second number represents sides of the copy  For  example  select 1 sided to 2 sided if you have 1 sided original documents and you want 2 sided copies     5 Touch Copy It     Reducing or enlarging copies    Copies can be reduced to 2596 of the original document size or enlarged to 40096 of the original document size  The  factory default setting for Scale is Auto  If you leave Scale set to Auto  the content of your original document will be  scaled to fit the size of the paper onto which you are copying     To reduce or enlarge a copy   1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides     3 On the home screen  touch Copy     Do
281. oading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Light as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Heavy Loading  Duplex  Off    Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Heavy as the paper type    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Rough Loading       Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify          Duplex Rough as the paper type  Off Note  Off is the factory default setting   Notes       Duplex sets the printer default to 2 sided printing for every print job unless 1 sided printing is selected from Print  Properties in Windows or the Print dialog in Macintosh        f Duplex is selected  all print jobs are sent through the duplex unit  including 1 sided jobs   b          Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 162    a    Menu item Description    Custom  lt x gt  Loading Determines whether 2 sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  Duplex Custom  lt x gt  as the paper type  Off Notes     e Offis the factory default setting       Custom   x   Loading is available only if the custom type is  supported           Notes       Duplex sets the printer default to 2 sided printing for every print job unless 1 sided printing is selected from Print  Properties in Windows or the Print dialog in Macintosh              f Duplex is selected  all print jobs are sent through the duplex unit  including 1 sided 
282. obs on the home screen  and  then touch Profiles     d After you enter the shortcut number  the scanner scans and sends the document to the directory or program  you specified  If you touched Profiles on the home screen  then locate your shortcut on the list     9 Return to the computer to view the file     The output file is saved in the location you specified or launched in the program you specified     Scanning to a flash drive    1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides     3 Insert the flash drive into the USB port on the front of the printer     The Held Jobs screen appears   4 Touch Scan to USB drive   5 Select the scan settings     6 Touch Scan It     Understanding scan profile options             Quick Setup   This option lets you select preset formats or customize the scan job settings  You can select one of these settings      Custom Photo   Color JPEG    Text   BW PDF Photo   Color TIFF   Text   BW TIFF Text Photo   BW PDF   L Text Photo   Color PDF             To customize the scan job settings  from the Quick Setup menu  select Custom  Then change the scan settings as needed     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Scanning to a compute
283. of the current menu settings for reference  then print a menu settings page before you restore  the factory default settings  For more information  see  Printing a menu settings page  on page 45     Warning    Potential Damage  Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory default  setting  Exceptions include the display language  custom sizes and messages  and Network Port menu settings  All  downloads stored in RAM are deleted  Downloads stored in flash memory or on a printer hard disk are not affected     1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   2 Onthe home screen  touch          3 Touch Settings     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Administrative support 263    4 Touch General Settings    5 Touch the down arrow until Factory Defaults appears   6 Touch the left or right arrow until Restore Now appears   7 Touch Submit     8 Touch           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 264    Troubleshooting    Solving basic printer problems    If there are basic printer problems  or the printer is unresponsive  make sure     The power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly grounded electrical outlet     The electrical outlet is not turned off by any switch or breaker     The printer is not plugged into any surge protectors  uninterrupted power supplies  or extension cords       Other electronic equipment plugged into the outlet is working     The printer is turned on  Check the printer
284. ol panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       180                      Menu item Description  Serial Protocol Selects the hardware and software handshaking settings for the serial port  DTR Notes   DTR DSR  XON XOFF   DTRis the factory default setting   XON XOFF DTR    DTR DSR is a hardware handshaking setting   XON XOFF DTRDSR   XON XOFF is a software handshaking setting      XON XOFF DTR and XON XOFF DTR DSR are combined hardware and  software handshaking settings    Robust XON Determines whether or not the printer communicates availability to the computer  on Notes   Off     Offis the factory default setting      This menu item applies only to the serial port if Serial Protocol is set to  XON XOFF    Baud Specifies the rate at which data can be received through the serial port  1200 Notes   2400  4800   9600 is the factory default setting   9600   138200  172800  230400  and 345600 baud rates are displayed only in the  19200 Standard Serial menu  These settings do not appear in the Serial Option or  38400 Serial Option 2 menus   57600  115200  138200  172800  230400  345600  Data Bits Specifies the number of data bits that are sent in each transmission frame  7 Note  8 is the factory default setting   8  Parity Sets the parity for serial input and output data frames  Even Note  None is the factory default setting   Odd  None  I
285. om ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Remove packaging material  check    x   239   Remove paper from   linked bin  set name   239   Remove paper from all bins 239   Remove paper from bin   x   239   Remove paper from standard  output bin 239   Replace all originals if restarting  job  239   Replace wiper 240   Restore Held Jobs  240   Scan Document Too Long 240   Scanner ADF Cover Open 240   Scanner Disabled 249   Scanner Jam Access Cover  Open 240   Securely clearing disk space 240   Sending page   n   240   Serial   x   240   Set clock 240   SMTP server not set up  Contact  system administrator  240   Some held jobs were not  restored 241   System busy  preparing resources  for job  241   System busy  preparing resources  for job  Deleting held job s   241   Unsupported disk 241   Unsupported USB device  please  remove 241   Unsupported USB hub  please  remove 241   USB USB   x   241   Waiting for redial 241    printer options troubleshooting    2000 sheet tray 277   4 bin mailbox 277   envelope feeder 277   flash memory card 278   hard disk with adapter 278   high capacity output  expander 277   Internal Solutions Port 278   memory card 278   option not working 276   paper trays 276   StapleSmart finisher 277    printer problems  solving basic 264  printing    directory list 137    313    from flash drive 136   from Macintosh 131   from Windows 131   installing printer software 46   menu settings page 45   network setup page 46   print quality test pages 137  printing confi
286. om publications to view the envelope  feeder instruction sheet     Output options    If the high capacity output expander  4 bin mailbox  or StapleSmart finisher is listed on the menu settings page  but  paper jams when it exits the printer or enters the output option  then it may not be properly installed  Reinstall the  option  For more information  see the hardware setup documentation that came with the option     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 278    Flash memory card    Make sure the flash memory card is securely connected to the printer system board     Hard disk with adapter    Make sure the hard disk is securely connected to the printer system board     Internal Solutions Port    If the Lexmark Internal Solutions Port  ISP  does not operate correctly  then these are possible solutions  Try one or  more of the following     CHECK THE ISP CONNECTIONS      Make sure the ISP is securely attached to the printer system board       Make sure the cable is securely connected to the correct connector     CHECK THE CABLE    Make sure you are using the correct cable and that it is securely connected     IVIAKE SURE THE NETWORK SOFTWARE IS CONFIGURED CORRECTLY    For information about installing software for network printing  see the Networking Guide on the Software and  Documentation CD    Memory card    Make sure the memory card is securely connected to the printer system board     Solving paper feed problems    Paper frequently jams    These ar
287. ord into the LINE     port of the printer  and then plug it into an active telephone wall jack        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 69    4 Connect a second telephone cord from the telephone to the computer modem        5 Connect a third telephone cord from the computer modem to the EXT port     of the printer                    Setting the outgoing fax name and number  To have the designated fax name and fax number printed on outgoing faxes   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     Click Settings    Click Fax Settings    Click Analog Fax Setup    Click inside the Station Name box  and then enter the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes     Click inside the Station Number box  and then enter the printer fax number     Nn oO uU A VU NM    Click Submit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 70    Setting the date and time    You can set the date and time so that they are printed on every fax you send  If there is a power failure  then you may  have to reset the date and time  To set the date and time     1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section    
288. ork Card menu  This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports  gt  Standard Network or Network  lt x gt   gt  Std Network Setup or Net  lt x gt  Setup  gt  Network Card    Menu item Description    View Card Status Lets you view the connection status of the Network Card  Connected  Disconnected             View Card Speed Lets you view the speed of a currently active network card  Network Address Lets you view the network addresses   UAA   LAA       r       M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 171    a    Menu item Description    Job Timeout Sets the amount of time in seconds that a network print job can take before it  0 225 seconds is canceled  Notes       90 seconds is the factory default setting     Asetting value of 0 disables the timeout      f avalue of 1   9 is selected  then the setting is saved as 10                 Banner Page Allows the printer to print a banner page  Off Note  Off is the factory default setting   On       TCP IP menu    Use the following menu items to view or set the TCP IP information   Note  This menu is available only for network models or printers attached to print servers     This menu is available from the Network Ports menu     Network Ports    Standard Network or Network   x      Std Network Setup or Net   x   Setup    TCP IP    Menu item Description          Activate Activates TCP IP  On Note  On is the factory default setting   Off  View Hostname Lets you view the curr
289. ort  and report the message     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 250    1565 Emulation error  load emulation option    The printer automatically clears the message in 30 seconds and then disables the download emulator on the firmware  card     To fix this  download the correct download emulator version from the Lexmark Web site at www lexmark com     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 251    Maintaining the printer    Periodically  certain tasks are required to maintain optimum print quality     Cleaning the exterior of the printer    1 Make sure that the printer is turned off and unplugged from the wall outlet     CAUTION   SHOCK HAZARD  To avoid the risk of electric shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer   unplug the power cord from the wall outlet and disconnect all cables to the printer before proceeding     2 Remove paper from the standard exit bin   3 Dampen a clean  lint free cloth with water     Warning   Potential Damage  Do not use household cleaners or detergents  as they may damage the finish of  the printer     4 Wipe only the outside of the printer  making sure to include the standard exit bin   Warning   Potential Damage  Using a damp cloth to clean the interior may cause damage to your printer     5 Make sure the paper support and standard exit bin are dry before beginning a new print job     Cleaning the scanner glass    Clean the scanner glass if you encounter print
290. otes   A5  A6   From the Paper menu  Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order  JIS BS for MP Feeder Size to appear as a menu item   Letter   A4 isthe international factory default setting  Letter is the US factory  Legal default setting   Executive   The multipurpose feeder does not automatically sense paper size  The  M paper size value must be set   Oficio  Folio  Statement  Universal  7 3 4 Envelope  9 Envelope  10 Envelope  DL Envelope    Other Envelope          1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off           Note  Only installed trays  drawers  and feeders are listed in this menu    lt        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       155    Understanding printer menus    Menu item    MP Feeder Type  Plain Paper  Card Stock  Transparency  Recycled  Labels  Vinyl Labels  Bond  Envelope  Rough Envelope  Letterhead  Preprinted  Colored Paper  Light Paper  Heavy Paper  Rough Cotton Paper  Custom Type  lt x gt        Description    Specifies the type of paper loaded in the multipurpose feeder    Notes       From the Paper menu  Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order  for MP Feeder Type to appear as a menu item       Plain Paper is the factory default setting        Envelope Feeder Size  7 3 4 Envelope  9 Envelope  10 Envelope  DL Envelope  Other Envelope    Specifies the envelope size loaded in the envelope feeder    Note  DL Envelope is the international factory default setting  10 Envelope is  the US factory default setting        Envelope Feed
291. overholder de v  sentlige krav og   vrige relevante  krav i direktiv 1999 5 EF        Deutsch Hiermit erkl  rt Lexmark International  Inc   dass sich das Ger  t dieses Ger  t in   bereinstimmung mit den  grundlegenden Anforderungen und den   brigen einschl  gigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999 5 EG  befindet     EMnvik     ME THN TIAPOYZA H LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL  INC  AHAONEI OTI AYTO TO NPOION  ZYMMOPOONETAI NPOZ TIZ OYZIOAEIZ ANAITHZEI2 KAI TIZ AOITIEX ZXETIKEZ AIATAZEI2  TH   OAHTIAZ 1999 5 EK           English Hereby  Lexmark International  Inc   declares that this type of equipment is in compliance with the  essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999 5 EC        Espa  ol Por medio de la presente  Lexmark International  Inc  declara que este producto cumple con los requisitos  esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva 1999 5 CE        Eesti K  esolevaga kinnitab Lexmark International  Inc   et seade see toode vastab direktiivi 1999 5 EU  p  hin  uetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele muudele asjakohastele s  tetele        Suomi Lexmark International  Inc  vakuuttaa t  ten  ett   t  m   tuote on direktiivin 1999 5 EY oleellisten vaatimusten  ja muiden sit   koskevien direktiivin ehtojen mukainen        Fran  ais Par la pr  sente  Lexmark International  Inc  d  clare que l appareil ce produit est conforme aux exigences  fondamentales et autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999 5 CE  
292. own  the left arrow is  unavailable     9 Touch Done   10 Touch Fax it     Note  The document is scanned and then faxed at the scheduled time     Viewing a fax log  1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings   3 Click Reports   4 Click Fax Job Log or Fax Call Log     Blocking junk faxes  1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings   3 Click Fax Settings     4 Click Analog Fax Setup     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 118    5 Click the Block No Name Fax option     This option blocks all incoming faxes that have a private caller ID or no fax station name     6 Inthe Banned Fax List field  enter the phone numbers or fax station names of specific fax callers you want to block     Canceling an outgoing fax    Canceling a fax while the original documents are still scanning      When using the ADF  touch Cancel Job while Scanning   appears       When using the scanner glass  touch Cancel Job while Scanning    appears or while Scan the Next Page   Finish the Job appears     Canceling a fax after the original documents have been scanned to memory    1 On the home screen  touch Cancel 
293. paper types and weights   The paper capacity of each output bin is listed in parentheses  Paper capacity estimations are calculated based on  75 g m   20 Ib  paper     The Finisher supports 60 176 g m   16 47 Ib  paper weights     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper and specialty media guidelines 92                   Paper type Finisher standard   Output Expander  550   5 Bin Mailbox StapleSmart Finisher  bin  250 or 550 sheets  or High  500 sheets    500 sheets2   sheets  Capacity Output   Stacker  1850 sheets    Paper y     J     Plain     Bond     Colored     Custom     Letterhead     Light     Heavy     Preprinted     Rough Cotton    Recycled   Card stock JV vV X   Envelopes   JV X X   Labels   V J X X     Paper    Vinyl  Transparencies JV JV X X                   1 Supports 60 90 g m   16 24 Ib  paper weights     Maximum of 50 sheets per stapled packet     3 Printing labels requires a special label fuser cleaner which prevents duplexing  The label fuser cleaner is included with the  special cartridge required for label applications    lt           d       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 93    Copying  ADF Scanner glass             Use the ADF for multiple page documents    Use the scanner glass for single pages  small items  such as postcards or  photos   transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine    clippings                  Making copies    Making a quick copy  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge
294. pecially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line  ensure the installation of this  equipment does not disable your alarm equipment  If you have questions about what will disable alarm equipment   consult your telephone company or a qualified installer     Telephone companies report that electrical surges  typically lightning transients  are very destructive to customer  terminal equipment connected to AC power sources  This has been identified as a major nationwide problem  It is  recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  connected  An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated  and certified by UL  Underwriter s  Laboratories   another NRTL  Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory   or a recognized safety certification body in  the country region of use  This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  surges     The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic  device  including fax machines  to send any message unless said message clearly contains in a margin at the top or  bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission  the date and time it is sent and an identification  of the business or other entity  or other individual sending the message  and the telephone number of the sending  machine or such business  other entit
295. pient s e mail address     To create a group of recipients  touch Next address  and then type the next recipient s e mail address   3 Touch Save as Shortcut   4 Type a unique name for the shortcut  and then touch Enter     5 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct  and then touch OK     If the name or number is incorrect  then touch Cancel  and then reenter the information     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       E mailing 108    E mailing a document    Sending an e mail using the touch screen  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch E mail     4 Enter the e mail address or shortcut number     To enter additional recipients  touch Next Address  and then enter the address or shortcut number you want to  add     5 Touch E mail It     Sending an e mail using a shortcut number  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust t
296. placed on the top edge of portrait pages  and the left edge of landscape pages   Copies Specifies a default number of copies for each print job  1 999 Note  1 is the factory default setting   Blank Pages Specifies whether blank pages are inserted in a print job  Do Not Print Note  Do Not Print is the factory default setting   Print       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals             Understanding printer menus    Menu item   Collate  Off  1 1 1 2 2 2   On  1 2 1 2 1 2        222    Description    Stacks the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies  Notes   e Off is the factory default setting  No pages will be collated       The On setting stacks the print job sequentially       Both settings print the entire job the number of times specified by the Copies  menu setting        Separator Sheets  None  Between Copies  Between Jobs  Between Pages    Specifies whether blank separator sheets are inserted    Notes       Noneis the factory default setting       Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if  Collation is set to On  If Collation is set to Off  a blank page is inserted between  each set of printed pages  such as after all page 1 s and after all page 2 s       Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs       Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of the print job  This  setting is useful when printing transparencies or inserting blank pages in a  document for notes        Separator Sourc
297. poraneous oral or written communications  proposals  and representations with respect to the  Software Program or any other subject matter covered by this Software License Agreement  except to the extent  such extraneous terms do not conflict with the terms of this Software License Agreement  any other written  agreement signed by you and Lexmark relating to your Use of the Software Program   To the extent any Lexmark  policies or programs for support services conflict with the terms of this Software License Agreement  the terms of  this Software License Agreement shall control     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Index    Index    Numerics  1565 Emulation error  load  emulation option 250  2000 sheet tray   loading 75  200 282 yy paper jam 248  250 sheet tray  standard or  optional    loading 72  283 Staple jam 248  290 294 yy scanner jam 248  293 Replace all originals if restarting  job 248  293 02 Flatbed Cover Open 249  30 Invalid refill  change  cartridge 241  31 Replace defective cartridge 241  32 Cartridge part number  unsupported by device 241  34 Short paper 242  35 Insufficient memory to support  Resource Save feature 242  37 Insufficient memory for Flash  Memory Defragment  operation 242  37 Insufficient memory to collate  job 242  37 Insufficient memory  some Held  Jobs were deleted 242  37 Insufficient memory  some held  jobs will not be restored 242  38 Memory full 243  39 Complex page  some data may  not have printed 243  42 xy Cartridge region 
298. pout  None  Red  Green  Blue  Default Red Threshold  0 255  Default Green Threshold  0 255  Default Blue Threshold  0 255    217    Description    Specifies which color to drop during scanning  and how much to increase or decrease  the dropout    Notes       None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout       128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold        Contrast  0   5  Best for content    Specifies the contrast of the output    Note   Best for content  is the factory default setting        Mirror Image  On  Off    Creates a mirror image of the original document    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Negative Image    Creates a negative image of the original document       On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off   Shadow Detail Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image  0 4    Note  O is the factory default setting        Scan edge to edge    Specifies whether the original document is scanned edge to edge                   On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Sharpness Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a scanned image  0 5 Note  3 is the factory default setting   NS SJ  Print Settings  Menu item Description  Copies Specifies the number of copies to print       Paper Source  Tray  lt x gt   MP Feeder  Manual Paper  Manual Envelope    Specifies the paper source selected to supply paper for the printer to print from the  flash drive       Collate  Off  1 1 1 2 2 2   On  1 2 1 2 1 2        Sta
299. py Settings  Fax Settings  E mail Settings  FTP Settings  Flash Drive Menu    Print Settings    Help    Print all guides  Copy guide   E mail guide   Fax guide   FTP guide  Information guide  Print Defects guide  Supplies Guide    Understanding printer menus    Paper menu    Default Source menu    Default Source  Tray  lt x gt   MP Feeder  Envelope Feeder  Manual Paper  Manual Env       cr    Menu item       153    Sets a default paper source for all print jobs    Notes       Tray 1  standard tray  is the factory default setting     Only an installed paper source will appear as a menu setting       A paper source selected by a print job will override the Default Source  setting for the duration of the print job       Ifthe same size and type of paper are in two trays and the Paper Size and  Paper Type settings match  then the trays are automatically linked  When  one tray is empty  the job prints using the linked tray       From the Paper menu  Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order for  MP Feeder to appear as a menu setting     Description       M       Paper Size Type menu    a    Tray  lt x gt  Size  A4  A5  A6  JIS B5  Letter  Legal  Executive   Oficio   Folio  Statement   Universal    Menu item    Specifies the paper size loaded in each tray    Notes     e A4 is the international factory default setting  Letter is the US factory  default setting       For trays with automatic size sensing  only the size detected by the  hardware appears       Use this menu item to
300. r     4 From the Printer List  choose Add     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 53    5  6    Select the printer from the list   Click Add     b For AppleTalk printing     In Mac OS X version 10 5    1    au wWN    From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   Click Print  amp  Fax    Click      Click AppleTalk    Select the printer from the list    Click Add     In Mac OS X version 10 4    1    O oOnN DU BW N    m  o    From the Go menu  choose Applications    Double click Utilities    Locate and double click Print Center or Printer Setup Utility   From the Printer List  choose Add    Choose the Default Browser tab    Click More Printers    From the first pop up menu  choose AppleTalk    From the second pop up menu  select Local AppleTalk zone   Select the printer from the list    Click Add     Installing the printer on a wired network    Use the following instructions to install the printer on a wired network  These instructions apply to Ethernet and fiber  optic network connections     Before you install the printer on a wired network  make sure that       You have completed the initial setup of the printer       The printer is connected to your network with the appropriate type of cable     For Windows users    1 Insert the Software and Documentation CD     Wait for the Welcome screen to appear     If the CD does not launch after a minute  then do one of the following     In Windows Vista    a Click e     b Inthe Start Search box
301. r cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Turn the printer power back on     56 Parallel port   x   disabled    x   is the number of the parallel port   Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message   The printer discards any data received through the parallel port       Make sure the Parallel Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled     56 Serial port   x   disabled    x   is the number of the serial port   Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message   The printer discards any data received through the serial port       Make sure the Serial Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled     56 Standard parallel port disabled    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message   The printer discards any data received through the parallel port       Mlake sure the Parallel Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled     56 Standard USB port disabled    Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message   The printer discards any data received through the USB port       Make sure the USB Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 246    56 USB port  lt x gt  disabled     lt x gt  is the number of the USB port     Try one or more of the following     Touch Continue to clear the message   The printer discards any data received through the USB port       Make sure the USB Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled 
302. r link buffers  and whether Resource Save is set to On or  Off     To increase the maximum size range for the Parallel Buffer  disable or reduce  the size of the USB  serial  and network buffers     Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Job Buffering  Off  On  Auto    Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing  Notes     e Offis the factory default setting     The Off setting does not buffer print jobs to the printer hard disk     The On setting buffers jobs on the printer hard disk     The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  from another input port     Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Advanced Status    Enables bidirectional communication through the parallel port       On Notes   Off    Onisthe factory default setting     The Off setting disables parallel port negotiation   Protocol Specifies the parallel port protocol  Standard Notes   Fastbytes         Fastbytes is the factory default setting  It provides compatibility with most  existing parallel ports and is the recommended setting          The Standard setting tries to resolve parallel port communication problems        P        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item  Honor Init  On  
303. r or flash drive 129    Format Type    This option sets the output  PDF  JPEG  TIFF  SECURE PDF  or XPS  for the scanned image       PDF   Creates a single file with multiple pages  viewable with Adobe Reader  Adobe Reader is provided free by  Adobe at www adobe com      JPEG   Creates and attaches a separate file for each page of your original document  viewable by most Web browsers  and graphics programs      TIFF   Creates multiple files or a single file  If Multi page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  Web Server  then TIFF saves one page in each file  The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG     Secure PDF   Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access    e XPS   Creates a single XPS file with multiple pages  viewable using an Internet Explorer hosted viewer and the  NET  Framework  or by downloading a third party standalone viewer    Compression    This option sets the format used to compress the scanned output file     Default Content    This option tells the printer the original document type  Choose from Text  Text Photo  or Photo  Content affects the  quality and size of your scanned file     Text   Emphasizes sharp  black  high resolution text against a clean  white background  Text Photo   Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures    Photo   Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures  This setting increases the time it takes t
304. r you to receive Scan to PC images  You can scan the document back to the computer over  the network by creating a scan profile on the computer and then downloading the profile to the printer     Scanning to a computer    1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     Click Scan Profile   Click Create   Select your scan settings  and then click Next     Select a location on your computer where you want to save the scanned output file     a u A WwW N    Enter a scan name     The scan name is the name that appears in the Scan Profile list on the display     N    Click Submit     8 Review the instructions on the Scan Profile screen     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Scanning to a computer or flash drive 128    A shortcut number was automatically assigned when you clicked Submit  You can use this shortcut number when  you are ready to scan your documents     a Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as  magazine clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     b Ifyou are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides     c Press        and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad  or touch Held J
305. rd disk   e     The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  from another input port     Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Mac Binary PS  On    Sets the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs          Notes    Off  Auto   Auto is the factory default setting      The Off setting filters print jobs using the standard protocol      The On setting processes raw binary PostScript print jobs    USB With ENA Sets the network address  netmask  or gateway information for an external print   ENA Address server that is attached to the printer using a USB cable   ENA Netmask Note  This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print  ENA Gateway server through the USB port           Parallel   x   menu    This menu appears only if an optional parallel card is installed     Menu item          Description  PCL SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  On through a parallel port requires it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes     On is the factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data     When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PostScript emulation if PS  SmartSwitch is set to On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch
306. rds  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 Press    and then enter the FTP shortcut number     4 Touch Send It     Scanning to an FTP address using the address book  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  adjust the paper guides    On the home screen  touch FTP    Touch Search Address Book    Type the name or part of the name you are searching for  and then touch Search     Touch the name that you want to add to the To  field     Nn Oo Ww A VU N    Touch Send It     Creating shortcuts    Instead of entering the entire FTP site address on the control panel each time you want to send a document to an FTP  server  you can create a permanent FTP destination and assign a shortcut number  There are two methods for creating  shortcut numbers  using a computer or using the printer touch screen     Creating an FTP shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup pag
307. re replacing     80 Routine maintenance needed    The printer needs to have routine maintenance done  Order a maintenance kit  which contains all the items necessary  to replace the pick rollers  the charge roll  the transfer roller  and the fuser     88 Cartridge low    The toner is low  Replace the print cartridge  and then touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing     88 yy Cartridge nearly low    The toner is low  Replace the print cartridge  and then touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing     88 yy Replace cartridge  The print cartridge is empty   1 Replace the print cartridge     2 Touch Continue to clear the message     200 282 yy paper jam  1 Clear the paper path     2 Touch Continue to continue printing     283 Staple jam    1 Clear the jam from the specified stapler area s      2 Touch Continue to continue printing     290 294 yy scanner jam    Clear all original documents from the scanner     293 Replace all originals if restarting job     The scanner was instructed to scan using the ADF but there is no paper in the ADF  Load paper in the ADF     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages    Try one or more of the following       Touch Continue if no scan job is active when the attendance message appears  This clears the message     249      Touch Cancel Job if a scan job is processing when the attendance message appears  This cancels the job and clears    the message     immediately after the 
308. receive  faxes 274  cannot send or receive a fax 272  received fax has poor print  quality 275  faxing  canceling a fax job 118  changing resolution 116  choosing a fax connection 60  creating shortcuts using the  Embedded Web Server 114  creating shortcuts using the touch  screen 115  forwarding faxes 121  holding faxes 120  improving fax quality 120  making a fax lighter or darker 116  sending a fax at a scheduled  time 117  sending using the computer 114  sending using the printer control  panel 113  setting the date and time 70  setting the outgoing fax name and  number 69  turning Daylight Saving Time  on 70  using shortcuts 115  using the address book 115  viewing a fax log 117  FCC notices 293  297  fiber optic  network setup 53  finding information  customer support 14  publications 14  Finishing menu 221  firmware card  installing 29  flash drive 136  Flash Drive menu 214  flash memory card  installing 29    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       troubleshooting 278  Flushing buffer 234  forwarding faxes 121  FTP   address book 123  FTP quality  improving 126  FTP screen   advanced options 125   options 124  125  FTP Settings menu 211  fuser   ordering 256    G    guidelines  card stock 133  envelopes 132  labels 133  letterhead 131  transparencies 132    H    hard disk with adapter  troubleshooting 278  held jobs 134  printing from Macintosh  computer 135  printing from Windows 135  Help menu 231  holding faxes 120  home screen  buttons 19  HTML menu 229  
309. residential area is likely to cause harmful interference  in which case  the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense     The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by using other than recommended  cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment  Unauthorized changes or modifications could  void the user s authority to operate this equipment     Note  To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class A computing device   use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach or 1021294 for  USB attach  Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC  regulations     Compliance statement    This product complies with the Class A emission requirements of EN55022 and immunity requirements of EN55024   This product is not intended to be used in residential environments     Exposure to radio frequency radiation    The following notice is applicable if your printer has a wireless network card installed     The radiated output power of this device is far below the FCC radio frequency exposure limits  A minimum separation  of 20 cm  8 inches  must be maintained between the antenna and any persons for this device to satisfy the RF exposure  requirements of the FCC     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 294    Industry Canada notices    Industry Canada
310. rinter  for example  if the paper curls excessively under normal printing  conditions      Storing paper    Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality       For best results  store paper where the temperature is 21  C  70  F  and the relative humidity is 4096  Most label  manufacturers recommend printing in a temperature range of 18 to 24  C  65 to 75  F  with relative humidity between  40 and 60      Store paper in cartons when possible  on a pallet or shelf  rather than on the floor     Store individual packages on a flat surface       Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Paper and specialty media guidelines 89    Supported paper sizes  types  and weights  The following tables provide information on standard and optional paper sources and the types of paper they support   Note  For an unlisted paper size  configure a Universal Paper Size     For information on card stock and labels  see the Card Stock  amp  Label Guide on the Lexmark Web site at  www lexmark com publications     Paper sizes supported by the printer    Dimensions 250  or Optional Multipurpose Duplex unit  550 sheet trays 2000 sheet tray feeder     standard or                                  optional   j DN y v y  1 TT i 7    A612 105 x 148 mm X X J X   4 1 x 5 8 in    He EOS v v    oo Te v v v  b   un e v v v  n TUN i v    w uU s i v y  RE Ep i v y  Statement    eee   JV X  i X                      
311. rinter com Manuals       Clearing jams 151    5 Open the bottom ADF door  and then remove any jammed pages              6 Close the bottom ADF door and scanner cover     7 Touch Restart Job     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Understanding printer menus    Menus list    152    A number of menus are available to make it easy for you to change printer settings  To access the menus  touch         on the home screen     Paper Menu    Default Source  Paper Size Type  Configure MP  Envelope Enhance  Substitute Size  Paper Texture  Paper Weight  Paper Loading  Custom Types  Custom Names  Custom Scan Sizes  Custom Bin Names  Universal Setup    Bin Setup    1 Only appears if a wireless card is installed     Reports    Menu Settings Page  Device Statistics  Network Setup Page  Network   x   Setup Page  Wireless Setup Page   Shortcut List   Fax Job Log   Fax Call Log   Copy Shortcuts  E mail Shortcuts   Fax Shortcuts   FTP Shortcuts  Profiles List  NetWare Setup Page  Print Fonts   Print Directory    Asset Report    Network Ports    Active NIC  Standard Network   SMTP Setup  Standard USB  Parallel   x      Serial   x        Depending on the printer setup  this menu item appears as Standard Network or Network   x       Security    Edit Security Setups  Miscellaneous Security Settings  Confidential Print   Disc Wiping   Security Audit Log   Set Date and Time    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Settings    General Settings  Co
312. rinter messages    Insert Tray  lt x gt     Insert the specified tray into the printer     Install bin  lt x gt     Try one or more of the following     Install the specified bin   1 Turn the printer off   2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet     3 Install the specified bin     4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Restart the printer       Cancel the current job     Install envelope feeder    Try one or more of the following      nstall the envelope feeder   1 Turn the printer off   2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet     3 Install the envelope feeder     4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Restart the printer       Cancel the current job     Install Tray   x      Try one or more of the following      nstall the specified tray   1 Turn the printer off   2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet     3 Install the specified tray     4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet     5 Restart the printer       Cancel the current job     Invalid PIN    Enter a valid PIN     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       235    Understanding printer messages 236    Job stored for delayed transmission    The scanning completed for a delayed send fax job  Wait for the message to clear     Line busy    A fax number is dialed  but the fax line is busy  Wait for the message to clear     Load  lt src gt  with  lt x gt    lt src gt  is a tray or feeder  and  lt x gt  is a paper type or size     Try one or mor
313. ription signifie simplement que le produit est conforme  aux sp  cifications techniques d Industry Canada     Radio interference notice    This is a Class A product  In a domestic environment  this product may cause radio interference  in which case  the user  may be required to take adequate measures     European Community  EC  directives conformity    This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004 108 EC  2006 95 EC  and  1999 5 EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic  compatibility  safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits and on radio equipment and    telecommunications terminal equipment     A declaration of conformity with the requirements of the directives is available from the Director of Manufacturing and  Technical Support  Lexmark International  S  A   Boigny  France     Compliance is indicated by the CE marking     This product satisfies the limits of EN 55022  safety requirements of EN 60950  radio spectrum requirements of ETSI  EN 300 330 1 and ETSI EN 300 330 2  and the EMC requirements of EN 55024  ETSI EN 301 489 1 and ETSI EN 301 489 3        P 7  Cesky Spole  nost Lexmark International  Inc  t  mto prohla  uje  Ze v  robek tento v  robek je ve shod   se z  kladn  mi  po  adavky a dal    mi p    slu  n  mi ustanoven  mi sm  rnice 1999 5 ES        Dansk Lexmark International  Inc  erkl  rer herved  at dette produkt 
314. rnational factory default setting for Width   3 14 17 inches  76 360 mm   Orientation   14 Inches is the US factory default setting for Height  356 millimeters is  the international factory default setting for Height   Landscape              Landscape is the factory default setting for Orientation   Portrait    Off is the factory default setting for 2 scans per side   User Default is the factory default setting for ADF Pick Roller Force     2 scans per side  Off  On   ADF Pick Roller Force  User Default  3096  4096  5096  6096  7096  8096                Custom Bin Names menu    Description       Standard Bin Specifies a custom name for the Standard Bin        Bin 1   Specifies a custom name for Bin 1 j       Universal Setup menu    These menu items are used to specify the height  width  and feed direction of the Universal Paper Size  The Universal  Paper Size is a user defined paper size setting  It is listed with the other paper size settings and includes similar options   such as support for duplex printing and printing multiple pages on one sheet     Menu item Description       Units of Measure Identifies the units of measure  Inches Notes   Millimeters      Inches is the US factory default setting          Millimeters is the international factory default setting        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 164    Menu item Description    Portrait Width Sets the portrait width  3 14 inches Notes   76 360 mm      Ifthe width exceeds th
315. roblems  For the best print quality  try a sample of the  paper or specialty media before buying large quantities     Paper characteristics    The following paper characteristics affect print quality and reliability  Consider these characteristics when evaluating  new paper stock     Note  For detailed information on card stock and labels  see the Card Stock  amp  Label Guide available on the Lexmark  Web site at www lexmark com publications     Weight    The printer can automatically feed paper weights from 60 176 g m   16 47 Ib bond  grain long  Paper lighter than  60 g m   16 Ib  might not be stiff enough to feed properly  causing jams  For best performance  use 75 g m   20 Ib  bond  grain long paper  For paper smaller than 182 x 257 mm  7 2 x 10 1 in    we recommend 90 g m   24 Ib  or heavier  paper     Curl    Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges  Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems  Curl can occur after  the paper passes through the printer  where it is exposed to high temperatures  Storing paper unwrapped in hot  humid   cold  or dry conditions  even in the trays  can contribute to paper curling prior to printing and can cause feeding  problems     Smoothness    Paper smoothness directly affects print quality  If paper is too rough  then toner cannot fuse to it properly  If paper is  too smooth  then it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues  Always use paper between 100 and 300 Sheffield  points  smoothness between 150 and 250 Sheff
316. rom ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 51                Enter the printer information  1 Access the AirPort options   In Mac OS X version 10 5  a From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences     b Click Network   C Click AirPort     In Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier  a From the Go menu  choose Applications   b Double click Internet Connect     c From the toolbar  click AirPort     2 From the Network pop up menu  select print server xxxxxx  where the x s are the last six digits of the MAC address  located on the MAC address sheet     Open the Safari browser   From the Bookmarks drop down menu  select Show     Under Collections  select Bonjour or Rendevous  and then double click the printer name     a uu Aa W    From the main page of the Embedded Web Server  navigate to the page where the wireless settings information is  stored   Configure the printer for wireless access   1 Type the name of your network  SSID  in the appropriate field    2 Select Infrastructure as your Network Mode if you are using a wireless router    3 Select the type of security you use to protect your wireless network     4 Enter the security information necessary for the printer to join your wireless network     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup    5 Click Submit     6 Open the AirPort application on your computer     In Mac OS X version 10 5    a  b    c    From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   Click Network   Click AirPort 
317. rom the wall outlet   3 Remove the tray    4 Contact Customer Support       Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the tray     Close door or insert cartridge    The cartridge is missing or not installed correctly  Insert the cartridge and close all doors and covers     Close finisher side door    Close the side door on the finisher     Connect  lt x gt bps  The fax is connected  Wait for the message to clear     Note    x   is the baud rate per second     Dialing    A fax number is dialed  If the number is too long to fit on the screen  only the word Dialing appears  Wait for the  message to clear     Disk corrupted    The printer attempted a hard disk recovery on a corrupted hard disk  and the hard disk cannot be repaired  The hard  disk must be reformatted     Touch Reformat disk to reformat the hard disk and clear the message     Note  Reformatting the disk deletes all the files currently stored on the disk     Disk Full   Scan Job Canceled    The scan job canceled or stopped due to insufficient printer hard disk space     Touch Continue to clear the message     Fax failed    The fax failed to be sent  Wait for the message to clear     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer messages 234    Fax memory full  There is not enough memory to send the fax job     Touch Continue to clear the message     Fax partition inoperative  Contact system administrator     The fax partition appears to be corrupted  Try one or more of the 
318. rough a serial port requires it  regardless of the default printer language    Notes       On is the factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data       When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PostScript emulation if PS  SmartSwitch is set to On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off           Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer menus       179       Menu item Description  PS SmartSwitch Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  On through a serial port requires it  regardless of the default printer language  Off Notes     On is the factory default setting     When the Off setting is used  the printer does not examine incoming data     When the Off setting is used  the printer uses PCL emulation if PCL  SmartSwitch is set to On  It uses the default printer language specified in the  Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off   NPA Mode Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  On communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  Off Notes   Auto      Auto is the factory default setting       When the On setting is used  the printer performs NPA processing  If the data  is not in NPA format  it is rejected as bad data       When the Off setting is used  the printer does not perform NPA processing       When the Auto settin
319. ry PostScript print jobs        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 169    Menu item Description Iii  Std Network Setup For descriptions and settings of the network setup menus  see the following   Reports or Network Reports      Network Reports menu  on page 170  Network Card    Network Card menu  on page 170  TRAE      TCP IP menu    on page 171  uve e    IPv6 menu    on page 172  AppleTalk  NetWare    Wireless menu    on page 172  LexLink      AppleTalk menu  on page 173  e    NetWare menu    on page 173  Net  lt x gt  Setup    Reports or Network Reports A beating iment mpage TIS  Network Card Note  The Wireless menu appears only when the printer is connected to a wireless  TCP IP network   IPv6  Wireless  AppleTalk  NetWare  LexLink    es                SMTP Setup menu    Use the following menu to configure the SMTP server     Menu item Description       Primary SMTP Gateway Specifies SMTP server port information  Primary SMTP Gateway Port Note  25 is the default SMTP gateway port   Secondary SMTP Gateway    Secondary SMTP Gateway Port       SMTP Timeout Specifies the amount of time in seconds before the server stops trying to  5 30 send the e mail    Note  30 seconds is the factory default setting                 Reply Address Specifies server information  This is a required item    Use SSL Notes   Disabled   The message box has a limitation of 512 characters   Negotiate             Disabled is the factory default setting for Use 
320. s longer than  expected 266  jobs do not print 265  Large jobs do not collate 267  multiple language PDFs do not  print 264  paper curl 283  paper frequently jams 278  tray linking does not work 267  unexpected page breaks  occur 267  troubleshooting  print quality  blank pages 280  characters have jagged edges 280  clipped images 281  ghost images 281  gray background 282  poor transparency quality 290  print irregularities 283  print is too dark 286  print is too light 285  print quality test pages 279  repeating defects 284  skewed print 284  solid black streaks 285  solid color pages 287  solid white streaks 285  streaked vertical lines 288  toner fog or background  shading 288  toner rubs off 289  toner specks 289  troubleshooting  printer options  2000 sheet tray 277  4 bin mailbox 277  envelope feeder 277  flash memory card 278  hard disk with adapter 278  high capacity output  expander 277    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Internal Solutions Port 278  memory card 278  option not working 276  paper trays 276  StapleSmart finisher 277  troubleshooting  scan  cannot scan from a computer 272  partial document or photo  scans 271  scan was not successful 270  scanner unit does not close 268  scanning takes too long or freezes  the computer 271    U    Universal Paper Size   setting 71  Universal Setup menu 163  unlinking trays 83  Unsupported disk 241  Unsupported USB device  please  remove 241  Unsupported USB hub  please  remove 241  USB port 44  USB US
321. sh users  change these settings from the Print dialog and pop up menus     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 286    THE PAPER HAS ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY    Load paper from a fresh package       Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it     CHECK THE PAPER    Avoid textured paper with rough finishes     CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray   1 From the printer control panel  check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu     2 Before sending the job to print  specify the correct type setting     For Windows users  specify the type from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  specify the type from the Print dialog     THE TONER IS LOW    When 88 Cartridge Low appears  order a new print cartridge   THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE    Replace the print cartridge     Print is too dark    ES    ABC  DEF    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     CHECK THE DARKNESS  BRIGHTNESS  AND CONTRAST SETTINGS    The Toner Darkness setting is too dark  the Brightness setting is too dark  or the Contrast setting is too high     From the printer control panel  change these settings from the Quality menu     For Windows users  change these settings from Print Properties       For Macintosh users  change these settings from the Print dialog and pop up menus     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 287    THE PAPER 
322. sly configured for a wired connection  then make sure the  wired network is disconnected when you configure the printer to operate wirelessly  If the wired connection  remains connected  then the wireless configuration will complete  but the wireless ISP will not be active  This  can be fixed by disconnecting the wired connection  turning the printer off  and then turning the printer back on  again    For Windows users    1 Print a network setup page and make a note of the new IP address     2 Doone of the following     In Windows Vista    a Click e    b Click Control Panel     c Under Hardware and Sound  click Printer     In Windows XP  a Click Start     b Click Printers and Faxes     In Windows 2000  a Click Start   b Click Settings    Printers     3 Locate the printer that has changed    Note  If there is more than one copy of the printer  then update all of them with the new IP address   Right click the printer    Click Properties    Click the Ports tab     Locate the port in the list  and then select it     oN OO Ui Bf    Click Configure Port     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 57    9 Type the new IP address in the    Printer Name or IP Address    field  You can find the new IP address on the network  setup page you printed in step 1     10 Click OK  and then click Close     For Mac users  1 Print a network setup page and make a note of the new IP address     2 Locate the printer IP address in the TCP IP section of the network s
323. sparencies that are 138 146 g m   37 39 Ib  bond  in weight   To prevent print quality problems  avoid getting fingerprints on the transparencies   Before loading transparencies  fan the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together     We recommend Lexmark part number 12A5010 for A4 size transparencies and Lexmark part number 70X7240 for  letter size transparencies     Tips on using envelopes    Print samples on the envelopes being considered for use before buying large quantities     When printing on envelopes     Feed envelopes from the multipurpose feeder or the optional envelope feeder   Set the Paper Type to Envelope  and select the envelope size     Use envelopes designed specifically for laser printers  Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure the  envelopes can withstand temperatures up to 230  C  446  F  without sealing  wrinkling  curling excessively  or  releasing hazardous emissions     For the best performance  use envelopes made from 90 g m   24 Ib bond  paper  Use up to 105 g m   28 Ib bond   weight for envelopes as long as the cotton content is 25  or less  All cotton envelopes must not exceed 90 g m    24 Ib bond  weight     Use only new envelopes    To optimize performance and minimize jams  do not use envelopes that       Have excessive curl or twist       Are stuck together or damaged in any way       Have windows  holes  perforations  cutouts  or embossing       Have metal clasps  string ties  or folding bars       Haveaninterlocking design      
324. sses nnne eene nennen nnn nein 123  Scanning to an FTP address using the address book                    esses eene eene nennen nennt nnn nnns 123   Creating dipeigieU cM 123  Creating an FTP shortcut using the Embedded Web Server            cccesscccccsssssseeeceesssenseeeeseesseeeeessesssseesseenseeeeas 123  Creating an FTP shortcut using the touch screen               sssesssssssssseeeeeee eee eene een nnnn anser nennen 124   Understanding FIPOoptiORs      ciet eot ntn p Reg eedem nn eae rune Ra E a can enn E ke Re SERE eT 124  Gur                                                        A 124  SOINS          124  edu LEER 124  Spes                                      4                                  sence 124  Resol  tiOn ase ete RENS ER PUE eal ce aee ise mrs a ee et exu e epe te err ade eaa Eangi 125  Send AS o sostinmdieune ipM BIDEN ChI ut RUE SUITE 125  Seloi fq p                                                                                125  Advanced Options    aia Gees eit aa sua co LE Ta a GR K Eae ET RUE ca RE EARN E eS ERE CEDE ca e ea a ITAL RR euo 125   improving ETP QUALI TT 126    Scanning to a computer or flash Crive              ccsccsscsscssccscsscssccsccsscsscescesee 127    Scanning To a COmpUuter        2 2  2 eere R iege gea eani geli oe a p Ro Dee oo Ia Meus eoe ONE bands Gaudueasndetsadens vu ERE PESOe EE Ee du Inr aDERO 127  Scanning to a flash drive      rii tete tere este eren eese e X RRRE ETE dee Eee ex ae EAEE ERNE eie eese 128  Understand
325. ssible solutions  Try one or more of the following     RE SEND THE DOCUMENT    Ask the person who sent you the fax to     Check that the quality of the original document is satisfactory     Resend the fax  There may have been a problem with the quality of the telephone line connection       Increase the fax scan resolution  if possible     THE TONER MAY BE LOW    When 88 Cartridge low appears or when you experience faded print  replace the cartridge     MIAKE SURE THE FAX TRANSMISSION SPEED IS NOT SET TOO HIGH  Decrease the incoming fax transmission speed   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings   3 Click Fax Settings   4 Click Analog Fax Setup     5 Inthe Max Speed box  click on one of the following   2400  4800  9600  14400  33600    6 Click Submit     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Troubleshooting 276    Solving option problems    Option does not operate correctly or quits after it is installed    These are possible solutions  Try one or more of the following     RESET THE PRINTER    Turn the printer off  wait about 10 seconds  and then turn the printer on     CHECK TO SEE IF THE OPTION IS CONNECTED TO THE PRINTER  1 Turn the printer off   2 Unplug the printer     3 Check the connection between the option and the printer     IVIAKE SURE THE OPTION IS INSTALLED CO
326. ssssaseeeecessssaeeeessesseeeceesessuecsscssaseeeceseaeaeseseseessaaaes 138    I NA me                                            M    EL    Avoiding  Jalmis       ioo nean reges e RR RE EILEEN REEF ER ctucsansanbessuaniataandescsuehandssgacantaxeeransestanesssavevsesancede 140  Understanding jam numbers and locations                     esses enne nnn nnne nenne nennen nennen 141  200 and 201 paper jams    contr tte enano aede vue oues ane Fee E agenda pai gute ea du aaa Niania ataasehecevans    141  202  pa  per ja Mirisi ERU 143  230 439 paper IMS eee rece cene e ener e oe tener ea aono N AAEE TEKEAR AAEN E A AARAA AE ARANE EA 144  240 249 pap  r JAMS ccccassssccaceserecaonedavedevcdunsetvacdsasiwnadntedeacienoiunndansddeswaunwevedeseoauuea e SETE Erienn     145  PASSIERT Em 146   rst ERES 147  270 279  paper  Jarmis    eere eoo a ee esee saa eee RE AER H NE SUSAN E AERE E de Ue TENER eaae ee es re aaa Ra ENRERE ree E Erie 147  280 282 paper JAMS                                           147  283 staple JAMS  i    eene eiis iia destheecasadedsneecdea ied n enne tei du Seu E den nune eda aaea ERa 148  290   294 paper JalTis         eremo Rt ete iere a ARR RA SE SUP a o a ERE au euer Diva epe REL a Ne En aU e FERRE TERR 150    Understanding printer menus                          eee eere eene eee e eene e eee nenne ees sess LD2    Menus list                                                             H            H sa 152  Ee E a A E E A A E N                             153
327. t  but it will fit the telephone outlet used in your  location     2 Connect the telephone line of your chosen telecommunications equipment to the left outlet of the adapter        If your telecommunications equipment uses a US style  RJ11  telephone line  follow these steps to connect the  equipment     1 Remove the plug from the EXT port on the back of the printer        Note  Once this plug is removed  any country  or region specific equipment you connect to the printer by way  of the adapter  as shown  will not function properly     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup          62    Warning   Potential Damage  Do not touch cables or the printer in the area shown while actively sending or    receiving a fax     Country region      Saudi Arabia     United Arab Emirates    Egypt     Bulgaria     Czech Republic     Belgium     Australia     South Africa      Greece    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Israel  Hungary  Poland  Romania  Russia  Slovenia  Spain  Turkey    Additional printer setup 63    To connect a telephone  an answering machine  or other telecommunications equipment to the printer     1 Remove the plug from the back of the printer     on the back of the printer        Note  Once this plug is removed  any country  or region specific equipment that you connect to the printer by way  of the adapter  as shown  will not function properly        Country region      Germany    Austria      Switzerland    Downloa
328. t job  the printer prints one copy and holds the  remaining copies in printer memory  Verify lets you examine the first copy to see  if it is satisfactory before printing the remaining copies  Once all copies are printed   the job is automatically deleted from printer memory        Reserve When you senda Reserve print job  the printer does not print the job immediately   It stores the job in memory so you can print the job later  The job is held in memory  until you delete it from the Held Jobs menu        Repeat When you send a Repeat print job  the printer prints all requested copies of the  job and stores the job in memory so you can print additional copies later  You can  print additional copies as long as the job remains stored in memory     M e i                Other types of held jobs include     Profiles from various sources including Lexmark Document Solutions Suite  LDSS     Forms from a kiosk    Bookmarks      Jobs not printed  which are called parked jobs    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Printing 135    Printing confidential and other held jobs from Windows    Note  Confidential and Verify print jobs are automatically deleted from memory after they print  Repeat and Reserve  jobs continue to be held in the printer until you choose to delete them     1    2  3  4    uw    With a document open  click File  gt  Print   Click Properties  Preferences  Options  or Setup   Click Other Options  and then click Print and Hold     Select your job type  Con
329. t job and lets you print copies   Note  The Job Interrupt setting must be On for this feature to function   1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 From the printer control panel  press KD     4 If you placed the document on the scanner glass  then touch Finish the Job to return to the home screen     Placing information on copies    Placing the date and time at the top of each page  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy    Touch Options    Touch Header Footer    Pick an area of the page to place the date and time    Touch Date Time  and then touch Continue     Touch Done     O on Oo Ui A V N    Touch Copy It     Placing an overlay message on each page    An overlay message can be placed on each page  The message choices are Urgent  Confidential  Copy  or Draft  To place  a message on the copies     1 Load an origin
330. t setting  Off prints a partial page  when there is not enough memory to print the whole page       On sets the printer to process the whole page so that the  entire page prints        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          192    Understanding printer menus    Menu item   Factory Defaults  Do Not Restore  Restore Now       r    Description    Returns the printer settings to the factory default settings    Notes       Do Not Restore is the factory default setting  Do Not Restore  keeps the user defined settings       Restore returns all printer settings to the factory default  settings except Network Ports menu settings  All downloads  stored in RAM are deleted  Downloads stored in flash  memory or on a printer hard disk are not affected           M       Copy Settings menu    Content  Text Photo  Photograph  Printed Image  Text    Menu item    Description    Specifies the type of content contained in the copy job    Notes       Text Photo is the factory default setting  Text Photo is used when the original  documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures       Photograph tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures   This setting increases the time it takes to scan  but emphasizes a reproduction  of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document  This increases the  amount of information saved       Printed Image is used when jobs are composed primarily of images  Printed  Image converts the images to halftone  Halftoning 
331. tanding printer menus 231    Help menu    The Help menu consists of Help pages that are stored in the printer as PDFs  They contain reference information about  using the printer and performing tasks  You may select to print each one individually  or select Print all  guides to print all of them at one time     English  French  German  and Spanish translations are stored in the printer  Other translations are available on the  Software and Documentation CD     Menu item Description          Print all guides Prints all the guides  Copy guide Provides information about making copies and changing settings  E mail guide Provides information about sending e mails using addresses  shortcut numbers     or the address book  and changing settings       Fax guide Provides information about sending faxes using fax numbers  shortcut numbers   or the address book  and changing settings       FTP guide Provides information about scanning documents directly to an FTP server using an  FTP address  shortcut numbers  or the address book  and changing settings                   Information guide Provides help in locating additional information  Print defects guide Provides help in resolving repeating defects in copies or prints  Supplies guide Provides part numbers for ordering supplies       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          232    Understanding printer messages    Understanding printer messages    List of status and error messages    Answering    The printer is answering a f
332. tch setting is Off   NPA Mode Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  On communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  Off Notes   Auto    Auto is the factory default setting     Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated   USB Buffer Sets the size of the USB input buffer  Disabled Notes   Auto    3K to  lt maximum size allowed gt        Auto is the factory default setting     The Disabled setting turns off job buffering  Any jobs already buffered on the   disk are printed before normal processing is resumed    The USB buffer size value can be changed in 1 K increments    The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer   the size of the other link buffers  and whether the Resource Save setting is On  or Off     To increase the maximum size range for the USB Buffer  disable or reduce the  size of the parallel  serial  and network buffers     Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the          menus causes the printer to restart  The menu selection is updated        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    Menu item  Job Buffering  Off  On  Auto    176    Description    Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing  Notes     Off is the factory default setting     The On setting buffers jobs on the printer ha
333. tem support person  Once it is set up  it  appears as a display item                    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Learning about the printer    5    Display item    Status message bar    Description      Shows the current printer status such as Ready or Busy     Shows printer conditions such as Toner Low       Shows intervention messages to give instructions on what you should do so the printer can  continue processing  such as Close doororInsert print cartridge                 r       6   Status Supplies Appears on the display whenever the printer status includes a message requiring intervention   Touch it to access the messages screen for more information on the message  including how  to clear it    7    Tips All menus have a Tips button  Tips is a context sensitive Help feature within the display touch  screens    8 Fax Opens the Fax menus          M       Other buttons that may appear on the home screen     Display item    Release Held Faxes    Function    If this button is shown  then there are held faxes with a scheduled hold  time previously set  To access the list of held faxes  touch this button        Search Held Jobs    Searches on any of the following items and returns search results     User names for held or confidential print jobs    Job names for held jobs  excluding confidential print jobs    Profile names    Bookmark container or job names      USB container or job names for supported extensions only       Held Jobs    Opens a screen 
334. tes       Use a regular telephone to answer an incoming fax job and to dial a fax  number       Touch  0 on the numeric keypad to go directly to the Manual Fax function        Memory Use  All receive  Mostly receive  Equal  Mostly sent  All send       Defines the allocation of non volatile memory between sending and receiving fax jobs    Notes          All receive  specifies that all the memory is set to receive fax jobs      Mostly receive  specifies that most of the memory is set to receive fax jobs       Equalis the factory default setting  Equal splits the memory for sending and  receiving fax jobs into equal amounts        Mostly sent  specifies that most of the memory is set to send fax jobs           e    All send  specifies that all the memory is set to send fax jobs        Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    a    Menu item    Cancel Faxes    199    Description    Specifies whether the printer may cancel fax jobs                            Allow Note  If Cancel Faxes is not enabled  it will not appear as an option   Don t Allow  Caller ID Specifies type of caller ID being used  FSK Note  FSK is the factory default setting   DTMF  Fax number masking Specifies the direction from which digits are masked in an outgoing fax number  Off Note  The number of characters masked is determined by the    Digits to mask     From left setting   From right  Digits to mask Specifies the number of digits to mask in an outgoing fax number  0 5
335. th the same  or different parameters     The definition of a set depends on the scan source      f you scan a document on the scanner glass  a set consists of one page      f you scan multiple pages using the ADF  a set consists of all scanned pages until the ADF becomes empty        f you scan one page using the ADF  a set consists of one page   For example   1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy    Touch Options    Touch Custom Job    Touch On     Touch Done     on Oo Ui A W N    Touch Copy It     When the end of a set is reached  the scan screen appears     9 Load the next document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass  and then touch  Scan the Automatic Document Feeder or Scan the flatbed     Note  If required  change the job settings     10 If you have another document to scan  load the next document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown  on the scanner glass  and then touch Scan the Automatic Document Feeder or Scan the flatbed  Otherwise  touch  Finish the job     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 101    Job interrupt    Job interrupt pauses the current prin
336. the Industry Canada technical  specifications were met     Industry Canada  Canada     Cet appareil est conforme    la norme RSS 210 d Industry Canada  Son fonctionnement est soumis aux deux conditions  suivantes       1  cet appareil ne doit pas provoquer d interf  rences et  2  il doit accepter toute interf  rence recue  y compris celles  risquant d alt  rer son fonctionnement     Cet appareil a   t   concu pour fonctionner uniquement avec l antenne fournie  L utilisation de toute autre antenne est  strictement interdite par la r  glementation d Industry Canada     En application des r  glementations d Industry Canada  l utilisation d une antenne de gain sup  rieur est strictement  interdite     Pour emp  cher toute interf  rence radio au service faisant l objet d une licence  cet appareil doit   tre utilis      l int  rieur  et loin des fen  tres afin de garantir une protection optimale     Si le mat  riel  ou son antenne d   mission  est install      l ext  rieur  il doit faire l objet d une licence     L installateur de cet   quipement radio doit veiller    ce que l antenne soit implant  e et dirig  e de mani  re    n   mettre  aucun champ HF d  passant les limites fix  es pour l ensemble de la population par Sant   Canada  Reportez vous au  Code de s  curit   6 que vous pouvez consulter sur le site Web de Sant   Canada www hc sc gc ca rpb     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 295    Le terme    IC    pr  c  dant le num  ro de d accr  ditation insc
337. the printer   4 Install the drivers and add the printer   a Install a PPD file on the computer   1 Insert the Software and Documentation CD in the CD or DVD drive   Double click the installer package for the printer   From the Welcome screen  click Continue   Click Continue again after viewing the Readme file     U AUN    Click Continue after viewing the license agreement  and then click Agree to accept the terms of the  agreement    6 Select a Destination  and then click Continue    7 From the Easy Install screen  click Install     8 Type the user password  and then click OK   All the necessary software is installed on the computer   9 Click Close when installation is complete     b Add the printer     For IP printing     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup    In Mac OS X version 10 5    1  2  3  4  5    From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   Click Print  amp  Fax    Click      Select the printer from the list    Click Add     In Mac OS X version 10 4 and earlier    1    uk WN    6    From the Go menu  choose Applications   Double click Utilities    Double click Printer Setup Utility or Print Center   From the Printer List  click Add    Select the printer from the list    Click Add       For AppleTalk printing     In Mac OS X version 10 5    1    au RW N    From the Apple menu  choose System Preferences   Click Print  amp  Fax    Click      Click AppleTalk    Select the printer from the list    Click Add     In Mac OS X version
338. the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     2 Click Settings   3 Click Manage Shortcuts     Note  A password may be required  If you do not have an ID and password  get one from your system support  person     4 Click Fax Shortcut Setup     5 Type aunique name for the shortcut  and then enter the fax number     To create a multiple number shortcut  enter the fax numbers for the group   Note  Separate each fax number in the group with a semicolon         6 Assign a shortcut number     If you enter a number that is already in use  then you are prompted to select another number     7 Click Add     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Faxing 115    Creating a fax destination shortcut using the touch screen  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     2 If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   3 On the home screen  touch Fax   4 Enter the fax number   To create a group of fax numbers  touch Next number  and then enter the next fax number   5 Touch Save as Shortcut   6 Enter a name for the shortcut     7 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct  and then touch OK  If the name or number is incorrect  then  touch Cancel  and then reenter t
339. ther the original document is scanned edge to edge  On Note  Off is the factory default setting   Off  Sharpness Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a scanned image  t 0 5 Note  3 is the factory default setting  J          Flash Drive menu    Scan Settings    Menu item Description             Format Specifies the format of the file  PDF   pdf   Secure PDF  TIFF   tif   JPEG   jpg   XPS   xps   PDF Version Sets the version of the PDF file that will be scanned to USB  1 2 1 6 Note  1 5 is the factory default setting   Content Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to USB  Text Photo Notes   Photograph  Text   Text Photo is the factory default setting  Text Photo is used when the  documents are mostly text or line art     Photograph is used when the document is a high quality photograph or inkjet  print    Text is used when the document is mostly text   Color Specifies whether job prints in grayscale or color  Gray Note  Gray is the factory default setting   Color             Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals          Understanding printer menus    a    215             Business Card  Custom Scan Size  lt x gt   A4   AS   Oficio  Mexico    A6   JIS BS   Book Original   Auto Size Sense  Mixed Letter Legal    Menu item Description  Resolution Specifies how many dots per inch are scanned  75 Note  150 dpi is the factory default setting   150  200  300  400  600  Darkness Lightens or darkens the output  1 9 Note  5 is the factory default setting   Orientation Spec
340. ther with all modifications   documentation  and merged portions in any form     TAXES  You agree that you are responsible for payment of any taxes including  without limitation  any goods and  services and personal property taxes  resulting from this Software License Agreement or your Use of the Software  Program     LIMITATION ON ACTIONS  No action  regardless of form  arising out of this Software License Agreement may be  brought by either party more than two years after the cause of action has arisen  except as provided under applicable  law     APPLICABLE LAW  This Software License Agreement is governed by the laws of the Commonwealth of Kentucky   United States of America  No choice of law rules in any jurisdiction shall apply  The UN Convention on Contracts for  the International Sale of Goods shall not apply     UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT RESTRICTED RIGHTS  The Software Program has been developed entirely at private  expense  Rights of the United States Government to use the Software Program are as set forth in this Software  License Agreement and as restricted in DFARS 252 227 7014 and in similar FAR provisions  or any equivalent agency  regulation or contract clause      CONSENT TO USE OF DATA  You agree that Lexmark  its affiliates  and agents may collect and use information you  provide in relation to support services performed with respect to the Software Program and requested by you   Lexmark agrees not to use this information in a form that personally identifies 
341. tic Wiping   activating this option may decrease printer performance  especially if the    printer requires hard disk space faster than it can be wiped and returned to  service        Manual Wiping  Start now  Do not start now       Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  from the printer hard disk  All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved   such as downloaded fonts  macros  and held jobs     Manual Wiping overwrites all disk space that has been used to hold data from a print  job that has been processed  i e  printed   This type of wipe does not erase any  information related to an unprocessed print job     Notes     This menu item appears only if a formatted  non defective printer hard disk is  installed      Do not start now  is the default setting     e  f the Disk Wiping access control is activated  then a user must successfully  authenticate and have the required authorization in order to initiate the disk          wipe     M       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus    a    Menu item  Automatic Method  Single pass   Multiple pass    183    Description    Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  from the printer hard disk  All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved   such as downloaded fonts  macros  and held jobs     Notes     This menu item appears only if a formatted  non defective printer hard disk is  
342. ting     5 reduces the file size  but the quality of the image is lessened     90 provides the best image quality  but the file size is very large       This menu item applies to Text  Text Photo  and all scan functions        Use Multi Page TIFF  On  Off    Provides a choice between single page TIFF files and multiple page TIFF files  For a  multiple page scan to USB job  either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages   or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job     Notes       Onisthe factory default setting       This menu item applies to all scan functions        Scan bit Depth  8 bit  1 bit    Enables the Text Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1 bit images when  Color is set to Off    Note  8 bit is the factory default setting        Base File Name    Lets you enter a base file name       Custom Job scanning  Off  On    Lets you copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single job       Scan Preview  On  Off    Specifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs    Note  Off is the factory default setting        Background Removal   4to  4    Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy    Note  0 is the factory default setting        Auto Center  On  Off       Lets you automatically center the copy on the page    Note  Off is the factory default setting              Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus      Menu item  Color Dropout  Color Dro
343. tion    When should   use Text  mode     Tip      Use Text mode when text preservation is the main goal of the fax  and preserving images  copied from the original document is not a concern       Text mode is recommended for faxing receipts  carbon copy forms  and documents that  contain only text or fine line art        When should   use  Text Photo mode       UseText Photo mode when faxing an original document that contains a mixture of text and  graphics       Text Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles  business graphics  and brochures        When should   use Photo  mode        Use Photo mode when faxing photos printed on a laser printer or taken from a magazine or  newspaper              Holding and forwarding faxes    Holding faxes    This option lets you hold received faxes from printing until they are released  Held faxes can be released manually or    at a scheduled day or time     1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  then print a network setup page and locate the IP  address in the TCP IP section     Click Settings     Click Fax Settings     Click Holding Faxes     vn Oo Ui A VUN      Off     Always On    Manual     Scheduled    Click Analog Fax Setup     Enter a password in the Print Faxes Password box     From the Held Fax Mode menu  select one of the following     8 If you selected Scheduled  then continue with the following steps  Otherwise  go to step 9   a
344. trays from the Paper Type menu available from the Paper Size Type menu     Unlinking trays    Unlinked trays have settings that are not the same as the settings of any other tray     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Loading paper and specialty media 84    To unlink a tray  change the following tray settings so that they do not match the settings of any other tray     Paper Type  for example  Plain Paper  Letterhead  Custom Type  lt x gt      Paper Type names describe the paper characteristics  If the name that best describes your paper is used by linked  trays  assign a different Paper Type name to the tray  such as Custom Type  lt x gt   or define your own custom name       Paper Size  for example  letter  A4  statement     Load a different paper size to change the Paper Size setting for a tray automatically  Paper Size settings for the  multipurpose feeder are not automatic  they must be set manually from the Paper Size menu     Warning   Potential Damage  Do not assign a Paper Type name that does not accurately describe the type of paper  loaded in the tray  The temperature of the fuser varies according to the specified Paper Type  Paper may not be  properly processed if an inaccurate Paper Type is selected     Assigning a custom paper type name  Assign a custom paper type name to a tray when linking or unlinking the tray   1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   2 From the home screen  touch        3 Touch Paper Menu   4 Touch Paper Size Type   5
345. ts   This option places a blank piece of paper between copies  pages  and print jobs  The separator sheets can be drawn  from a tray that contains a type or color of paper that is different from the paper your copies are printed on   Margin Shift   This option increases the size of the margin a specified distance  This can be useful in providing space to bind or hole   punch copies  Use the increase or decrease arrows to set how much of a margin you want  If the additional margin is  too large  then the copy will be cropped     Edge Erase    This option eliminates smudges or information around the edges of your document  You can choose to eliminate an  equal area around all four sides of the paper  or pick a particular edge  Edge Erase erases whatever is within the selected  area  leaving nothing printed on that portion of the paper     Header Footer    This option turns on the Date Time  Page number  Bates number  or Custom text and prints them in the specified  header or footer location     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 105    Overlay    This option creates a watermark  or message  that overlays the content of your copy  You can choose between Urgent   Confidential  Copy  and Draft  or you can enter a custom message in the  Enter custom text    field  The word you pick  will appear  faintly  in large print across each page     Note  A custom overlay can also be created by your system support person  When a custom overlay is created  a  button with
346. tt are the REN without a decimal point  for example  03 is a REN of 0 3   For earlier products   the REN is shown separately on the label     If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network  the telephone company will notify you in advance that  temporary discontinuance of service may be required  If advance notice is not practical  the telephone company will  notify the customer as soon as possible  You will also be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC     The telephone company may make changes in its facilities  equipment  operations or procedures that could affect the  operation of this equipment  If this happens  the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to  make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service     If you experience trouble with this equipment  for repair or warranty information  contact Lexmark International  Inc   at www lexmark com or your Lexmark representative  If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone network  the  telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved     This equipment contains no user serviceable parts  For repair and warranty information  contact Lexmark International   Inc  See the previous paragraph for contact information     Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs  Contact the state public utility commission  public service  commission  or corporation commission for information     If your home has s
347. tter size paper  setting the     Copy from  and  Copy to  paper sizes automatically changes the scaleto keep all the original document information  on your copy     Touch the left arrow to decrease the value by 196  touch the right arrow to increase the value by 196     Hold your finger on an arrow to make a continuous increment change     Hold your finger on an arrow for two seconds to cause the pace of the change to accelerate     Darkness    This option adjusts how light or dark your copies will turn out in relation to the original document     Content    This option tells the printer the original document type  Choose from Text  Text Photo  Photograph  or Printed Image     Text   Emphasize sharp  black  high resolution text against a clean  white background    Text Photo   Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures      Photograph   Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures  This setting increases the time it  takes to scan  but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document       Printed Image   Used when copying halftone photographs  graphics such as documents printed on a laser printer   or pages from a magazine or newspaper that are composed primarily of images  Sides  Duplex   Use this option to select duplex settings  You can print copies on one or two sides  make two sided copies  duplex  of    two sided original documents  make two sided copies from one sided origin
348. tting   Color  Resolution Specifies how many dots per inch are scanned  75 Note  150 dpi is the factory default setting   150  200  300  400  600  Darkness Lightens or darkens the output  1 9 Note  5 is the factory default setting   Orientation Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  Portrait Note  Portrait is the factory default setting   Landscape             Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus       Menu item    Original Size  Letter  Legal  Executive  Folio  Statement  Universal  4x 6in   3x 5in   Business Card  Custom Scan Size  lt x gt   A4  AS  Oficio  Mexico   A6  JIS B5  Book Original  Auto Size Sense  Mixed Letter Legal    212    Description    Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned    Note  Letter is the US factory default setting  A4 is the international factory default  setting           Sides  Duplex  Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  Off Notes   Long edge  Short edge e Off is the factory default setting     Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page  left edge for  portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation      Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page  top edge for  portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation    JPEG Quality Sets the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  Best for content image  5 90 Notes          Best for content    is the factory defau
349. uipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative Council  for Terminal Attachments  ACTA   On the back of this equipment is a label that contains  among other information  a  product identifier in the format US AAAEQHH TXXXX  If requested  this number must be provided to your telephone  company     This equipment uses the RJ 11C Universal Service Order Code  USOC  jack     A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises  wiring and telephone network must comply with the  applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA  A compliant telephone cord and modular plug is  provided with this product  It is designed to be connected to a compatible modular jack that is also compliant  See your  setup documentation for more information     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 298    The Ringer Equivalence Number  REN  is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected toa telephone  line  Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call  In most  but not all areas  the sum of RENs should not exceed five  5 0   To be certain of the number of devices that may be  connected to a line  as determined by the total RENs  contact your local telephone company  For products approved  after July 23  2001  the REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the format US AAAEQHHTXXXX   The digits represented by t
350. uired     You do not need to attach the printer to a computer  but you do need to connect it to a telephone line to send and  receive faxes     You can connect the printer to other equipment  See the following table to determine the best way to set up the printer          Equipment Benefits      The printer Send and receive faxes without using a computer       Atelephone cord       The printer   Use the fax line as a normal telephone line       Atelephone   Send and receive faxes without using a computer     Two telephone cords       The printer Receive both incoming voice messages and faxes     A telephone      Ananswering machine    Three telephone cords       The printer Send faxes using the computer or the printer     A telephone      Acomputer modem             Three telephone cords       Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Additional printer setup 61    Using an RJ11 adapter    Country region      United Kingdom    taly      reland   Sweden     Finland   Netherlands    Norway   France     Denmark   Portugal    To connect your printer to an answering machine  telephone  or other telecommunications equipment  use the  telephone line adapter included in the box with the printer in some countries or regions     Note  If you have DSL  do not connect the printer using a splitter because the fax feature may not work correctly     1 Connect the adapter to the telephone cord that came with the printer     Note  The UK adapter is shown  Your adapter may look differen
351. uments are mostly text or line art     Photograph is used when the document is a high quality photograph or inkjet  print   Darkness Lightens or darkens the output  1 9 Note  5 is the factory default setting   Dial Prefix A numeric entry field is provided to enter numbers       Dialing Prefix Rules  Prefix Rule   x      Establishes a dialing prefix rule       Automatic Redial  0 9    Specifies the number of times the printer tries to send the fax to a specified number    Note  5 is the factory default setting        Redial Frequency  1 200    Specifies the number of minutes between redials       Behind a PABX  Off  On    Enables switchboard blind dialing without a dial tone       Enable ECM  On  Off    Enables Error Correction Mode for fax jobs       Enable Fax Scans  On  Off    Lets you send faxes by scanning at the printer       Driver to fax  On  Off    Allows driver to fax jobs to be sent by the printer       Allow Save as Shortcut  On  Off       Lets you save fax numbers as shortcuts in the printer             Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Understanding printer menus 201       Menu item Description                                        Dial Mode Specifies the dialing sound  either as a tone or a pulse   Tone  Pulse  Max Speed Specifies the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are sent  2400  4800  9600  14400  33600  Custom Job scanning Lets you scan a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single file  On  Off  Scan Preview Specifies whether
352. useeecesesseaeesess nnn n nnne 101  Placing an overlay message on each page          cccceesseccccessessscceceesseesecescessesececessusseeeceessasseeescesseeseeeesesesaeeesees 101  Canceling a copy JOD r srcssii niinen sennae aiaiai a iaaa eaa AEE anaa AEE AAEE aa aaiae 102  Canceling a copy job while the document is in the ADF                  esses eene nnne enne nnne nnns nnne nnns 102  Canceling a copy job while copying pages using the scanner glass    102  Canceling a copy job while the pages are being printed                         seessssessssssseneeee eene enne 102  Understanding the copy screens and options                  sssssssssssssssssseseeeenenenee ener sene 102  COPY Aonm                                                          102  Sod                                                                                      103  el m                                                                 103  REI e                                                            103  Sonic                                                                        OR 103  Sides  D  plex  cose deste reve ended eue ath seated dietas A Uo deni cU IN DUM Iud 103  sr m                                                                                         104  OPON cem 104  Improving  copy quality  i    ceci eee reati eene Ee ceno opp e eek oce Fee tbe aeo ne rne Ea ape bdo Gea ne do 105    EINE eisspese Ges reae RR XE NEPRESRURONE EUM RE M RS E NUR RUPES KR ER RE RR OL GE nS EE ROE E 
353. ve gases      Heavy dust    Conserving supplies    There are some settings you can change from the printer control panel that will help you conserve toner and paper   For more information  see  Supplies menu    Quality menu   and  Finishing menu      If you need to print several copies  you can conserve supplies by printing the first copy and checking it for accuracy  before printing the remaining copies     Checking the status of supplies    A message appears on the display when a replacement supply item is needed or when maintenance is required     Checking the status of supplies from the printer control panel  1 Make sure the printer is on and Ready appears   2 Onthe home screen  touch Status Supplies     Note  If Status Supplies is not on the home screen  then print a menu settings page to review the status of the  supplies     Checking the status of supplies from a network computer  Note  The computer must be connected to the same network as the printer   1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser     Note  If you do not know the IP address of the printer  print a network setup page and locate the IP address in  the TCP IP section     2 Click Device Status  The Device Status page appears  displaying a summary of supply levels     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Maintaining the printer 255    Ordering supplies    To order supplies in the U S   contact Lexmark at 1 800 539 6275 for information about Lexmark authorized supplies
354. warranty period  For products no longer covered  by a Lexmark warranty  technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee     Extent of limited warranty    Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of prints  produced by any product     Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by       Modification or unauthorized attachments      Accidents  misuse  abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user   s guides  manuals  instructions or guidance     Unsuitable physical or operating environment      Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer      Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle      Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications      Refurbishment  repair  refilling or remanufacture by a third party of products  supplies or parts      Products  supplies  parts  materials  such as toners and inks   software  or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark    TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW  NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS OR  REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND  WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WITH  RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT  AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF  MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  AND SATISFACTORY QUALITY  ANY WARRANTIES THAT  MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD  NO  WA
355. wnloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 98    4 From the Scale area  touch the arrows to enlarge or reduce your copies     Touching    Copy to    or    Copy from    after setting Scale manually changes the scale value back to Auto     5 Touch Copy It     Adjusting copy quality  1 Load an original document faceup  short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass     Note  Do not load postcards  photos  small items  transparencies  photo paper  or thin media  such as magazine  clippings  into the ADF  Place these items on the scanner glass     If you are loading a document into the ADF  then adjust the paper guides   On the home screen  touch Copy   Touch Options     Touch Content     a A VU N    Touch the button that best represents what you are copying     Text   Used for original documents that are mostly text or line art    Text Photo   Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures    Photograph   Used when the original document is a high quality photograph or inkjet print      Printed Image   Used when copying halftone photographs  graphics such as documents printed on a laser  printer  or pages from a magazine or newspaper that are composed primarily of images    7 Touch Done     8 Touch Copy It     Collating copies    If you print multiple copies of a document  then you can choose to print each copy as a set  collated  or to print the  copies as groups of pages  not collated      Collated Not collated        
356. y  or individual   The telephone number provided may not be a 900 number or  any other number for which charges exceed local or long distance transmission charges      See your user documentation in order to program this information into your fax machine     Notice to users of the Canadian telephone network    This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications  The Ringer Equivalence Number  REN  is  an indication of the maximum number of terminals allowed to be connected to a telephone interface  The terminus of  an interface may consist of any combination of devices  subject only to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of  all the devices does not exceed five  The modem REN is located on the rear of the equipment on the product labeling     Telephone companies report that electrical surges  typically lightning transients  are very destructive to customer  terminal equipment connected to AC power sources  This has been identified as a major nationwide problem  It is    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 299    recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  connected  An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated  and certified by UL  Underwriter   s  Laboratories   another NRTL  Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory   or a recognized safety certification body in  the country region of use  This is to avoid damage to the equipment 
357. ycled paper and other office papers  on  page 88     Unacceptable paper    The following paper types are not recommended for use with the printer       Chemically treated papers used to make copies without carbon paper  also known as carbonless papers  carbonless  copy paper  CCP   or no carbon required  NCR  paper      Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer    Preprinted papers that can be affected by the temperature in the printer fuser      Preprinted papers that require a registration  the precise print location on the page  greater than  2 3 mm    0 9 in     such as optical character recognition  OCR  forms    In some cases  registration can be adjusted with a software application to successfully print on these forms     Coated papers  erasable bond   synthetic papers  thermal papers    Rough edged  rough or heavily textured surface papers  or curled papers    Recycled papers that fail EN12281 2002  European     Paper weighing less than 60 g m   16 Ib       Multiple part forms or documents    Selecting paper    Using appropriate paper prevents jams and helps ensure trouble free printing   To help avoid jams and poor print quality     Always use new  undamaged paper       Before loading paper  know the recommended print side of the paper  This information is usually indicated on the  paper package       Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand     Do not mix paper sizes  types  or weights in the same source  mixing results in jams  
358. you are going to copy     Touch a paper size button to select it as the  Copy from  setting  The copy screen appears with your new setting  displayed     When  Copy from  is set to Mixed Letter Legal  you can copy an original document that contains mixed paper sizes       When    Copy from  is set to Auto Size Sense  the scanner automatically determines the size of the original document     Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Copying 103    Copy to    This option opens a screen where you can enter the size and type of paper on which your copies will be printed       Touch a paper size button to select it as the  Copy to    setting  The copy screen appears with your new setting  displayed       fthe size settings for  Copy from  and  Copy to  are different  the printer automatically adjusts the Scale setting  to accommodate the difference     e Ifthe type or size of paper that you want to copy onto is not loaded in one of the trays  touch Manual Feeder  and  manually send the paper through the multipurpose feeder       When  Copy to  is set to Auto Size Match  each copy matches the size of the original document  If a matching paper  size is not in one of the trays  the printer scales each copy to fit loaded paper     Scale    This option creates an image from your copy that is proportionally scaled anywhere between 25  and 400   Scale can  also be set for you automatically       When you want to copy from one size of paper to another  such as from legal size to le
359. you except to the extent necessary  to provide such services     EXPORT RESTRICTIONS  You may not  a  acquire  ship  transfer  or reexport  directly or indirectly  the Software  Program or any direct product therefrom  in violation of any applicable export laws or  b  permit the Software  Program to be used for any purpose prohibited by such export laws  including  without limitation  nuclear  chemical   or biological weapons proliferation    AGREEMENT TO CONTRACT ELECTRONICALLY  You and Lexmark agree to form this Software License Agreement  electronically  This means that when you click the  Agree  or    I accept  button on this page or use this product   you acknowledge your agreement to these Software License Agreement terms and conditions and that you are  doing so with the intent to  sign  a contract with Lexmark    CAPACITY AND AUTHORITY TO CONTRACT  You represent that you are of the legal age of majority in the place you  sign this Software License Agreement and  if applicable  you are duly authorized by your employer or principal to  enter into this contract    ENTIRE AGREEMENT  This Software License Agreement  including any addendum or amendment to this Software  License Agreement that is included with the Software Program  is the entire agreement between you and Lexmark    Downloaded From ManualsPrinter com Manuals       Notices 307    relating to the Software Program  Except as otherwise provided for herein  these terms and conditions supersede  all prior or contem
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
SECTION 2 INSTALLATION  313 - 三菱電機  Owner`s Manual - Stamina Products  Embarcação e sua navegação - Rede e-Tec  Reich mode d`emploi    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file